Javascript required
Skip to content Skip to sidebar Skip to footer

A Fire Rated Evacuation Stair Can Not Have a Skylight

The British Columbia
Fire Code
1998

Office of the Fire Commissioner
Ministry of Municipal Affairs

Province of British Columbia

ORDER OF THE LIEUTENANT GOVERNOR
IN COUNCIL

Order in Council No.

1095

Approved and Ordered

JUL 30 1998

��������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������
������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������������ _____________________________

������������ Administrator

Executive Council Chambers, Victoria

On the recommendation of the undersigned, the Administrator, by and with the advice and consent of the Executive Council, orders that, effective December 1, 1998,

��������� (a)��� the British Columbia Fire Code which adopts with some changes the National Fire Code of Canada 1995 as it existed on January 1, 1998, is adopted and enacted in the form attached to this order, and

��������� (b)��� B.C. Reg. 403/92, the British Columbia Fire Code Regulation, is repealed.

�� DEPOSITED

�� AUG 04 1998

�� B.C. REG. 285/98

������� ��������������������

������������������������������������������������������������������������ _________________________________ ���������������������������������������������������������������������������������������� _________________________________

Minister of Municipal Affairs Presiding Member of the Executive Council

(This part is for administrative purposes only and is not part of the Order)

Authority under which Order is Made:

Act and section:- ........ Fire Services Act, section 47 (2) RSBC 1996 c.144���������

Other (specify):- ........ oic 1594/92�������

���������� July 27, 1998����������������������������������������������������������� 1253/98/13/bgn

B.C. Fire Code Committee 1998

Voting Member��������������������������������������������� Organization

Duncan Ferguson, P.Eng.��������������������������������� Ministry of Environment, Lands and Parks

Tim K. Lenahan, P.Eng.����������������������������������� Association of Professional Engineers & Geoscientists of B.C.

Bob Furlong����������������������������������������������������� Fire Prevention Officers' Association of B.C.

Edward MacKinnon, MAIBC.�������������������������� Architectural Institute of B.C.

John Chace������������������������������������������������������ Building Officials' Association of B.C.

Robert Stephenson, P.Eng.�������������������������������� Canadian Petroleum Products Institute

Jim S. McGregor, Fire Chief����������������������������� Fire Chiefs' Association of B.C.

Avy Woo, P.Eng.��������������������������������������������� City of Vancouver

Brad Walton, A.Sc.T.��������������������������������������� Applied Science Technologists & Technicians
����������������������������������������������������������������������� Association of B.C.; Building Owners &
����������������������������������������������������������������������� Managers Association of B.C.

A Guide to the Use of the Code

The British Columbia Fire Code provides a set of minimum requirements respecting fire safety in existing buildings and within the community at large. Its primary purpose is the promotion of public safety through the application of uniform fire safety standards throughout British Columbia.

Historically, building code and fire code requirements were developed to provide property protection, but current fire protection legislation gives increasing emphasis to matters affecting life safety. Life safety is a primary objective of the British Columbia Fire Code and property protection requirements are included for two reasons: they make a direct contribution to life safety, and for the purpose of controlling conflagrations or large loss fires because these events can have serious social and economic impact on the community.

The British Columbia Fire Code contains safety measures for both the building occupants and fire fighters. Safe evacuation or rescue of the occupants, as well as containment or control of a fire, are achieved through requirements for life safety and property protection. Although increased property protection is desirable, any extra protection for existing buildings may not be economically feasible, and the extent to which this Code can include such requirements must be based on risk assessment and available technical resources.

The Code is divided into 7 Parts: each Part is self sufficient with cross references to the building code and other standards where needed. A decimal numbering system has been used throughout the Code. The first number indicates the Part of the Code, the second the Section in the Part, the third the Subsection in the Section and the fourth the Article in the Subsection. An article may be broken down further into sentences, clauses and subclauses, each of which, as can be seen below, is in parentheses.

����������������������� 2������������������������ Part

����������������������� 2.8���������������������� Section

����������������������� 2.8.2������������������� Subsection

����������������������� 2.8.2.1.��������������� Article

����������������������� 2.8.2.1.(1)����������� Sentence

����������������������� 2.8.2.1.(1)(a)������� Clause

����������������������� 2.8.2.1.(1)(a)(i)��� Subclause

A summary of the contents of the Code follows:

Part 1Application and Definitions

Part 1 contains the definitions of all words throughout the Code that appear in italic type, and stipulates how the Code is applied. It includes the necessary administrative requirements to ensure that the technical requirements can be applied with a minimum of difficulty.

Part 2Building and Occupant Fire Safety

Part 2 contains general fires safety requirements for all buildings. It provides for the control of common fire hazards, including those arising from smoking, open flames, storage and disposal of combustible materials, open air fires and incinerators, and addresses maintenance of fire separations, heating appliances and systems and air conditioning systems. In addition, it includes requirements for maintenance of fire department access and means of egress, establishment of fire safety plans and fire emergency procedures, and fire safety at demolition and construction sites. Portions of this Part deal with upgrading existing buildings to ensure an acceptable standard of life safety.

Part 3Industrial and Commercial Occupancies

Part 3 contains requirements for the storage of combustible products and dangerous goods, both inside and outside of buildings.

Part 4Flammable and Combustible Liquids

Part 4 contains requirements for the storage, handling and use of flammable and combustible liquids in connection with the operation of residential, assembly, institutional, commercial and industrial facilities.

Part 5Hazardous Materials, Processes and Operations

Part 5 applies to processes and operations that involve a risk from fire or explosion or otherwise create a hazard to life safety.

Part 6Fire Protection Equipment

Part 6 is designed to ensure the continued safe operation of portable extinguishers, fire suppression systems, fire alarm systems, water supplies for fire protection and emergency power installations.

Part 7Inspection, Testing and Maintenance of Fire Emergency Systems in High Buildings

Part 7 addresses requirements for the inspection, testing and maintenance of fire emergency systems in high buildings. It provides a companion document to Part 3 of the British Columbia Building Code and Commentary C of the user's guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3).

Appendix A���� Explanatory Information

Appendix A provides explanatory information on the requirements contained in Parts 1 to 7. It is included for information purposes only and is not part of the technical requirements of the Code.

Part 1 ����� General

Section 1.1. �� General

1.1.1. �� General

1.1.1.1. Responsibility

������������ 1)�� Unless otherwise specified, the owner or the owner's authorized agent shall be responsible for carrying out the provisions of this Code.

1.1.1.2. Authority

������������ 1)�� The fire commissioner is designated as the person responsible for administration of this Code.

������������ 2)�� The fire commissioner, inspectors and local assistants are designated as the persons responsible for the enforcement of this Code and may issue orders to ensure compliance where necessary.

1.1.1.3. Orders

������������ 1)�� When making an order, the fire commissioner, inspectors and local assistants shall take into account relevant recognized standards and related safety factors.

������������ 2)�� An order shall be made in writing and given to the persons affected.

������������ 3)�� An owner or occupier of a building or premises shall, after receipt of the order, comply with it.

1.1.1.4. Appeals to Fire Commissioner

������������ 1)�� A person adversely affected by the order made by a local assistant or an inspector may appeal the order to the fire commissioner.

������������ 2)�� An appeal shall be made by registered letter, mailed within 10 days after receipt of the order by the owner or occupier.

������������ 3)�� The fire commissioner shall promptly investigate each appeal, affirm, modify or revoke the order appealed from, and in writing communicate the decision and the reasons to the appellant and to the maker of the order.

1.1.1.5. Other Appeals

������������ 1)�� Where an order made under this Code involves the loss or expenditure of more than $500, a person adversely affected by it, if dissatisfied with the order or decision, may, within 5 days of its receipt, apply for a review of it by petition to the Supreme Court, and section 28 of the Act applies for the purposes of this review.

1.1.1.6. Records

������������ 1)�� Where this Code requires that records of inspections, maintenance procedures or tests be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, such records shall be retained during the required time interval between the inspections, maintenance procedures or tests, or for 2 years, whichever is greater.

������������ 2)�� The records required in Sentence (1) shall be retained as part of the fire safety plan required in Section 2.8.

1.1.2. �� Equivalents

1.1.2.1. Equivalence

������������ 1)�� The provisions of this Code are not intended to limit the appropriate use of materials, systems, equipment and procedures not specifically described herein.

������������ 2)�� Materials, systems, equipment and procedures not specifically described herein or that vary from the specific requirements in this Code or for which no recognized test procedure has been established, are permitted to be used if it can be shown that these alternatives are equivalent on the basis of tests, evaluations or past performance.

������������ 3)�� Where no published test method exists, any test submitted to determine equivalence shall be designed to simulate or exceed anticipated service conditions or shall be designed to compare the performance of the material, system, equipment or procedure with similar materials, systems, equipment or procedures that are known to meet the requirements of this Code.

1.1.2.2. Equivalent Test Standards

������������ 1)�� The results of tests based on test standards other than as described in this Code are permitted to be used provided such alternate test standards will provide comparable results.

1.1.2.3. Alternatives

������������ 1)�� Alternatives to requirements in this Code are permitted if the authority having jurisdiction is satisfied that these alternatives provide a level of fire and life safety that is equivalent to the level of performance required by this Code in conformance withArticle 1.1.2.1. (See Appendix A.)

1.1.3. �� Referenced Documents

1.1.3.1. Conflicting Requirements

������������ 1)�� When a conflict exists between the provisions of this Code and those of a referenced document, the provisions of this Code shall govern.

1.1.3.2. Effective Date

������������ 1)�� Unless otherwise specified herein, the documents referenced in this Code shall include all amendments, revisions and supplements effective to 1 January 1998.

������������ 2)�� Documents referenced in this Code shall be the editions designated in Table 1.1.3.2. (See Appendix A.)

Table 1.1.3.2.

Documents Referenced in the British Columbia Fire Code

Forming Part of Sentence 1.1.3.2.(2)

Issuing Agency

Document Number

Title of Document

Code Reference

AAFC

Pest Control Products Act and its Regulations

4.2.3.2.(2)

AECB

Atomic Energy Control Act and its Regulations

3.1.1.2.(1)

ANSI/ASME

Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code 1995

4.3.1.3.(1)
4.4.10.5.(2)
4.4.10.6.(1)

ANSI/ASME

B16.5-1996

Pipe Flanges and Flanged Fittings

4.4.5.3.(1)

ANSI/ASME

B31.3-1996

Chemical Plant and Petroleum Refinery Piping

4.4.2.1.(5)

API

5L-1995

Line Pipe

4.4.2.1.(4)

API

12B-1995

Bolted Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

API

12D-1994

Field Welded Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

API

12F-1996

Shop Welded Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

API

620-1990

Design and Construction of Large, Welded, Low-Pressure Storage Tanks

4.3.1.3.(1)
4.3.3.1.(1)

API

650-1993

Welded Steel Tanks for Oil Storage

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.3.1.(1)

API

1104-1994

Welding Pipelines and Related Facilities

4.4.5.2.(1)

API

RP 1107-1991

Recommended Pipeline Maintenance Welding Practices

4.4.5.2.(1)
4.4.11.7.(6)

API

2000-1992

Venting Atmospheric and Low-Pressure Storage Tanks

4.3.4.1.(1)

API

2200-1994

Repairs to Crude Oil, Liquefied Petroleum Gas and Products Pipelines

4.4.11.7.(6)

API

2201-1995

Welding or Hot Tapping on Equipment Containing Flammables

4.4.11.7.(6)

ASTM

A 53-97

Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated, Welded and Seamless

4.4.2.1.(4)

ASTM

A 193/A 193M-97b

Alloy-Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High Temperature Service

4.4.5.4.(1)

ASTM

D 56-97a

Flash Point by Tag Closed Tester

4.1.3.1.(1)

ASTM

D 93-97

Flash Point by Pensky-Martens Closed-Cup Tester

4.1.3.1.(2)

ASTM

D 323-94

Vapor Pressure of Petroleum Products (Reid Method)

1.2.1.2.(1)

ASTM

D 3278-96

Flash Point of Liquids by Small Scale Closed-Cup Apparatus

4.1.3.1.(4)

ASTM

D 3828-97

Flash Point by Small Scale Closed Tester

4.1.3.1.(3)

CCBFC

NRCC 38726

British Columbia Building Code

1.2.1.2.(1)
1.2.2.1.(1)
2.1.2.1.(1)
2.1.3.1.(1)
2.1.3.2.(1)
2.2.1.1.(1)
2.2.1.1.(2)
2.2.1.1.(3)
2.2.2.1.(1)
2.2.2.1.(2)
2.2.2.4.(2)
2.3.1.1.(1)
2.3.1.4.(1)
2.4.1.2.(1)
2.5.1.1.(1)
2.6.1.1.(1)
2.6.1.5.(1)
2.6.1.9.(1)
2.6.2.1.(1)
2.7.1.1.(1)
2.7.1.2.(1)
2.7.1.4.(2)
2.7.3.1.(1)
2.8.1.1.(1)
2.8.2.4.(1)
2.8.2.5.(2)
2.8.3.1.(1)
2.8.3.2.(1)
2.9.1.1.(1)
2.9.3.6.(1)
2.10.1.1.(1)
2.11.1.1.(1)
2.13.2.1.(1)
2.13.2.2.(2)
2.14.1.3.(1)
3.2.6.2.(1)
3.2.7.12.(3)
3.3.2.5.(1)
4.1.7.1.(1)
4.2.7.5.(2)
4.2.11.3.(1)
4.3.2.4.(2)
4.3.3.2.(1)
4.3.13.4.(1)
4.4.9.2.(3)
4.5.2.2.(3)
4.5.3.2.(2)
5.1.3.1.(1)
5.6.1.11.(1)
5.7.2.2.(1)
6.5.1.1.(1)
6.5.1.7.(1)
7.1.1.1.(1)
7.1.1.2.(1)
7.1.1.2.(2)
7.1.1.4.(2)

CCBFC

NRCC 40383

User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3)

7.1.1.2.(2)
7.2.3.1.(1)
7.2.3.3.(1)
7.3.2.1.(1)
7.3.3.1.(1)
7.3.4.1.(1)
7.3.5.1.(1)
7.3.6.1.(1)
7.3.7.1.(1)
7.3.8.1.(1)
7.3.9.1.(1)
7.3.10.1.(1)
7.3.11.1.(1)
7.3.12.1.(1)
7.3.13.1.(1)
7.3.14.1.(1)
7.3.15.1.(1)

CGSB

CAN/CGSB-4.162-M80

Hospital Textiles � Flammability Performance Requirements

2.3.2.3.(1)

CGSB

20-GP-12Ma-1989

Braided Water Hose, Knitted or Spiral Wound Reinforcement

6.2.3.4.(1)

CPPI

Using the CPPI Colour-Symbol System to Mark Equipment and Vehicles for Product Identification (1990)

4.3.1.7.(1)
4.4.4.1.(3)
4.4.8.7.(1)

CPPI

PACE Report No. 87-1

Impressed Current Method of Cathodic Protection of Underground Petroleum Storage Tanks

4.3.9.1.(2)
4.4.3.1.(2)

CSA

CAN/CSA-B44-94

Safety Code for Elevators

7.2.2.1.(2)

CSA

B51-97

Boiler, Pressure Vessel, and Pressure Piping Code

4.3.1.3.(2)

CSA

CAN/CSA-B139-M91

Installation Code for Oil Burning Equipment

4.1.1.1.(3)

CSA

B306-M1977

Portable Fuel Tanks for Marine Use

4.2.3.1.(1)

CSA

B346-M1980

Power-Operated Dispensing Devices for Flammable Liquids

4.5.3.1.(1)

CSA

B376-M1980

Portable Containers for Gasoline and Other Petroleum Fuels

4.2.3.1.(1)

CSA

B620-1987

Highway Tanks and Portable Tanks for the Transportation of Dangerous Goods

4.2.3.1.(1)

CSA

C22.1-94

British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations

3.1.4.1.(1)
4.1.4.1.(1)
5.1.2.1.(1)
5.1.2.2.(1)
5.3.1.2.(2)
5.3.1.2.(3)
5.3.1.10.(2)
5.4.6.1.(1)
5.5.3.4.(1)
5.7.3.4.(1)
5.7.5.4.(1)

CSA

CAN/CSA-C282-M89

Emergency Electrical Power Supply for Buildings

6.7.1.1.(1)
6.7.1.4.(1)

CSA

W117.2-94

Safety in Welding, Cutting and Allied Processes

5.2.1.1.(2)

CSA

Z245.1-93

Steel Line Pipe

4.4.2.1.(4)

HC

Hazardous Products Act and its Regulations

4.2.3.2.(2)

HC

Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System (WHMIS) of the Hazardous Products Act

1.2.2.1.(1)
Table 3.2.7.1
3.2.7.15.(2)

IMO

International Maritime Dangerous Goods Code (1992)

3.3.4.8.(1)

NFPA

10-1994

Portable Fire Extinguishers

3.2.4.5.(1)
6.2.1.1.(1)
Table 6.2.3.3.
Table 6.2.3.5.
6.2.4.1.(1)

NFPA

11-1994

Low Expansion Foam and Combined Agent Systems

4.3.2.5.(2)
6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

11A-1994

Medium and High Expansion Foam Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

12-1993

Carbon Dioxide Extinguishing Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

12A-1997

Halon 1301 Fire Extinguishing Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

12B-1990

Halon 1211 Fire Extinguishing Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

13-1996

Installation of Sprinkler Systems

3.2.3.3.(2)

NFPA

14-1996

Installation of Standpipe and Hose Systems

6.4.1.1.(1)

NFPA

15-1996

Water Spray Fixed Systems for Fire Protection

4.3.2.5.(2)
6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

16-1995

Deluge Foam-Water Sprinkler Systems and Foam-Water Spray Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

17-1994

Dry Chemical Extinguishing Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

17A-1994

Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

18-1995

Wetting Agents

6.8.1.1.(1)

NFPA

30-1996

Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code

4.2.7.7.(1)

NFPA

30B-1994

Manufacture and Storage of Aerosol Products

3.2.5.2.(1)
3.2.5.5.(1)

NFPA

32-1996

Drycleaning Plants

5.6.2.1.(1)

NFPA

37-1994

Installation and Use of Stationary Combustion Engines and Gas Turbines

4.3.12.2.(1)

NFPA

51-1997

Design and Installation of Oxygen-Fuel Gas Systems for Welding, Cutting and Allied Processes

5.2.2.4.(1)

NFPA

68-1994

Venting of Deflagrations

3.2.8.2.(1)
4.2.9.6.(1)
4.3.13.3.(1)
4.8.3.1.(1)
4.8.4.2.(1)
5.3.1.6.(2)
5.6.1.5.(1)

NFPA

69-1997

Explosion Prevention Systems

4.3.2.5.(2)
4.8.4.2.(1)
5.3.1.7.(2)

NFPA

72-1990

Installation, Maintenance and Use of Protective Signalling Systems

6.3.1.4.(1)

NFPA

82-1994

Incinerators, Waste and Linen Handling Systems and Equipment

2.6.2.2.(1)

NFPA

86-1995

Ovens and Furnaces

5.6.1.7.(1)

NFPA

91-1995

Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials

3.2.2.3.(6)
5.3.1.3.(2)
5.3.2.1.(1)
5.7.4.3.(1)

NFPA

96-1998

Ventilation Control and Fire Protection of Commercial Cooking Equipment

2.6.1.9.(2)

NFPA

170-1994

Standard for Fire Safety Symbols

2.8.2.7.(4)

NFPA

231-1995

General Storage

3.2.1.1.(1)
3.2.2.4.(3)
3.2.3.3.(2)
3.2.3.3.(3)

NFPA

231C-1995

Rack Storage of Materials

3.2.3.3.(2)
3.2.3.3.(3)

NFPA

231D-1994

Storage of Rubber Tires

3.2.4.3.(1)

NFPA

303-1995

Fire Protection Standard for Marinas and Boatyards

2.16.1.1.(1)

NFPA

505-1996

Powered Industrial Trucks

3.1.3.1.(1)

NFPA

664-1993

Prevention of Fires and Explosions in Wood Processing and Woodworking Facilities

5.3.2.1.(1)

NFPA

701-1996

Fire Tests for Flame-Resistant Textiles and Films

2.3.2.2.(1)
2.9.2.1.(1)

NRCan

Explosives Ac t and its Regulations

3.1.1.3.(1)
5.1.1.2.(1)

NRCan

Fireworks Manual (1991)

5.1.1.3.(1)

TC

Airport Regulations of the Aeronautics Act

2.13.1.1.(1)

TC

Transportation of Dangerous Goods Ac t (Canada) and its Regulations (TDGR)

1.2.1.2.(1)
1.2.2.1.(1)
3.1.2.1.(1)
3.1.2.5.(1)
Table 3.2.7.1.
3.2.7.1.(2)
3.2.7.14.(1)
3.2.7.14.(4)
3.2.7.15.(2)
3.3.4.1.(3)
4.1.1.1.(3)
4.2.3.1.(1)
4.2.3.2.(2)

TC

CTC 1977-3 RAIL

Pipe Crossings under Railways
(No. E-10) Regulations

4.4.7.4.(3)

TC

CTC 1982-8 RAIL

Railway Prevention of Electric Sparks Regulations

4.6.4.5.(2)
4.7.5.1.(1)

TC

General Order No. O-32

Flammable Liquids Bulk Storage Regulations

4.4.7.4.(4)
4.6.2.2.(1)
4.6.4.1.(2)

TC

General Order No. O-36

Ammonium Nitrate Storage Facilities Regulations

3.2.9.2.(1)

ULC

C558-1975

Internal Combustion Engine-Powered Industrial Trucks

3.1.3.1.(2)

ULC

C583-1974

Electric Battery Powered Industrial Trucks

3.1.3.1.(3)

ULC

C842-M1984

Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.8.1.(1)

ULC

C1275-1984

Storage Cabinets for Flammable Liquid Containers

4.2.10.5.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S109-M87

Flame Tests of Flame-Resistant Fabrics and Films

2.3.2.1.(1)

ULC

CAN4-S111-M95

Fire Tests for Air Filter Units

5.4.3.3.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S503-M90

Carbon Dioxide Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers

6.2.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S504-M86

Dry Chemical and Dry Powder Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers

6.2.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S507-92

9 Litre Stored Pressure Water Type Fire Extinguishers

6.2.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S508-M90

Rating and Fire Testing of Fire Extinguishers and Class D Extinguishing Media

6.2.2.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S512-M87

Halogenated Agent Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers

6.2.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S531-M87

Smoke Alarms

2.1.3.3.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S536-M97

Inspection and Testing of Fire Alarm Systems

6.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

ULC-S601-93

Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Horizontal Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN4-S601(A)-1991

Shop Refurbishing of Steel Aboveground Horizontal Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.10.4.2.(3)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S602-M92

Aboveground Steel Tanks for Fuel Oil and Lubricating Oil

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S603-92

Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.15.4.(5)

ULC

CAN4-S603(A)-1992

Refurbishing of Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.10.4.2.(3)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S603.1-92

Galvanic Corrosion Protection Systems for Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.8.5.(1)
4.3.9.1.(1)
4.4.3.1.(2)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S612-M88

Hose for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.5.5.1.(1)

ULC

CAN4-S615-M83

Reinforced Plastic Underground Tanks for Petroleum Products

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.8.5.(2)
4.3.15.4.(5)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S620-M90

Hose Nozzle Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.8.1.(2)
4.5.5.2.(1)

ULC

ULC-S630-93

Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Vertical Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.3.2.(1)

ULC

CAN4-S630(A)-1991

Shop Refurbishing of Steel Aboveground Vertical Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.10.4.2.(3)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S633-M90

Flexible Underground Hose Connectors for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.7.13.(2)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S642-M87

Compounds and Tapes for Threaded Pipe Joints

4.4.5.1.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S643-M90

Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Utility Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S644-M90

Emergency Breakaway Fittings for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.5.5.2.(4)

ULC

CAN/ULC-S651-M90

Emergency Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.8.1.(3)
4.5.6.3.(1)

ULC

ULC-S652-93

Tank Assemblies for Collection of Used Oil

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

ULC-S653-94

Aboveground Steel Contained Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C30-1995

Safety Containers

4.1.5.9.(2)
4.2.3.1.(1)
4.2.6.4.(1)
5.7.5.2.(2)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C58.9-1997

Secondary Containment Liners for Underground and Aboveground Flammable and Combustible Liquid Tanks

4.3.7.2.(2)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C58.10-1992

Jacketed Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.9.1.(2)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C58.12-1992

Leak Detection Devices (Volumetric Type) for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks

4.3.15.1.(3)
4.3.16.2.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C58.14-1992

Nonvolumetric Leak Detection Devices for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks

4.3.15.1.(3)
4.3.16.2.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C58.15-1992

Overfill Protection Devices for Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks

4.3.1.8.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C107.4-1992

Ducted Flexible Underground Piping Systems for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.2.1.(3)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C107.7-1993

Glass Fibre Reinforced Plastic Pipe and Fittings for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.4.2.1.(3)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C107.12-1992

Line Leak Detection Devices for Flammable Liquid Piping

4.4.6.7.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C142.5-1992

Concrete Encased Steel Aboveground Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C142.16-1994

Protected Aboveground Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.3.1.2.(1)
4.3.2.1.(7)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C142.23-1991

Aboveground Waste Oil Tanks

4.3.1.2.(1)

ULC

ULC/ORD-C410A-1994

Absorbents for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.1.6.3.(4)

Section 1.2. �� Definitions

1.2.1. �� Terms

1.2.1.1. Non-Defined Terms

������������ 1)�� Words and phrases that are not included in the list of definitions in Article 1.2.1.2. shall have the meanings which are commonly assigned to them in the context in which they are used in this Code, taking into account the specialized use of terms by the various trades and professions to which the terminology applies.

1.2.1.2. Defined Terms

������������ 1)�� The words and terms used in this Code that are in italics have the following meanings:

Access to exit means that part of a means of egress within a floor area that provides access to an exit serving the floor area.

Act means the Fire Services Act.

Air-supported structure means a structure consisting of a pliable membrane which achieves and maintains its shape and support by internal air pressure.

Alarm Signal means an audible signal transmitted throughout a zone or zones or throughout a building to advise occupants that a fire emergency exists.

Alert Signal means an audible signal to advise designated persons of a fire emergency.

Appliance means a device to convert fuel into energy and includes all components, controls, wiring and piping required to be part of the device by the applicable standard referred to in this Code.

Assembly occupancy (Group A) means the occupancy or the use of a building, or part thereof, by a gathering of persons for civic, political, travel, religious, social, educational, recreational or like purposes, or for the consumption of food or drink.

Atmospheric storage tank means a storage tank designed to operate at pressures from atmospheric to 3.5 kPa (gauge).

Authority having jurisdiction means the fire commissioner, inspectors and local assistants to the fire commissioner.

Basement means a storey or storeys of a building located below the first storey.

Breeching means a flue pipe or chamber for receiving flue gases from one or more flue connections and for discharging these gases through a single flue connection.

Building means any structure used or intended for supporting or sheltering any use or occupancy.

Business and personal services occupancy (Group D) means the occupancy or use of a building or part thereof for the transaction of business or the rendering or receiving of professional or personal services.

Care or detention occupancy (Group B) means the occupancy or use of a building or part thereof by persons who require special care or treatment because of cognitive or physical limitations or by persons who are restrained from, or are incapable of, self preservation because of security measures not under their control.

Chimney means a primarily vertical shaft enclosing at least one flue for conducting flue gases to the outdoors.

Class A fire means a fire involving combustible materials such as wood, cloth and paper.

Class B fire means a fire involving a flammable liquid or combustible liquid, fat or grease.

Class C fire means a fire involving energized electrical equipment.

Class D fire means a fire involving a combustible metal.

Closed container means a container so sealed by means of a lid or other device that neither liquid nor vapour will escape from it at ordinary temperatures.

Closure means a device or assembly for closing an opening through a fire separation or an exterior wall, such as a door, a shutter, wired glass or glass block, and includes all components such as hardware, closing devices, frames and anchors.

Combustible construction means that type of construction that does not meet the requirements for noncombustible construction.

Combustible dusts means dusts and particles ignitable and liable to produce an explosion.

Combustible fibres means finely divided combustible vegetable or animal fibres and thin sheets or flakes of such materials which in a loose, unbaled condition present a flash fire hazard, including cotton, wool, hemp, sisal, jute, kapok, paper and cloth.

Combustible liquid means a liquid having a flash point at or above 37.8�C and below 93.3�C. (See Subsection 4.1.2.)

Community care facilities means community care facilities as defined in the Community Care Facility Act.

Dangerous goods means those products or substances which are regulated by the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Act (Canada) " and its Regulations. (See Table 3.2.7.1.)

Distilled beverage alcohol means a beverage that is produced by fermentation and contains more than 20% by volume of water-miscible alcohol.

Distillery means a process plant where distilled beverage alcohols are produced, concentrated or otherwise processed, and includes facilities on the same site where the concentrated products may be blended, mixed, stored or packaged.

Dwelling unit means a suite operated as a housekeeping unit, used or intended to be used as a domicile by one or more persons and usually containing cooking, eating, living, sleeping and sanitary facilities.

Electrical service room means a room or space provided in a building to accommodate building electrical service equipment and constructed in accordance with the British Columbia Building Code.

Electrical service vault means an isolated enclosure, either above or below ground, with fire resisting walls, ceilings and floors for the purpose of housing transformers and other electrical equipment.

Exit means that part of a means of egress, including doorways, that leads from the floor area it serves, to a separate building, an open public thoroughfare, or an exterior open space protected from fire exposure from the building and having access to an open public thoroughfare. (See Appendix A.)

Fire compartment means an enclosed space in a building that is separated from all other parts of the building by enclosing construction providing a fire separation having a required fire-resistance rating.

Fire damper means a closure which consists of a damper installed in an air distribution system or a wall or floor assembly, which is normally held open but designed to close automatically in the event of a fire in order to maintain the integrity of the fire separation.

Fire detector means a device which detects a fire condition and automatically initiates an electrical signal to actuate an alert signal or an alarm signal, and includes heat detectors and smoke detectors.

Fire-protection rating means the time in hours or fraction thereof that a closure will withstand the passage of flame when exposed to fire under specified conditions of test and performance criteria, or as otherwise prescribed in the British Columbia Building Code.

Fire-resistance rating means the time in hours or fraction thereof that a material or assembly of materials will withstand the passage of flame and the transmission of heat when exposed to fire under specified conditions of test and performance criteria, or as determined by extension or interpretation of information derived therefrom as prescribed in the British Columbia Building Code.

Fire separation means a construction assembly that acts as a barrier against the spread of fire. (See Appendix A.)

Fire stop flap means a device intended for use in horizontal assemblies required to have a fire-resistance rating and incorporating protective ceiling membranes, which operates to close off a duct opening through the membrane in the event of a fire.

Firewall means a type of fire separation of noncombustible construction which subdivides a building or separates adjoining buildings to resist the spread of fire and which has a fire-resistance rating as prescribed in this Code and has structural stability to remain intact under fire conditions for the required fire-rated time.

First storey means the uppermost storey having its floor level not more than 2 m above grade.

Flame-spread rating means an index or classification indicating the extent of spread-of-flame on the surface of a material or an assembly of materials as determined in a standard fire test as prescribed in the British Columbia Building Code.

Flammable liquid means a liquid having a flash point below 37.8�C and having a vapour pressure not more than 275.8 kPa (absolute) at 37.8�C as determined by ASTM D 323, "Vapor Pressure of Petroleum Products (Reid Method)." (See Subsection 4.1.2.)

Flash point means the minimum temperature at which a liquid within a container gives off vapour in sufficient concentration to form an ignitable mixture with air near the surface of the liquid. (See Subsection 4.1.3.)

Floor area means the space on any storey of a building between exterior walls and required firewalls, including the space occupied by interior walls and partitions, but not including exits, verticle service spaces, and their enclosing assemblies.

Flue means an enclosed passageway for conveying flue gases.

Flue collar means the portion of a fuel-fired appliance designed for the attachment of the flue pipe or breeching.

Flue pipe means the pipe connecting the flue collar of an appliance to a chimney.

Fuel dispensing station means any premises at which flammable liquids or combustible liquids are dispensed from fixed equipment into the fuel tank of a motor vehicle or watercraft.

Heat detector means a fire detector designed to operate at a pre-determined temperature or rate of temperature rise.

High hazard industrial occupancy (Group F, Division 1) means an industrial occupancy containing sufficient quantities of highly combustible and flammable or explosive materials which, because of their inherent characteristics, constitute a special fire hazard.

Individual storage area means the area occupied by piles, bin boxes, racks or shelves, including subsidiary aisles providing access to the stored products, which is separated from adjacent storage by aisles not less than 2.4 m in width. (SeeAppendix A.)

Industrial occupancy (Group F) means the occupancy or use of a building or part thereof for the assembling, fabricating, manufacturing, processing, repairing or storing of goods and materials.

Inspector means an inspector with the Office of the Fire Commissioner.

Interconnected floor space means superimposed floor areas or parts of floor areas in which floor assemblies that are required to be fire separations are penetrated by openings that are not provided with closures.

Low hazard industrial occupancy (Group F, Division 3) means an industrial occupancy in which the combustible content is not more than 50 kg/m2 or 1 200 MJ/m2 of floor area.

Low pressure storage tank means a storage tank designed to operate at pressures greater than 3.5 kPa (gauge) to 100 kPa (gauge).

Lower explosive limit means the minimum concentration of vapour in air at which the propagation of flame occurs on contact with a source of ignition.

Major occupancy means the principal occupancy for which a building or a part thereof is used or intended to be used, and shall be deemed to include the subsidiary occupancies which are an integral part of the principal occupancy.

Marine fuel dispensing station means a fuel dispensing station at which flammable liquids or combustible liquids are put into the fuel tanks of watercraft.

Means of egress means a continuous path of travel provided for the escape of persons from any point in a building or contained open space to a separate building, an open public thoroughfare, or an exterior open space protected from fire exposure from the building and having access to an open public thoroughfare. Means of egress includes exits and access to exits.

Medium hazard industrial occupancy (Group F, Division 2) means an industrial occupancy in which the combustible content is more than 50 kg/m2 or 1 200 MJ/m2 of floor area and not classified as high hazard industrial occupancy.

Mercantile occupancy (Group E) means the occupancy or use of a building or part thereof for the displaying or selling of retail goods, wares or merchandise.

Noncombustible construction means that type of construction in which a degree of fire safety is attained by the use of noncombustible materials for structural members and other building assemblies.

Occupancy means the use or intended use of a building or part thereof for the shelter or support of persons, animals or property.

Occupant load means the number of persons for which a building or part thereof is designed.

Order means and includes a remedial action, an approval, a decision, a determination, a permit and the exercise of a discretion made under this Code.

Partition means an interior wall 1 storey or part-storey in height that is not loadbearing.

Pressure vessel means a storage tank designed to operate at pressures greater than 100 kPa (gauge).

Process plant means an industrial occupancy where materials, including flammable liquids, combustible liquids or Class 2 gases, are produced or used in a process. (See Table 3.2.7.1.)

Public corridor means a corridor that provides access to exit from more than one suite. (See Appendix A.)

Rack means any combination of vertical, horizontal or diagonal members that support stored materials on solid or open shelves, including both fixed and portable units.

Refinery means any process plant in which flammable liquids or combustible liquids are produced from crude petroleum, including areas on the same site where the resulting products are blended, packaged or stored on a commercial scale.

Residential occupancy (Group C) means the occupancy or use of a building or part thereof by persons for whom sleeping accommodation is provided but who are not harboured or detained to receive medical care or treatment or are not involuntarily detained.

Self-service outlet means a fuel dispensing station other than a marine fuel dispensing station where the public handles the dispenser.

Service room means a room provided in a building to contain equipment associated with building services. (See Appendix A.)

Service space means space provided in a building to facilitate or conceal the installation of building service facilities such as chutes, ducts, pipes, shafts or wires.

Smoke alarm means a combined smoke detector and audible alarm device designed to sound an alarm within the room or suite in which it is located upon the detection of smoke within that room or suite.

Smoke detector means a fire detector designed to operate when the concentration of airborne combustion products exceeds a pre-determined level.

Spray booth means a power-ventilated structure provided to enclose or accommodate a spraying operation so that spray vapour and residue can be controlled and exhausted.

Spraying area means the area that is within 6 m of any part of a spray booth and that is not separated therefrom by a vapour-tight separation.

Sprinklered (as applying to a building or part thereof) means that the building or part thereof is equipped with a system of automatic sprinklers.

Storage tank means a vessel for flammable liquids or combustible liquids having a capacity of more than 230 L, and designed to be installed in a fixed location.

Storey means that portion of a building which is situated between the top of any floor and the top of the floor next above it, and if there is no floor above it, that portion between the top of such floor and the ceiling above it.

Street means any highway, road, boulevard, square or other improved thoroughfare 9 m or more in width, which has been dedicated or deeded for public use, and is accessible to fire department vehicles and equipment.

Suite means a single room or series of rooms of complementary use, operated under a single tenancy, and includes dwelling units, individual guest rooms in motels, hotels, boarding houses, rooming houses and dormitories as well as individual stores and individual or complementary rooms for business and personal service occupancies. (See Appendix A.)

Supervisory staff means those occupants of a building who have some delegated responsibility for the fire safety of other occupants under the fire safety plan.

Tank vehicle means any vehicle, other than railroad tank cars and boats, with a cargo tank having a capacity of more than 450 L, mounted or built as an integral part of the vehicle and used for the transportation of flammable liquids or combustible liquids and including tank trucks, trailers and semi-trailers.

Unstable liquid means a liquid, including flammable liquids and combustible liquids, which is chemically reactive to the extent that it will vigorously react or decompose at or near normal temperature and pressure conditions or which is chemically unstable when subject to impact.

Vertical service space means a shaft oriented essentially vertically that is provided in a building to facilitate the installation of building services including mechanical, electrical and plumbing installations and facilities such as elevators, refuse chutes and linen chutes.

1.2.2. �� Abbreviations and Symbols

1.2.2.1. Abbreviations of Proper Names

������������ 1)�� The abbreviations of proper names in this Code shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Article. The appropriate addresses are shown in brackets following the name.

AAFC---------- Agriculture and Agri-Food Canada (Sir John Carling Building, 930 Carling Avenue, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0C5)

ACGIH--------- American Conference of Governmental Industrial Hygienists (1330 Kemper Meadow Drive, Cincinnati, Ohio 45240 U.S.A.)

AECB---------- Atomic Energy Control Board (280 Slater Street, P.O. Box 1046, Station B, Ottawa, Ontario K1P 5S9)

ANSI----------- American National Standards Institute (11 West 42nd Street, 13th Floor, New York, New York 10036 U.S.A.)

API------------- American Petroleum Institute (1220 L Street NW, Washington, D.C. 20005 U.S.A.)

ASME---------- American Society of Mechanical Engineers (22 Law Drive, Fairfield, New Jersey 07007 U.S.A.)

ASTM---------- American Society for Testing and Materials (1916 Race Street, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 19103-1187 U.S.A.)

BCBC---------- British Columbia Building Code

BCFC----------- British Columbia Fire Code

CAN------------ National Standard of Canada designation (The number or name following the CAN designation represents the agency under whose auspices the standard is issued. CAN1 designates CGA, CAN2 designates CGSB, CAN3 designates CSA, and CAN4 designates ULC.)

CCBFC--------- Canadian Commission on Building and Fire Codes (National Research Council of Canada, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0R6)

CGA------------ Canadian Gas Association (International Approval Services, 55 Scarsdale Road, Don Mills, Ontario M3B 2R3)

CGAI----------- The Compressed Gas Association Incorporated (1725 Jefferson Davis Highway, Suite 1004, Arlington, Virginia 22202-4102 U.S.A.)

CGSB----------- Canadian General Standards Board (222 Queen Street, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 1G6)

CPPI------------ Canadian Petroleum Products Institute (275 Slater Street, Suite 1000, Ottawa, Ontario K1P 5H9)

CSA------------- Canadian Standards Association (178 Rexdale Boulevard, Etobicoke, Ontario M9W 1R3)

FMEC---------- Factory Mutual Engineering Corporation (1151 Boston-Providence Turnpike, P.O. Box 9102, Norwood, Massachusetts 02062 U.S.A.)

HC-------------- Health Canada (Communications Directorate, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0K9)

IAO------------- Insurers' Advisory Organization (1989) Inc. (18 King Street East, Suite 700, Toronto, Ontario M5C 1C4)

ICAO----------- International Civil Aviation Organization (1000 Sherbrooke Street West, Montreal, Quebec H3A 2R2)

IMO------------- International Maritime Organization (4 Albert Embankment, London, SE1 7SR United Kingdom)

IRC------------- Institute for Research in Construction (National Research Council of Canada, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0R6)

IRI-------------- Industrial Risk Insurers (85 Woodland Street, Hartford, Connecticut 06102-5010 U.S.A.)

NFPA----------- National Fire Protection Association (Batterymarch Park, Quincy, Massachusetts 02269 U.S.A.)

NRC------------ National Research Council of Canada (Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0R6)

NRCan--------- Natural Resources Canada (580 Booth Street, Ottawa, Ontario K1A 0E4)

OCIMF--------- Oil Companies International Marine Forum (96 Victoria Street, 15th Floor, London, SW1E 5JW United Kingdom)

RMA------------ The Rubber Manufacturers Association, Inc. (1400 K Street N.W., Suite 900, Washington, D.C. 20005 U.S.A.)

TC--------------- Transport Canada (Public Affairs, Tower C, Place de Ville, 330 Sparks Street, 28th Floor, Ottawa K1A 0N5)

TDGR---------- Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations (see TC)

UL-------------- Underwriters Laboratories Inc. (333 Pfingsten Road, Northbrook, Illinois 60062-2096 U.S.A.)

ULC------------ Underwriters' Laboratories of Canada (7 Crouse Road, Scarborough, Ontario M1R 3A9)

UN-------------- United Nations (United Nations Plaza, New York, New York 10017 U.S.A.)

WHMIS-------- Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System (see HC)

1.2.2.2. Symbols and Other Abbreviations

������������ 1)�� Symbols and other abbreviations in this Code shall have the meanings assigned to them in this Article.

cm--------------- centimetre(s)

�C--------------- degree(s) Celsius

h----------------- hour(s)

kg---------------- kilogram(s)

kPa-------------- kilopascal(s)

L----------------- litre(s)

m---------------- metre(s)

max.------------- maximum

min.------------- minimum

min-------------- minute(s)

MJ--------------- megajoule(s)

mL-------------- millilitre(s)

mm-------------- millimetre(s)

mm2/s----------- centistoke(s)

N/A------------- not applicable

No.-------------- number(s)

pS/m------------ pico Siemens per metre

s----------------- second(s)

>----------------- greater than

----------- less than or equal to

%---------------- per cent

Part 2 ����� Building and Occupant Fire Safety

Section 2.1. �� General

2.1.1. �� Scope

2.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Part provides for the safety of the occupants in existing buildings, the elimination or control of fire hazards in and around buildings, the installation and maintenance of certain life safety systems in buildings, the installation and maintenance of posted signs and information, and the establishing of a fire safety plan in those occupancies where it is considered necessary.

2.1.2. �� Classification of Buildings

2.1.2.1. Classification

������������ 1)�� For the purpose of applying this Code, every building or part thereof shall be classified according to its major occupancy in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code. (See Appendix A.)

2.1.2.2. Hazardous Activities

������������ 1)�� Activities which create a hazard and which are not allowed for in the original design shall not be carried out in a building unless provisions are made to control the hazard in conformance with this Code. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� No major occupancy of Group F, Division 1 shall be contained within a building with any occupancy classified as an assembly, care or detention or residential occupancy.

2.1.3. �� Fire Safety Installations

2.1.3.1. Fire Alarm, Standpipe and Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� Fire alarm, standpipe and sprinkler systems shall be provided in all buildings where required by and in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� When changes in the use of buildings or floor areas create a hazard exceeding the criteria for which the fire protection systems were designed, such fire protection systems shall be upgraded to accommodate the increased hazard.

2.1.3.2. Voice Communication Systems

������������ 1)�� A voice communication system or systems integrated with the general fire alarm system shall be provided in buildings as specified in Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code.

2.1.3.3. Smoke Alarms

������������ 1)�� Smoke alarms conforming to CAN/ULC S531-M "Smoke Alarms" shall be provided in all hotels and public buildings as defined in the Act , where required by and in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 2)�� Smoke alarms shall be installed, inspected, tested and maintained in conformance with the manufacturers' instructions.

������������ 3)�� Smoke alarms may be battery operated where permitted by the authority having jurisdiction.

2.1.4. �� Posted Information

2.1.4.1. Posting

������������ 1)�� Where a sign, notice, placard or information is required to be posted, it shall be

����������������������� a)�� clearly legible, and

����������������������� b)�� except as provided in Sentence (2), permanently mounted in a conspicuous or prominent location in proximity to the situation to which it refers.

������������ 2)�� Where the situation for which posting is required is of a temporary nature, permanent mounting need not be provided.

2.1.4.2. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Every sign, notice, placard or information that is required to be posted shall be maintained in conformance with Article 2.1.4.1.

Section 2.2. �� Fire Separations

2.2.1. �� General

2.2.1.1. Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� Where a building contains more than one major occupancy, such occupancies shall be separated from each other in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 2)�� Where rooms or spaces within a building contain a high hazard industrial occupancy, such occupancy shall be separated from the remainder of the building by fire separations in conformance with this Code and the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 3)�� Rooms, corridors, shafts and other spaces shall be separated where practicable by fire separations conforming to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.2.1.2. Damage to Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� Where fire separations are damaged so as to affect their integrity, they shall be repaired so that the integrity of the fire separation is maintained.

2.2.2. �� Closures

2.2.2.1. Openings in Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� Openings in fire separations shall be protected with closures in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 2)�� Where closures in fire separations are replaced, the replacements shall be in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.2.2.2. Damage to Closures

������������ 1)�� Where closures are damaged so as to affect the integrity of their fire-protection rating, such damaged closures shall be repaired so that the integrity of the closures is maintained in conformance with Article 2.2.2.1.

2.2.2.3. Protective Guarding Devices

������������ 1)�� Protective guarding devices shall be

����������������������� a)�� provided where necessary to prevent damage to the mechanical components of doors in fire separations, and

����������������������� b)�� installed so as not to interfere with the proper operation of the doors.

2.2.2.4. Inspection and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Defects that interfere with the operation of closures in fire separations shall be corrected, and such closures shall be maintained to ensure that they are operable at all times by

����������������������� a)�� keeping fusible links and other heat-actuated devices undamaged and free of paint and dirt,

����������������������� b)�� keeping guides, bearings and stay rolls clean and lubricated,

����������������������� c)�� making necessary adjustments and repairs to door hardware and accessories to ensure proper closing and latching, and

����������������������� d)�� repairing or replacing inoperative parts of hold-open devices and automatic releasing devices.

������������ 2)�� Doors in fire separations shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 24 h to ensure that they remain closed unless the door is equipped with a hold-open device conforming to the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 3)�� Doors in fire separations shall be operated at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that they are properly maintained in accordance with Sentence (1), as specified in the fire safety plan prepared in conformance with Section 2.8.

������������ 4)�� Closures in fire separations shall not be obstructed or altered in any way that would prevent the normal operation of the closure.

������������ 5)�� Fire dampers and fire stop flaps shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that they are in place and are not obviously damaged or obstructed.

2.2.3. �� Fire Doors

2.2.3.1. Fire Door Signs

������������ 1)�� Every door used as a closure with a required fire protection rating shall have a permanent sign acceptable to the authority having jurisdiction, posted on the visible side of the door when it is in the open position, with the words "FIRE DOOR KEEP CLOSED" except where the door is

����������������������� a)�� located between a corridor and an adjacent sleeping room in hospitals ornursing homes,

����������������������� b)�� located between a corridor and an adjacent classroom,

����������������������� c)�� located between a public corridor and a suite of Group C or D occupancy, or

����������������������� d)�� fitted with an acceptable hold-open device designed to be released by a signal from a fire detector, fire alarm system or sprinkler system. (See Appendix A.)

Section 2.3. �� Interior Finishing, Furnishing and Decorative Materials

2.3.1. �� General

2.3.1.1. Interior Finish

������������ 1)�� The interior finish material that forms part of the interior surface of a floor, wall, partition or ceiling shall conform to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.3.1.2. Movable Partitions and Screens

������������ 1)�� Movable partitions or screens, including acoustical screens, shall have a flame-spread rating not greater than that required for the interior finish of the area in which they are located.

2.3.1.3. Decorative Materials

������������ 1)�� Decorative materials on walls or ceilings shall have a flame-spread rating not greater than that required for the interior finish of the space in which they are located.

2.3.1.4. Interconnected Floor Spaces

������������ 1)�� Combustible contents in interconnected floor spaces in which the ceiling is more than 8 m above the floor, shall not exceed the limit specified in Subsection 3.2.8. of the British Columbia Building Code.

2.3.1.5. Combustible Materials Within Classrooms

������������ 1)�� Combustible materials such as teaching aids, notices and pupil work attached to walls or ceilings in school classrooms shall not exceed 20% of the area of such walls or ceilings.

2.3.2. �� Flame Resistance

2.3.2.1. Drapes, Curtains and Decorative Materials

������������ 1)�� Drapes, curtains and other decorative materials including textiles and films used in buildings shall conform to CAN/ULC-S109-M, "Flame Tests of Flame-Resistant Fabrics and Films" when such drapes, curtains and other decorative materials are used in

����������������������� a)�� any assembly occupancy or Group B, Division 1 care or detention occupancy,

����������������������� b)�� any lobby or exit, or

����������������������� c)�� any open floor areas exceeding 500 m2 in any business and personal services, mercantile or industrial occupancy, except when the floor area is divided into fire compartments not exceeding 500 m2 in area and separated from the remainder of the floor area by fire separations having at least a 1 h fire-resistance rating.

2.3.2.2. Flame Retardant Treatments

������������ 1)�� Flame retardant treatments shall be renewed as often as required to ensure that the material will pass the match flame test in NFPA 701, "Fire Tests for Flame-Resistant Textiles and Films." (See Appendix A.)

2.3.2.3. Hospital Textiles

������������ 1)�� Mattresses, bed linen, window drapes and cubicle curtains used in Group B, Division 2 care or detention occupancies shall conform to CAN/CGSB-4.162-M, "Hospital Textiles - Flammability Performance Requirements."

Section 2.4. �� Fire Hazards

2.4.1. �� Combustible Materials

2.4.1.1. Accumulation of Combustible Materials

������������ 1)�� Combustible waste materials in and around buildings shall not be permitted to accumulate in quantities or locations that will constitute an undue fire hazard. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Combustible materials, other than those for which the location, room or space is designed, shall not be permitted to accumulate in any part of an elevator shaft, ventilation shaft, means of egress, service room or service space. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Horizontal concealed spaces, such as crawl spaces and ceiling spaces, shall not be used for the storage of combustible materials.

������������ 4)�� Combustible materials shall not be stored on a roof or adjacent to any building so as to create a fire hazard to the building or its occupants.

2.4.1.2. Storage Rooms for Combustible Waste Materials

������������ 1)�� Where rooms are provided for the storage of combustible waste materials, such rooms shall conform to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.4.1.3. Waste Receptacles

������������ 1)�� Greasy or oily rags or materials subject to spontaneous ignition shall be deposited in a receptacle conforming to Sentence (4) or be removed from the premises.

������������ 2)�� All ashes shall be stored in receptacles conforming to Sentence (4) and combustible materials shall not be stored with ashes in the same container.

������������ 3)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (4), noncombustible receptacles as required in Sentences (1) and (2) shall not be placed closer than 1 m to combustible materials.

������������ 4)�� A receptacle required in accordance with Sentences (1) and (2) shall

����������������������� a)�� be constructed of noncombustible materials,

����������������������� b)�� have a close-fitting metal cover, and

����������������������� c)�� if the flooring material upon which it is placed is combustible, have a flanged bottom or legs not less than 50 mm high.

2.4.1.4. Lint Traps for Laundry Equipment

������������ 1)�� Lint traps in laundry equipment shall be cleaned after each use of the equipment.

2.4.2. �� Smoking

2.4.2.1. Smoking Areas

������������ 1)�� Smoking shall not be permitted in areas where conditions are such as to make smoking a fire or explosion hazard.

������������ 2)�� An area where smoking is not permitted in Sentence (1) shall be identified by signs conforming to Article 2.4.2.2.

������������ 3)�� Where smoking is permitted, an adequate number of ash trays shall be provided.

2.4.2.2. Signs

������������ 1)�� Signs prohibiting smoking shall have black lettering not less than 50 mm high with a 12 mm stroke on a yellow background, except that symbols of not less than 150 mm by 150 mm are permitted to be used in lieu of lettering.

2.4.3. �� Open Flames

2.4.3.1. Open Flames in Processions

������������ 1) Open flames whose quantity and method of use create a fire hazard shall not be permitted

����������������������� a)�� in assembly occupancies,

����������������������� b)�� in dining areas in Group B, Division 2 care or detention occupancies, or

����������������������� c)�� in processions.

2.4.3.2. Flaming Meals and Drinks

������������ 1)�� In Group B, Division 2 care or detention occupancies, flaming meals or drinks shall not be served.

������������ 2)�� In assembly occupancies, flaming meals or drinks shall be ignited only at the location of serving.

������������ 3)�� Refuelling of equipment used for flaming meals or drinks or for warming food shall be carried out

����������������������� a)�� outside the serving area, and

����������������������� b)�� away from ignition sources.

2.4.3.3. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� A portable extinguisher with a minimum rating of 5-B:C shall be located on the serving cart or table where flaming meals and drinks are being served.

2.4.3.4. Devices Having Open Flames

������������ 1)�� Devices having open flames shall be securely supported in noncombustible holders and shall be located or protected so as to prevent accidental contact of the flame with combustible materials.

2.4.4. �� Use of Dangerous Goods

2.4.4.1. Flammable and Combustible Liquids

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be classified, stored and handled in conformance with Part 4.

������������ 2)�� Class 1 liquids shall not be used for cleaning purposes except where such cleaning is an essential part of a process.

������������ 3)�� Spills of flammable liquids or combustible liquids within buildings shall be removed in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

2.4.4.2. Flammable Gases

������������ 1)�� Class 2.1 flammable gases shall not be used to inflate balloons.

2.4.5. �� Open Air Fires

2.4.5.1. Open Air Fires

������������ 1)�� Except for fires used for cooking in fireplaces, grills or barbecues, open air fires shall not be set unless appropriate measures are taken to limit their spread. (See Appendix A.)

2.4.6. �� Vacant Buildings

2.4.6.1. Security

������������ 1)�� Vacant buildings shall be secured against unauthorized entry. (See Appendix A.)

2.4.7. �� Electrical Installations

2.4.7.1. Use and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Electrical installations shall be used and maintained so as not to constitute an undue fire hazard.

Section 2.5. �� Fire Department Access to Buildings

2.5.1. �� General

2.5.1.1. Access to Building

������������ 1)�� Fire department vehicles shall have direct access to at least one face of every building by means of a street, yard or roadway in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.5.1.2. Access Panels and Windows

������������ 1)�� Access panels or windows provided to facilitate access for fire fighting operations shall be maintained free of obstruction.

2.5.1.3. Access to Roof

������������ 1)�� Where access to a roof is provided for fire fighting purposes, keys shall be provided for locked roof access doors and kept in a location determined in cooperation with the fire department.

2.5.1.4. Access to Fire Department Connections

������������ 1)�� Access to fire department connections for sprinkler or standpipe systems by fire fighters and their equipment shall be maintained free of obstructions at all times.

2.5.1.5. Maintenance of Fire Department Access

������������ 1)�� Streets , yards and roadways provided for fire department access shall be maintained so as to be ready for use at all times by fire department vehicles.

������������ 2)�� Vehicles shall not be parked to obstruct access by fire department vehicles and signs shall be posted prohibiting such parking.

Section 2.6. �� Service Equipment

2.6.1. �� Heating, Ventilating and Air-Conditioning

2.6.1.1. Installation

������������ 1)�� Fireplaces, solid fuel burning equipment, chimneys, flue pipes, heating, ventilating and air-conditioning appliances and equipment shall be constructed and installed in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.6.1.2. Coal and Wood Bins

������������ 1)�� Coal and wood bins shall be located not less than 1.2 m from the appliance served.

2.6.1.3. Hoods, Ducts and Filters

������������ 1)�� Hoods, ducts and filters subject to accumulations of combustible deposits shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days, and shall be cleaned if the accumulation of such deposits creates a fire hazard.

2.6.1.4. Chimneys, Flues and Flue Pipes

������������ 1)�� Every chimney, flue and flue pipe shall be inspected to identify any dangerous condition

����������������������� a)�� at intervals not greater than 12 months,

����������������������� b)�� at the time of addition of any appliance, and

����������������������� c)�� after any chimney fire. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Chimneys , flues and flue pipes shall be cleaned as often as necessary to keep them free from dangerous accumulations of combustible deposits. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� A chimney, flue, or flue pipe shall be replaced or repaired to eliminate

����������������������� a)�� any structural deficiency or decay (see Appendix A), and

����������������������� b)�� all abandoned or unused openings which are not effectively sealed in a manner that would prevent the passage of fire or smoke.

2.6.1.5. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Required clearances between chimneys, flue pipes or appliance and combustible construction shall be maintained in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 2)�� Combustible materials shall not be located within the required clearance space surrounding chimneys, flue pipes or appliances, or adjacent to ash pit or cleanout doors.

2.6.1.6. Operation and Maintenance Procedures

������������ 1) Heating, ventilating and air conditioning systems, including appliances, chimneys and flue pipes, shall be operated and maintained so as not to create a hazardous condition.

������������ 2)�� Except for self-contained systems within dwelling units, disconnect switches for mechanical air-conditioning and ventilating systems shall be operated at intervals not greater than 12 months to establish that the system can be shut down in an emergency.

2.6.1.7. Ventilation Shafts

������������ 1)�� Ventilation shafts shall be used only for ventilating purposes.

2.6.1.8. Repairs and Renovations

������������ 1)�� Work on ducts involving the use of heat producing devices for cutting, welding or soldering shall not be undertaken before

����������������������� a)�� the system has been shut down,

����������������������� b)�� the duct has been cleaned of any accumulations of combustible deposits, and

����������������������� c)�� any combustible lining and covering material that could be ignited by such work has been removed.

������������ 2)�� Precautions shall be taken, where necessary, to ensure that there is no damage to fuel supply piping or equipment that would result in fuel leakage or a fire hazard during renovations or excavation.

2.6.1.9. Commercial Cooking Equipment

������������ 1)�� Commercial cooking equipment exhaust and fire protection systems shall be designed and installed in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 2)�� Except as required in Sentences (3) to (5), the use, inspection and maintenance of commercial cooking equipment exhaust and fire protection systems shall be in conformance with NFPA 96, "Ventilation Control and Fire Protection of Commercial Cooking Equipment"

������������ 3)�� Hoods, grease removal devices, fans, ducts, and other appurtenances shall be cleaned at frequent intervals to prevent surfaces from becoming heavily contaminated with grease or other residues. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 4)�� Flammable cleaning materials or solvents shall not be used for the cleaning of exhaust systems.

������������ 5)�� Instructions for manually operated fire extinguishing installations shall be posted conspicuously in the kitchen as part of the fire safety plan.

������������ 6)�� Commercial cooking equipment which is certified shall be installed and maintained in conformance with its certification.

������������ 7)�� Uncertified commercial cooking equipment shall be installed and maintained so as not to create a fire hazard.

2.6.2. �� Incinerators

2.6.2.1. Indoor Incinerators

������������ 1)�� The installation and alteration of indoor incinerators shall conform to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.6.2.2. Outdoor Incinerators

������������ 1)�� The design, construction, installation, alteration and maintenance of outdoor incinerators shall conform to NFPA 82, "Incinerators, Waste and Linen Handling Systems and Equipment" except that the flue venting an incinerator shall not serve as the chute conveying waste material to the incinerator.

2.6.2.3. Spark Arresters

������������ 1)�� Spark arresters installed in conformance with Articles 2.6.2.1. and 2.6.2.2. shall be inspected and cleaned at intervals not greater than 12 months or more frequently where accumulations of debris will adversely affect operations.

������������ 2)�� Burnt-out spark arresters shall be repaired or replaced.

2.6.3. �� Electrical Services

2.6.3.1. Use

������������ 1)�� Storage may be permitted in electrical service rooms in conformance with the British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and pursuant regulations.

������������ 2)�� Electrical equipment vaults shall not be used for storage purposes.

2.6.3.2. Security

������������ 1)�� Electrical equipment vaults and electrical service rooms shall be kept locked so that unauthorized persons will not have access to them.

Section 2.7. �� Safety to Life

2.7.1. �� Means of Egress

2.7.1.1. Means of Egress

������������ 1)�� Means of egress shall be provided in buildings in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.7.1.2. Open Floor Areas

������������ 1)�� Aisles in conformance with Sentences (2) to (4) shall be provided in every floor area that

����������������������� a)�� is not subdivided into rooms or suites served by corridors giving access to exits and

����������������������� b)�� is required by the British Columbia Building Code to have more than one egress doorway.

������������ 2)�� Every required egress doorway shall be served by an aisle that

����������������������� a)�� has a clear width not less than 1100 mm,

����������������������� b)�� has access to at least one additional egress doorway, and

����������������������� c)�� at every point on the aisle, provides a choice of 2 opposite directions by which to reach an egress doorway.

������������ 3)�� A subsidiary aisle with only a single direction of travel to an aisle described in Sentence (2) is permitted provided it has a clear width not less than 900 mm and a length not greater than

����������������������� a)�� 7.5 m in business and personal services, mercantile and high hazard industrial occupancies,

����������������������� b)�� 10 m in medium hazard industrial occupancies, or

����������������������� c)�� 15 m in low hazard industrial occupancies.

������������ 4)�� Every individual work area in business and personal services occupancies shall be located adjacent to an aisle or subsidiary aisle.

2.7.1.3. Occupant Load

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted by Sentence (2), the maximum permissible occupant load for a floor area or part of a floor area shall be calculated on the basis of the lesser of

����������������������� a )�� the number of persons permitted for the type of use, as determined from Table 2.7.1.3., or

����������������������� b)�� the occupant load for which means of egress are provided.

������������ 2)�� Where a permanent sign indicates that a floor area or part thereof has been designed in accordance with Subsection 3.1.16. of the British Columbia Building Code for an occupant load other than that determined from Table 3.1.16.1. of the British Columbia Building Code, the occupant load for that area shall be the amount indicated on the sign.

������������ 3)�� The number of persons permitted to enter a room shall not exceed the maximum occupant load calculated in conformance with Sentence (1) or (2). (See Appendix A.)

Table 2.7.1.3.

Occupant Load

Forming Part of Article 2.7.1.3.

Type of Use

Area per
person
m2

Type of Use

Area per
person
m
2

Assembly Uses

�� space with fixed seats

�� space with non-fixed seats

�� stages for theatrical performances

�� space with non-fixed seats and tables

�� standing space

�� stadia and grandstands

�� bowling alleys, pool and billiard rooms

�� classrooms

�� school shops and vocational rooms

�� reading or writing rooms or lounges

�� dining, beverage and cafeteria space

�� laboratories in schools

Care or detention uses

�� treatment and sleeping room areas

�� detention quarters

Residential uses

�� dwelling units

�� dormitories

(1)

0.75

0.75

0.95

0.40

0.60

9.30

1.85

9.30

1.85

1.20

4.60

10.00

11.60

(2)

4.60

Business and personal services uses

�� personal services shops

�� offices

Mercantile uses

�� basements and first storeys

�� second storeys having a principal

entrance from a pedestrian

thoroughfare or a parking area

�� other storeys

Industrial uses

�� manufacturing or process rooms

�� storage garages

�� storage spaces (warehouse)

�� aircraft hangars

Other uses

�� cleaning and repair goods

�� kitchens

�� storage

�� public corridors intended for

occupancies in addition to

pedestrian travel

4.60

9.30

3.70

3.70

5.60

4.60

46.00

28.00

46.00

4.60

9.30

46.00

3.70

Notes to Table 2.7.1.3.:

��� (1)�� The number of seats in an assembly occupancy having fixed seats

��� (2)�� 2 persons per sleeping room in a dwelling unit

2.7.1.4. Signs

������������ 1)�� In assembly occupancies with occupant loads exceeding 60 persons, the occupant load shall be posted in conspicuous locations near the principal entrances to the room or floor area.

������������ 2)�� Signs required by the British Columbia Building Code to indicate the occupant load for a floor area shall be posted in conspicuous locations near the principal entrances to the floor area. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Signs required in Sentences (1) and (2) shall be in a format as directed by the fire commissioner.

2.7.1.5. Nonfixed Seating

������������ 1)�� When nonfixed seats are provided in assembly occupancies,

����������������������� a)�� except as provided in Sentence (3), the seats shall be arranged in rows having an unobstructed passage of not less than 400 mm between rows measured horizontally between plumb lines from the backs of the seats in one row and the edges of the furthest forward projection of the seats in the next row behind in the unoccupied position,

����������������������� b)�� except as provided in Sentence (2), aisles shall be located so that there are not more than 7 seats between every seat and the nearest aisle,

����������������������� c)�� except as provided in Sentence (2), the clear width of an aisle in millimetres shall be not less than the greater of 1100 or the product of the number of seats served by that aisle and 6.1,

����������������������� d)�� the width of an aisle is permitted to be reduced to not less than 750 mm when serving 60 seats or fewer,

����������������������� e)�� dead-end aisles shall not be longer than 6 m, and

������������������������ f)�� except as provided in Sentence (3), when the occupant load exceeds 200 persons,

������������������������������������ i)��� the seats in a row shall be fastened together in units of no fewer than 8 seats, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� where there are 7 seats or fewer in a row, all the seats in the row shall be fastened together.

������������ 2)�� When nonfixed seats are provided in outdoor assembly occupancies,

����������������������� a)�� aisles shall be located so that there are not more than 15 seats between every seat and the nearest aisle, and

����������������������� b)�� the clear width of an aisle in millimetres shall be not less than the greater of 1200 or the product of the number of seats served by that aisle and 1.8.

������������ 3)�� When nonfixed seats are provided at tables arranged in rows, the spacing between the nearest edges of tables in 2 successive rows shall be not less than

����������������������� a)�� 1400 mm where seating is arranged on both sides of tables (back to back), or

����������������������� b)�� 1000 mm where seating is on one side only.

2.7.1.6. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Means of egress shall be maintained in good repair and free of obstructions.

2.7.1.7. Exterior Passageways and Exit Stairs

������������ 1)�� Exterior passageways and exterior exit stairs serving occupied buildings shall be maintained free of snow and ice accumulations.

������������ 2)�� Where equipment is provided to melt snow or ice on exterior passageways and exterior exit stairs serving an occupied building, such equipment shall be maintained in working order or alternative measures shall be taken to comply with Sentence (1).

2.7.2. �� Doors and Means of Egress

2.7.2.1. Exit Doors

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2), (3) and (4), all doors forming part of a means of egress shall be tested at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that they are operable.

������������ 2)�� The safety features of revolving doors shall be tested at intervals not greater than 12 months.

������������ 3)�� Sliding doors that are required to swing on their vertical axes in the direction of egress when pressure is applied shall be tested at intervals not greater than 12 months.

������������ 4)�� When doors are equipped with electromagnetic locks, these locks shall be tested at intervals not greater than 12 months.

2.7.2.2. Records

������������ 1)�� Records of tests required in Sentences 2.7.2.1.(2), (3) and (4) shall be retained in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

2.7.3. �� Exit Lighting, Exit Signs and Emergency Lighting

2.7.3.1. Installation and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Exit lighting, exit signs and emergency lighting shall be provided in buildings in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Exit lighting and exit signs shall be illuminated during times the building is occupied.

������������ 3)�� Emergency lighting shall be maintained in operating condition, in conformance with Section 6.7.

Section 2.8. �� Emergency Planning

2.8.1. �� General

2.8.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Fire emergency procedures conforming to this Section shall be provided for

����������������������� a)�� every building containing an assembly or a care or detention occupancy,

����������������������� b)�� every building required by the British Columbia Building Code to have a fire alarm system,

����������������������� c)�� demolition and construction sites regulated under Section 2.14. of this Code,

����������������������� d)�� storage areas required to have a fire safety plan in conformance with Articles 3.2.2.6. and 3.3.2.9.,

����������������������� e)�� areas where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are stored or handled, in conformance with Article 4.1.5.6., and

������������������������ f)�� areas where hazardous processes or operations occur, in conformance with Article 5.1.5.1.

2.8.1.2. Training of Supervisory Staff

������������ 1)�� Supervisory staff shall be trained in the fire emergency procedures described in the fire safety plan before they are given any responsibility for fire safety. (See Appendix A.)

2.8.1.3. Keys and Special Devices

������������ 1)�� Any keys or special devices needed to operate the fire alarm system or provide access to any fire protection systems or equipment shall be readily available to on-duty supervisory staff.

2.8.2. �� Fire Safety Plan

2.8.2.1. Measures in a Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� In buildings or areas described in Article 2.8.1.1., a fire safety plan conforming to this Section shall be prepared in cooperation with the fire department and other applicable regulatory authorities and shall include

����������������������� a)�� the emergency procedures to be used in case of fire, including

������������������������������������ i)��� sounding the fire alarm (see Appendix A),

����������������������������������� ii)��� notifying the fire department,

���������������������������������� iii)��� instructing occupants on procedures to be followed when the fire alarm sounds,

���������������������������������� iv)��� evacuating occupants, including special provisions for persons requiring assistance (see Appendix A),

����������������������������������� v)��� confining, controlling and extinguishing the fire,

����������������������� b)�� the appointment and organization of designated supervisory staff to carry out fire safety duties,

����������������������� c)�� the training of supervisory staff and other occupants in their responsibilities for fire safety,

����������������������� d)�� documents, including diagrams, showing the type, location and operation of the building fire emergency systems,

����������������������� e)�� the holding of fire drills,

������������������������ f)�� the control of fire hazards in the building,

����������������������� g)�� the inspection and maintenance of building facilities provided for the safety of occupants, and

����������������������� h)�� a copy of the records of inspections, maintenance procedures or tests as required by Article 1.1.1.6.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan shall be reviewed at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that it takes account of changes in the use and other characteristics of the building.

2.8.2.2. Care or Detention Occupancies

������������ 1)�� A sufficient number of supervisory staff shall be on duty in care or detention occupancies to perform the tasks outlined in the fire safety plan described in Clause 2.8.2.1.(1)(a).

2.8.2.3. Assembly Occupancies

������������ 1)�� In Group A, Division 1 assembly occupancies containing more than 60 occupants, there shall be at least one supervisory staff member on duty in the building to perform the tasks outlined in the fire safety plan in Clause 2.8.2.1.(1)(a) whenever the building is open to the public.

2.8.2.4. High Buildings

������������ 1)�� In buildings within the scope of Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code, the fire safety plan shall, in addition to the requirements of Sentence 2.8.2.1.(1), include

����������������������� a)�� the training of supervisory staff in the use of the voice communication system,

����������������������� b)�� the procedures for the use of elevators,

����������������������� c)�� the action to be taken by supervisory staff in initiating any smoke control or other fire emergency systems installed in a building in the event of fire until the fire department arrives,

����������������������� d)�� instructions to the supervisory staff and fire department for the operation of the systems referred to in Clause (c), and

����������������������� e)�� the procedures established to facilitate fire department access to the building and fire location within the building.

2.8.2.5. Retention of Fire Safety Plans

������������ 1)�� The fire safety plan shall be kept in a location, designated by the authority having jurisdiction within the building, for reference by the fire department, supervisory staff and other personnel.

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan for a building within the scope of Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code shall be kept at the central alarm and control facility.

2.8.2.6. Distribution

������������ 1)�� A copy of the fire emergency procedures and other duties for supervisory staff, as laid down in the fire safety plan, shall be given to all supervisory staff.

2.8.2.7. Posting of Fire Emergency Procedures

������������ 1)�� At least one copy of the fire emergency procedures shall be prominently posted on each floor area.

������������ 2)�� In every hotel and motel bedroom the fire safety rules for occupants shall be posted showing the locations of exits and the paths of travel to exits.

������������ 3)�� Where a fire alarm system has been installed with no provisions to transmit a signal to the fire department, a sign shall be posted at each manually actuated signalling box requesting that the fire department be notified, and including the telephone number of that department.

������������ 4)�� All buildings served by one or more elevators shall have a permanently mounted fire safety sign or symbol on each floor level at each elevator entrance, which indicates that the elevator is not to be used in case of fire. This symbol shall be at least 100 mm in height and width and shall be designed in accordance with NFPA 170.

2.8.3. �� Fire Drills

2.8.3.1. Fire Drill Procedures

������������ 1)�� The procedure for conducting fire drills shall be determined by the person in responsible charge of the building, taking into consideration

����������������������� a)�� the building occupancy and its fire hazards,

����������������������� b)�� the safety features provided in the building,

����������������������� c)�� the desirable degree of participation of occupants other than supervisory staff,

����������������������� d)�� the number and degree of experience of participating supervisory staff,

����������������������� e)�� the features of fire emergency systems installed in buildings within the scope of Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code, and

������������������������ f)�� the requirements of the fire department.

(See Appendix A.)

2.8.3.2. Fire Drill Frequency

������������ 1)�� Fire drills as described in Sentence 2.8.3.1.(1) shall be held at intervals not greater than 12 months for the supervisory staff, except that

����������������������� a)�� in day-care centres and in Group B major occupancies, such drills shall be held at intervals not greater than one month,

����������������������� b)�� in schools attended by children, total evacuation fire drills shall be held at least 3 times in each of the fall and spring school terms, and

����������������������� c)�� in buildings within the scope of Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code, such drills shall be held at intervals not greater than 2 months.

Section 2.9. �� Tents and Air-Supported Structures

2.9.1. �� General

2.9.1.1. Tents and Air-Supported Structures

������������ 1)�� Tents and air-supported structures shall be in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.9.2. �� Materials

2.9.2.1. Flame Retardant Treatments

������������ 1)�� Flame retardant treatments shall be renewed as often as required to ensure that the material will pass the match flame test in NFPA 701, "Fire Tests for Flame-Resistant Textiles and Films." (See A-2.3.2.2.(1) in Appendix A.)

2.9.3. �� Fire Hazards and Control

2.9.3.1. Electrical Systems

������������ 1)�� The electrical system in a tent or air-supported structure shall be maintained and operated in a safe manner.

������������ 2)�� Portable electrical systems shall be inspected for fire hazards and defects shall be corrected before the tent or air-supported structure is occupied by the public.

������������ 3)�� The electrical system and equipment in a tent or air-supported structure, including electrical fuses and switches, shall be inaccessible to the public.

������������ 4)�� Cables on the ground in areas used by the public in a tent or air-supported structure shall be placed in trenches or protected by covers to prevent damage from traffic.

2.9.3.2. Combustible Materials

������������ 1)�� Hay, straw, shavings or similar combustible materials other than necessary for the daily feeding and care of animals shall not be permitted within a tent or air-supported structure used for an assembly occupancy, except that sawdust and shavings are permitted to be used if kept damp.

2.9.3.3. Smoking and Open Flame Devices

������������ 1)�� Smoking and open flame devices shall not be permitted in a tent or air-supported structure while it is occupied by the public.

2.9.3.4. Fire Watch

������������ 1)�� A person shall be employed to watch for fires in tents and air-supported structures occupied by the public where the facilities are designed to accommodate more than 1000 persons.

������������ 2)�� A person employed to watch for fires as described in Sentence (1) shall

����������������������� a)�� be familiar with all fire safety features, including the fire safety plan as provided in conformance with Section 2.8. and the condition of exits, and

����������������������� b)�� patrol the area to ensure that the means of egress are kept clear and that requirements of the authority having jurisdiction are enforced.

2.9.3.5. Fire Alarm System

������������ 1)�� Where tents and air-supported structures are designed to accommodate more than 1000 persons, a fire alarm and emergency communication system shall be provided.

(See Appendix A.)

2.9.3.6. Blower Engines

������������ 1)�� Internal combustion engines used to power supplementary blowers required by the British Columbia Building Code shall be operated and maintained in conformance with Section 6.7.

Section 2.10. �� Community Care Facilities

2.10.1. �� Construction

2.10.1.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� Community care facilities shall be constructed in conformance with the requirements of the British Columbia Building Code.

2.10.2. �� Staffing

2.10.2.1. Staffing

������������ 1)�� Community care facilities shall be staffed in accordance with the appropriate requirements of the Community Care Facility Act and pursuant regulations.

2.10.3. �� Combustible Materials

2.10.3.1. Combustible Materials Attached to Walls

������������ 1)�� Combustible materials such as artwork and teaching materials which are attached to walls shall not exceed 20% of the area of such walls.

2.10.3.2. Waste Receptacles

������������ 1)�� Waste receptacles shall be made of noncombustible materials.

2.10.3.3. Flammable and Combustible Liquids

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be stored in conformance with Part 4 and in areas inaccessible to children.

2.10.4. �� Fire Safety Measures

2.10.4.1. Fire Prevention Inspections

������������ 1)�� Staff members of community care facilities in which more than 10 persons are cared for shall conduct fire prevention inspections in conformance with the fire safety plan at intervals not greater than one month.

2.10.4.2. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided in community care facilities in conformance with Part 6.

Section 2.11. �� Boarding and Lodging Houses

2.11.1. �� General

2.11.1.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� Buildings altered or occupied for purposes of providing accommodation for boarders, lodgers or roomers shall conform to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.11.2. �� Fire Safety Measures

2.11.2.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� At least one portable extinguisher having a 2-A rating shall be installed in conformance with Part 6 on each storey of a building described in Article 2.11.1.1.

Section 2.12. �� Covered Malls

2.12.1. �� General

2.12.1.1. Use

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), covered malls designed for ornamental and pedestrian oriented uses only shall not be used for merchandising or public activities.

������������ 2)�� A covered mall referred to in Sentence (1) is permitted to be used for merchandising or public activities on a temporary basis provided

����������������������� a)�� it conforms to Articles 2.12.1.2. to 2.12.1.9., and

����������������������� b)�� the fire safety plan required in Section 2.8. includes additional provisions to offset any hazard that may be created by such activity.

2.12.1.2. Adequacy of Sprinkler System

������������ 1)�� Merchandising or public activities in a sprinklered covered mall described in Article 2.12.1.1. shall not be permitted where such activity will create a hazard exceeding the design criteria for which the sprinkler system was designed.

2.12.1.3. Alternatives to Spatial Separation

������������ 1)�� When a covered mall having a width of not less than 9 m has been provided for the purpose of considering each portion of the building separated by the mall as a separate building, merchandising or public activities are permitted within the required 9 m width provided alternative protection is installed in conformance with Part 1.

2.12.1.4. Access to Exits

������������ 1)�� Access to exits within a covered mall shall be provided and maintained in conformance with Subsection 2.7.1.

2.12.1.5. Access to Fire Protection Equipment

������������ 1)�� Where a covered mall is used for merchandising or public activities, the activity shall be arranged so that access to fire protection equipment, including sprinkler control valves, fire hose stations, portable extinguishers and fire alarm stations, is not restricted.

2.12.1.6. Decorative Materials

������������ 1)�� Decorative materials used for merchandising or public activities in a covered mall shall conform to Subsection 2.3.2.

2.12.1.7. Flammable and Combustible Liquids and Flammable Gases

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids , combustible liquids and Class 2.1 flammable gases shall not be used or displayed in a covered mall.

2.12.1.8. Fuelled Equipment

������������ 1)�� Where a covered mall is used for the display of fuelled equipment, batteries shall be disconnected and caps for fuel tanks shall be locked or secured against tampering.

2.12.1.9. Propane Fuelled Automotive Vehicles

������������ 1)�� A propane fuelled automotive vehicle shall not be displayed in a covered mall unless:

����������������������� a)�� the propane fuel tank is permanently installed,

����������������������� b)�� the fuel system is equipped with an automatic stop-fill valve,

����������������������� c)�� the fuel cut-off valve is closed,

����������������������� d)�� fuel tank filling connections are locked or secured against tampering, and

����������������������� e)�� batteries are disconnected.

Section 2.13. �� Helicopter Landing Areas on Roofs

2.13.1. �� Construction

2.13.1.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� Helicopter landing areas on roofs shall be constructed in conformance with the requirements for heliports contained in the "Airport Regulations of the Aeronautics Act" of Transport Canada.

2.13.2. �� Fire Safety Measures

2.13.2.1. Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� Areas or rooms communicating with the landing area shall be separated therefrom by a fire separation conforming to the British Columbia Building Code.

2.13.2.2. Fire Alarm

������������ 1)�� Where a fire alarm system is installed, a manually operated fire alarm station shall be installed on the roof at each exit from a helicopter landing area.

������������ 2)�� Helicopter landing areas on roofs shall be provided with telephone extensions or means to notify the fire department in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code.

2.13.2.3. Smoking

������������ 1)�� Smoking shall not be permitted on helicopter landing areas on roofs, and signs conforming to Article 2.4.2.2. shall be placed at the exits from the rooftop and in the vicinity of the landing area.

2.13.2.4. Fire Watch

������������ 1)�� Two persons knowledgeable in the use of fire fighting equipment shall be in attendance on the roof deck at each landing area when it is in use.

2.13.2.5. Refuelling, Repair and Maintenance Operations

������������ 1)�� Helicopter refuelling, repair and maintenance operations shall not be carried out on helicopter landing areas on roofs except in an emergency.

2.13.2.6. Inspection of Separators

������������ 1)�� Aviation fuel and oil separators provided in the drainage system shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days to ensure safe operation and shall be serviced when necessary.

Section 2.14. �� Construction and Demolition Sites

2.14.1. �� General

2.14.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to buildings or parts of buildings undergoing construction or demolition operations and includes renovations.

������������ 2)�� The degree of application of this Section to each construction project and each demolition project shall be determined as part of the fire safety plan prior to the commencement of operations. (See Appendix A.)

2.14.1.2. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� Prior to the commencement of construction or demolition operations, a fire safety plan conforming to Section 2.8. shall be prepared for the site.

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan shall include

����������������������� a)�� the designation and organization of site personnel to carry out fire safety duties, including fire watch service if applicable,

����������������������� b)�� the emergency procedures to be used in the case of fire, including

������������������������������������ i)��� sounding the fire alarm,

����������������������������������� ii)��� notifying the fire department,

���������������������������������� iii)��� instructing site personnel on procedures to be followed when the alarm sounds, and

���������������������������������� iv)��� fire fighting procedures,

����������������������� c)�� the control of fire hazards in and around the building (see Appendix A), and

����������������������� d)�� maintenance of fire fighting facilities (see Appendix A).

2.14.1.3. Fire Safety

������������ 1)�� Fire safety at construction sites and demolition sites shall conform to Part 8 of the British Columbia Building Code.

Section 2.15. �� Fire Protection for Construction Camps

2.15.1. �� Fire Protection

2.15.1.1. Fire Protection For Construction Camps

������������ 1)�� Fire protection for construction camps shall conform to the British Columbia Building Code.

Section 2.16. �� Fire Protection for Marinas and Boatyards

2.16.1. �� Fire Protection

2.16.1.1. Fire Protection

������������ 1)�� Fire protection for marinas and boatyards shall conform to NFPA 303 "Fire Protection Standard for Marinas and Boatyards".

Part 3 ����� Indoor and Outdoor Storage

Section 3.1. �� General

3.1.1. �� Scope

3.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Part applies to the storage of combustible products and dangerous goods, both inside and outside of buildings.

3.1.1.2. Radioactive Materials

������������ 1)�� Class 7 radioactive materials shall be stored in conformance with the "Atomic Energy Control Act" and its Regulations.

3.1.1.3. Explosives and Fireworks

������������ 1)�� The storage of Class 1 explosives, blasting agents, detonators, propellant explosives, pyrotechnics, fireworks and ammunition shall be in conformance with the "Explosives Act" and its Regulations.

3.1.1.4. Compressed Gases

������������ 1)�� This Part shall not apply to

����������������������� a)�� facilities operated by manufacturers or distributors at which Class 2 gases are manufactured, or containers are filled or distributed, provided that storage and handling is in conformance with good engineering practice (see Appendix A), and

����������������������� b)�� the storage and dispensing of Class 2.1 flammable gases at fuel dispensing stations covered in Section 4.5. of this Code.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in this Part, the storage and handling of liquefied petroleum gases and natural gas shall conform to the requirements of the British Columbia Gas Safety Act and pursuant regulations.

3.1.2. �� Dangerous Goods

3.1.2.1. Classification

������������ 1)�� Classes and divisions of dangerous goods referred to in this Code shall mean their primary and first subsidiary classification, as defined in Part III of the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations."

������������ 2)�� Class 9 dangerous goods shall be stored according to the hazard they present based on their properties as dangerous goods.

3.1.2.2. Ambient Temperature

������������ 1)�� Class 5.1 ammonium nitrate and Class 2 gases shall not be stored in an area where the ambient air temperature is higher than 52�C.

������������ 2)�� Dangerous goods shall be stored in refrigerated areas where such refrigeration is necessary to stabilize the substances.

3.1.2.3. Packages and Containers

������������ 1)�� Dangerous goods shall be stored in packages or containers

����������������������� a)�� made of materials that are compatible with the product they contain, and

����������������������� b)�� of durable construction and designed to resist damage from normal material handling activities.

������������ 2)�� Where the package or container for a specific type of dangerous goods is subject to a standard established by a transportation regulatory authority, such package or container shall conform with the applicable standard. (See Appendix A.)

3.1.2.4. Compressed Gases

������������ 1)�� Cylinders and tanks of Class 2 gases shall be protected against mechanical damage.

������������ 2)�� Cylinders of Class 2 gases which are in storage shall be

����������������������� a)�� protected against valve damage (see Appendix A), and

����������������������� b)�� firmly secured in a position that will not interfere with the operation of the cylinder valve assembly.

������������ 3)�� Cylinders of Class 2 gases shall be transported in devices designed to provide restraint against movement in any direction.

������������ 4)�� Except for portable fire extinguishers, cylinders of Class 2 gases shall not be stored

����������������������� a)�� in any exit or corridor providing access to exits,

����������������������� b)�� under any fire escape, outside exit stair, passage or ramp, or

����������������������� c)�� within 1 m of any exit in buildings other than industrial occupancies.

3.1.2.5. Reactive Substances

������������ 1)�� Reactive substances shall be stored according to their properties as dangerous goods in conformance with Part III of the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations." (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Reactive substances that are unstable and susceptible to reactions, such as polymerization, or self-accelerating decomposition initiated by heat, shock, vibration, light or sound waves, shall be stored in a location and manner that will prevent the undesired reaction.

������������ 3)�� Reactive substances that may react with water shall be stored in sealed containers in a dry location.

������������ 4)�� Reactive substances that ignite spontaneously in air shall be stored in a liquid that is inert to the material, in an inert atmosphere or in sealed containers.

3.1.2.6. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� In addition to the information required in Section 2.8., where dangerous goods are stored or handled, the fire safety plan shall include the names, addresses and telephone numbers of persons to be contacted in case of fire during non-operating hours.

������������ 2)�� When the dangerous goods referred to in Sentence (1) consist of Class 7 radioactive materials, the fire safety plan shall also include

����������������������� a)�� methods to control a fire emergency and to recover radioactive materials and equipment containing radioactive materials safely and efficiently,

����������������������� b)�� the names, addresses and telephone numbers of primary and alternative sources of expert radiation safety advice and assistance, and

����������������������� c)�� the location of primary and alternative sources of radiation survey instruments.

3.1.3. �� Industrial Trucks

3.1.3.1. Industrial Trucks

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), the designation, use, maintenance and operation of industrial trucks shall conform to NFPA 505, "Powered Industrial Trucks."

������������ 2)�� Fuel-fired industrial trucks shall conform to ULC-C558, "Internal Combustion Engine-Powered Industrial Trucks."

������������ 3)�� Battery-powered industrial trucks shall conform to ULC-C583, "Electric Battery Powered Industrial Trucks."

3.1.4. �� Electrical Installations

3.1.4.1. Hazardous Locations

������������ 1)�� Where wiring or electrical equipment is located in areas in which flammable gases or vapours, combustible dusts or combustible fibres are present in quantities sufficient to create a hazard, such wiring and electrical equipment shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations," for hazardous locations. (See A-5.1.2.1.(1) in Appendix A.)

Section 3.2. �� Indoor Storage

3.2.1. �� Scope

3.2.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), this Section shall apply to buildings or parts of buildings used for the short or long term storage of the following products, whether raw or waste materials, goods in process, or finished goods:

����������������������� a)�� Class I, II, III and IV commodities, and Group A, B and C plastics, in conformance with NFPA 231, "General Storage" (see Appendix A),

����������������������� b)�� rubber tires and combustible fibres,

����������������������� c)�� Level 1, 2 and 3 aerosols, as described in Subsection 3.2.5.,

����������������������� d)�� dangerous goods as described in Subsection 3.2.7., or

����������������������� e)�� closed containers of distilled beverage alcohols.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� High rack storage warehouses with storage heights greater than 13 m, where conditions exist which must be addressed by design and operational details specific to the hazard, need not conform to this Section, where alternative protection is provided in conformance with Part 1.

3.2.2. �� General

3.2.2.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Unless otherwise specified, this Subsection shall apply to the indoor storage of any product covered in this Section.

3.2.2.2. Access Aisles

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Adequate access for fire fighting purposes shall be provided and maintained to all portions of the storage area.

������������ 2)�� Access aisles not less than 1.0 m wide shall be provided to fire department access panels and to fire protection equipment.

������������ 3)�� Aisles shall be maintained free of obstruction.

������������ 4)�� A storage room or area that is greater than 100 m2 shall be provided with at least one main aisle conforming to Sentences (5) to (8).

������������ 5)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (6), main access aisles shall have a minimum width of

����������������������� a)�� 2.4 m for storage heights of not more than 6 m, and

����������������������� b)�� 3.6 m for storage heights of more than 6 m.

������������ 6)�� The width of main access aisles referred to in Sentence (5) need not exceed 2.4 m where the products are stored in racks and the building is sprinklered.

������������ 7)�� Main access aisles shall extend

����������������������� a)�� the length of the storage area where only one main access aisle is provided, or

����������������������� b)�� the length or width of the storage area where 2 or more main access aisles are provided.

������������ 8)�� Main access aisles shall be accessible from at least 2 fire department access points.

3.2.2.3. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Wall clearances of not less than 600 mm shall be maintained where stored products may swell or expand with the absorption of water.

������������ 2)�� Except where the width of storage is not more than 1.5 m, measured out from the wall, wall clearances of not less than 400 mm shall be maintained when the quantity of dangerous goods stored in a building exceeds the quantities shown in Table 3.2.7.1.

������������ 3)�� In unsprinklered buildings, a clearance of not less than 1 m between top of storage and underside of floor or roof deck shall be maintained. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 4)�� If the top of storage in piles, on shelves, in bin boxes or on racks is above the lower chords of floor or roof structural framing members, a clear space of not less than 300 mm shall be maintained between the storage and the structural members.

������������ 5)�� In sprinklered buildings, the clearance between top of storage and ceiling sprinkler deflectors shall not be less than 450 mm.

������������ 6)�� Clearance between stored products and duct or blower systems shall be maintained in conformance with Section 2-18 of NFPA 91, "Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials." (See Appendix A.)

3.2.2.4. Combustible Pallets

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2) and (3), combustible pallets shall be

����������������������� a)�� stored outdoors in conformance with Section 3.3., and

����������������������� b)�� located or protected so as to avoid creating a fire exposure hazard.

������������ 2)�� Indoor storage of combustible pallets is permitted in a building that is not sprinklered, provided

����������������������� a)�� the height of storage of combustible pallets is not more than 1.2 m,

����������������������� b)�� the width of an individual storage area is not more than 7.5 m, and

����������������������� c)�� the aggregate area of storage is not more than

������������������������������������ i)��� 100 m2 for wood or solid deck non-expanded polyethylene pallets, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� 50 m2 for plastic pallets not designated in Subclause (i).

������������ 3)�� In a sprinklered building, the storage of combustible pallets is permitted to exceed the values in Sentence (2) provided the sprinkler system conforms to NFPA 231, "General Storage." (See Appendix A.)

3.2.2.5. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 3.2.4.5., portable extinguishers shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

3.2.2.6. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� A fire safety plan conforming to Section 2.8. and Sentences (2) and (3) shall be prepared.

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan shall identify

����������������������� a)�� the product classifications, as described in Sentence 3.2.1.1.(1), for each part of the building where products of different classification are stored,

����������������������� b)�� the method of storage, including aisle widths for rack storage,

����������������������� c)�� the maximum permitted height of storage for the building or part of the building, if different,

����������������������� d)�� the maximum permitted size of individual storage areas,

����������������������� e)�� in sprinklered buildings, the sprinkler system design criteria, inside and outside hose allowances, and results of the benchmark sprinkler system main drain and water flow tests.

������������ 3)�� The storage method and maximum height of storage as described in Clauses (2)(b) and (c) shall be posted in the storage area.

������������ 4)�� Signs required in Sentence (3) shall have

����������������������� a)�� a minimum dimension of 200 mm, and

����������������������� b)�� letters not less than 25 mm high.

3.2.2.7. Location of Hazardous Materials

������������ 1)�� When the products stored include Group A plastics, rubber products, Level 2 or 3 aerosols, or dangerous goods, an up-to-date record of their location on each floor area shall be kept with the fire safety plan.

3.2.3. �� General Indoor Storage

3.2.3.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection applies to the indoor storage of Class I to IV commodities, Group A, B or C plastics, and closed containers of distilled beverage alcohol, in solid piles, on pallets, on shelves or in bin boxes or racks.

������������ 2)�� When flammable liquids or combustible liquids are stored inside an area covered in this Subsection, they shall be in conformance with Subsection 4.2.8.

3.2.3.2. Individual Storage Areas

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the size of individual storage areas shall not exceed the limits shown in Table 3.2.3.2.

������������ 2)�� In a sprinklered building, the height of storage in racks is permitted to exceed the limits shown in Table 3.2.3.2. (See Appendix A.)

Table 3.2.3.2.

Size Limits for Individual Storage Areas

Forming Part of Sentences 3.2.3.2.(1) and (2)

Product Classification

Unsprinklered Buildings

Sprinklered Buildings

Area, m2

Height of
Storage, m

Area, m2

Height of
Storage, m

Class I commodities

500

6.5

1 500

9.0

Class II commodities

500

6.5

1 500

9.0

Class III commodities, Group C plastics

250

4.5

1 000

9.0

Closed containers of distilled beverage alcohol

250

4.5

1 000

9.0

Class IV commodities, Group B plastics

250

3.6

1 000

9.0

Group A plastics

250

1.5

500

6.1

3.2.3.3. Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� Where a sprinkler system is required to accommodate individual storage areas referred to in Article 3.2.3.2., the sprinkler system shall be designed and installed in conformance with Sentences (2) to (4).

������������ 2)�� For Class I, II, III or IV commodities, and Group B or C plastics, the sprinkler system referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed and installed in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� NFPA 13, "Installation of Sprinkler Systems," where the height of storage is not greater than 3.6 m,

����������������������� b)�� NFPA 231, "General Storage," where the height of storage is greater than 3.6 m in piles, on pallets, on shelves, or in bin boxes, or

����������������������� c)�� NFPA 231C, "Rack Storage of Materials," where the height of storage is greater than 3.6 m in racks.

������������ 3)�� For Group A plastics, the sprinkler system referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed and installed in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� NFPA 231, "General Storage," where storage is on pallets, on shelves, or in bin boxes, or

����������������������� b)�� NFPA 231C, "Rack Storage of Materials," where the product is stored in racks.

������������ 4)�� For closed containers of distilled beverage alcohol, the sprinkler system referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed in conformance with good engineering practice. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.4. �� Indoor Tire Storage

3.2.4.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to buildings or parts of buildings used for the storage of rubber tires.

3.2.4.2. Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� A tire storage area designed to contain more than 375 m3 of rubber tires shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.4.3. Sprinkler Protection

������������ 1)�� Buildings regulated by this Subsection shall be sprinklered in conformance with NFPA 231D, "Storage of Rubber Tires," whenever

����������������������� a)�� the aggregate of individual storage areas in the building exceeds 500 m2,

����������������������� b)�� any individual storage area exceeds 250 m2, or

����������������������� c)�� the height of storage is more than 3.6 m, and the total volume of tires in the building is more than 375 m3.

3.2.4.4. Clearance from Sprinklers

������������ 1)�� A clearance of not less than 900 mm shall be maintained between the top of storage and sprinkler deflectors.

3.2.4.5. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� In addition to the requirements of Part 6 of this Code, multipurpose dry chemical portable extinguishers rated 4-A:20-B shall be installed in conformance with NFPA 10, "Portable Fire Extinguishers" except that

����������������������� a)�� there shall be one such extinguisher for every 500 m2 of floor area, and

����������������������� b)�� the travel distance to any extinguisher shall not exceed 25 m.

3.2.5. �� Indoor Storage of Aerosol Products

3.2.5.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to the indoor storage of packaged aerosol products as classified in Article 3.2.5.2. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.5.2. Classification

������������ 1)�� For the purposes of this Subsection, aerosol products shall be classified as Level 1, 2 or 3 in conformance with NFPA 30B, "Manufacture and Storage of Aerosol Products."(See Appendix A.)

3.2.5.3. Level 1 Aerosols

������������ 1)�� Packaged Level 1 aerosol products shall be protected as required for Class III commodities, in both palletized and rack storage, in conformance with Article 3.2.3.2.

3.2.5.4. Level 2 and 3 Aerosols

������������ 1)�� The storage of packaged Level 2 and 3 aerosol products shall conform to Table 3.2.5.4. and Articles 3.2.5.5. to 3.2.5.8.

������������ 2)�� Where storage of packaged aerosol products is mixed, protection shall be provided for the most hazardous classification present.

Table 3.2.5.4.

Maximum Amount of Packaged Level 2 and 3
Aerosol Products, kg(1)

Forming Part of Sentences 3.2.5.4.(1) and 3.2.5.5.(2)

Product Classification

Type of Dedicated Area Required

Unsprinklered Building

Sprinklered Building

None

A (2)

B (3)

None

A (2)

B (3)

Level 2 and 3

1 000

5 000

10 000

10 000

50 000

No Limit

Notes to Table 3.2.5.4.:

��� (1)�� One pallet load of packaged aerosols is approximately 1 000 kg.

��� (2)�� See Article 3.2.5.6.

��� (3)�� See Article 3.2.5.7.

3.2.5.5. Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� Where a sprinkler system is required to accommodate the storage limits in Sentence 3.2.5.4.(1), the sprinkler system shall be designed and installed in conformance with Sentence 3.2.3.3.(2), with additional sprinkler protection provided in conformance with NFPA 30B, "Manufacture and Storage of Aerosol Products" for areas in which packaged aerosol products are stored.

������������ 2)�� Where the sprinkler system required to accommodate the storage limits in Sentence 3.2.5.4.(1) does not conform to Sentence (1), the storage of packaged Level 2 or 3 aerosol products shall conform to Table 3.2.5.4. for unsprinklered buildings.

3.2.5.6. Type A Dedicated Areas

������������ 1)�� Where a Type A 1dedicated storage area is required to accommodate the storage limits in Sentence 3.2.5.4.(1), it shall be separated from the remainder of the building by

����������������������� a)�� a chain link fence conforming to Sentence (2), or

����������������������� b)�� sheet metal or other noncombustible partitions capable of withstanding the impact of rocketing cans, and extending to the underside of the roof deck or to a ceiling capable of withstanding the impact of rocketing cans.

������������ 2)�� Chain link fencing referred to in Sentence (1) shall be not lighter than 3.8 mm steel wire woven into a 50 mm diamond mesh.

3.2.5.7. Type B Dedicated Areas

������������ 1)�� Where a Type B dedicated storage area is required to accommodate the storage limits in Sentence 3.2.5.4.(1), it shall be separated from the remainder of the building by partitions

����������������������� a)�� having not less than a 1 h fire-resistance rating,

����������������������� b)�� capable of withstanding the impact of rocketing cans, and

����������������������� c)�� extending to the underside of the roof or to a ceiling of construction equivalent to the partitions.

3.2.5.8. Storage Height

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the height of storage of packaged Level 2 or 3 aerosols shall be not greater than

����������������������� a)�� 1.75 m where products are in solid piles or on pallets, or

����������������������� b)�� 6.1 m where products are on racks.

������������ 2)�� Where the building is sprinklered in conformance with Article 3.2.5.5., and an enclosure conforming to Article 3.2.5.6. or 3.2.5.7. is provided, the height of storage of packaged Level 2 or 3 aerosols shall be not greater than

����������������������� a)�� 6.1 m where products are in solid piles or on pallets, or

����������������������� b)�� the height limit determined by the design capacity of the sprinkler system where products are on racks.

3.2.5.9. Aisles

������������ 1)�� Aisles separating racks, shelves, or piles of packaged Level 2 or 3 aerosol products shall be not less than 2.4 m wide.

3.2.6. �� Indoor Storage of Combustible Fibres

3.2.6.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to the storage of combustible fibres inside buildings.

3.2.6.2. Building Construction

������������ 1)�� Buildings used for the storage of baled combustible fibres shall comply with the height and area limitations of the British Columbia Building Code for buildings classified as Group F, Division 2.

3.2.6.3. Loose Combustible Fibres

������������ 1)�� Up to 3 m3 of loose combustible fibres are permitted to be kept in any building provided storage is in a metal-lined bin equipped with a self-closing metal-lined cover.

������������ 2)�� Quantities of loose combustible fibres exceeding 3 m3 but not exceeding 15 m3 shall be stored in rooms separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 h.

������������ 3)�� Quantities of loose combustible fibres exceeding 15 m3 but not exceeding 30 m3 shall be stored in rooms separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

������������ 4)�� Quantities of loose combustible fibres exceeding 30 m3 shall not be stored in an individual room unless the room is

����������������������� a)�� sprinklered in conformance with Article 6.5.1.1., and

����������������������� b)�� separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

3.2.6.4. Baled Combustible Fibres

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2), (3) and (4), baled combustible fibres shall be stored so that

����������������������� a)�� no individual storage area exceeds 250 m2,

����������������������� b)�� the height of storage in an individual storage area does not exceed 4.5 m,

����������������������� c)�� subsidiary aisles within individual storage areas are not less than 1 m wide, and

����������������������� d)�� the clearance between piles and building walls is not less than 1 m.

������������ 2)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (4), where baled combustible fibres are stored in sprinklered buildings, the maximum area of any individual storage area shall be 500 m2.

������������ 3)�� Where baled raw pulp is stored in an unsprinklered building,

����������������������� a)�� the maximum area of any individual storage area shall be 500 m2, and

����������������������� b)�� the maximum height of storage shall be 6 m.

������������ 4)�� Where baled raw pulp is stored in a sprinklered building,

����������������������� a)�� the maximum area of any individual storage area shall be 1 000 m2, and

����������������������� b)�� the maximum height of storage shall be 6 m.

������������ 5)�� The sides of baled storage piles shall be inclined back from the base of the pile with a slope of not less than 1 m for each 10 m of height.

3.2.6.5. Clearance from Sprinklers

������������ 1)�� The clearance between the top of any pile and sprinkler head deflectors shall be not less than 900 mm.

3.2.6.6. Heating Equipment

������������ 1)�� Storage areas for combustible fibres shall not contain fuel-fired appliances or electrical heating elements.

������������ 2)�� Shields shall be provided that will prevent stored material from coming within 300 mm of any part of a heating system.

3.2.7. �� Indoor Storage of Dangerous Goods

3.2.7.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Part 4 or otherwise specified in this Code, this Subsection shall apply to buildings or parts of buildings where dangerous goods in packages or containers are stored in a single fire compartment in quantities greater than those shown in Table 3.2.7.1.

������������ 2)�� When a product has a primary and a subsidiary classification, the quantities referred to in Sentence (1) shall be determined by

����������������������� a)�� using the classification having precedence as established in Schedule I of Section 3.8. of the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations," or

����������������������� b)�� using the lesser of the two small quantity exemptions in Table 3.2.7.1. when the precedence referred to in Clause (a) is not established.

Table 3.2.7.1.

Small Quantity Exemptions for Dangerous Goods

Forming Part of Sentences 3.2.2.3.(2), 3.2.7.1.(1) and (2), and 3.3.4.1.(2) and (3)

Class (1)

Dangerous Goods

Maximum Exempt Amount

1

Explosives

(See Subsection 3.1.1.)

2

Gases

������ Division 1 (1) Flammable

������ Division 2 Non-flammable

������ Division 3 Poisonous

������ Division 4 Corrosive

25 kg (2)

150 kg

0

0

3

Flammable Liquids and Combustible Liquids

0 (3)

4

Flammable Solids

������ Division 1 Flammable solids

������ Division 2 Subject to spontaneous ignition

������ Division 3 Reactive with water

100 kg (4)

50 kg

50 kg

5

Oxidizing Substances

������ Division 1 Oxidizers

������ Division 2 Organic peroxides

200 kg or 250 L

100 kg or 100 L

6

Poisonous and Infectious Substances

������ Division 1 Poisonous substances

������������ Packing Group I

������������ Packing Group II

������������ Packing Group III

������ Division 2 Infectious substances

0

100 kg or 100 L

1 000 kg or 1 000 L

0

7

Radioactive Materials

(See Subsection 3.1.1.)

8

Corrosive Substances

������ Packing Group I

������ Packing Group II

������ Packing Group III

500 kg or 500 L

1 000 kg or 1 000 L

2 000 kg or 2 000 L

9

Miscellaneous

������ Division 1 Miscellaneous

������ Division 2 Environmental hazard

������ Division 3 Specific wastes

See Article 3.1.2.1. (6)

See Article 3.1.2.1. (6)

See Article 3.1.2.1. (6)

Notes to Table 3.2.7.1.:

��� (1)�� The numbers refer to the class and division of dangerous goods , as defined in the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations."

��� (2)�� See A-3.2.8.2.(2) in Appendix A.

��� (3)�� See Part 4.

��� (4)�� 50 kg for nitrocellulose based products, and 10 kg for "strike anywhere" matches.

��� (5)�� The "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Act (Canada)" defines "packing group" as "a level of hazard inherent to dangerous goods ." Packing Group I products are more hazardous than Packing Group III products.

��� (6)�� Small quantity exemptions may be determined by other authorities such as the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Act (Canada)," the "Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System" (WHMIS), and environmental protection legislation.

3.2.7.2. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Heating appliances shall not be permitted in a fire compartment used for the storage of Class 2.1, 3, 4 or 5 dangerous goods unless they are installed in a manner that will not create a fire or explosion hazard.

������������ 2)�� Smoking shall not be permitted within a fire compartment used for the storage of dangerous goods and signs shall be posted in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Subsection 3.1.3. and in Section 5.2., open flames and spark-producing devices shall not be used in an area where dangerous goods are stored.

3.2.7.3. Ambient Conditions

������������ 1)�� Rooms or parts of buildings used for the storage of dangerous goods

����������������������� a)�� shall be dry and cool, and

����������������������� b)�� where the products being stored are capable of releasing flammable vapours or toxic gases under normal ambient conditions, shall be provided with a ventilation system to exhaust such vapours or gases outdoors to an area where they will not return to the building (see Appendix A).

3.2.7.4. Housekeeping

������������ 1)�� Areas where dangerous goods are stored shall be kept free of waste packaging materials, debris of any kind, or any spilled product.

������������ 2)�� Broken packages or containers of dangerous goods shall be moved to a safe location and the product repackaged and labelled as soon as possible.

3.2.7.5. Storage Arrangements

������������ 1)�� The method of storage of dangerous goods shall

����������������������� a)�� be determined to ensure stability of the stored products, and

����������������������� b)�� except as provided in Sentences (2) and (5), not exceed the maximum heights of storage shown in Table 3.2.7.5.

������������ 2)�� Storage heights for a protected storage area in Table 3.2.7.5. are permitted to be exceeded provided the dangerous goods are stored on racks or shelves.

Table 3.2.7.5.

Storage Height Limits for Dangerous Goods, m

Forming Part of Sentences 3.2.7.5.(1) and (2)

Classification (1)

Unprotected Storage

Protected Storage

Packing Group I

1.8

2.4

Packing Group II

2.4

4

Packing Group III

4.5

6

Notes to Table 3.2.7.5.:

(1) See Table 3.2.7.1.

������������ 3)�� When a storage area is required by this Article to be protected, it shall be sprinklered or protected with a special fire suppression system, in conformance with Part 6 and good engineering practice with respect to specific dangerous goods. (See A-3.2.7.9.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 4)�� Except for Class 2 gases, stored dangerous goods shall be kept not less than 100 mm above the floor level.

������������ 5)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be stored in conformance with Part 4.

������������ 6)�� Solid and liquid Class 5 oxidizing substances shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

������������ 7)�� Reactive substances shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h. (See A-3.1.2.5.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 8)�� Packages or containers of Class 5.2 organic peroxides shall not be opened, or the product dispensed, in the same area where it is stored.

3.2.7.6. Separation from Other Dangerous Goods

������������ 1)�� Except as required in Sentences (2) and (3) , dangerous goods shall be separated from other dangerous goods in conformance with Table 3.2.7.6.

������������ 2)�� In addition to the separation requirements in Sentence (1), dangerous goods shall be stored in conformance with the information provided in the Material Safety Data Sheet for the specific dangerous good. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Flammable liquids or combustible liquids or Class 8 corrosive substances shall not be stored with Class 7 radioactive materials in quantities or in a manner that would constitute an undue risk in the event of a fire.

Table 3.2.7.6.

Separation Chart for Storage of Dangerous Goods

Forming Part of Sentences 3.2.7.6.(1), 3.2.7.9.(2), 3.3.4.3.(2) and 4.2.2.3.(2)

Classification (1)

2.1

2.2

2.3

2.4

3

4.1

4.2

4.3

5.1

5.2

6

8

2.1

-

P

X

X

P

P

A

DS

X

X

X

X

2.2

P

-

P

P

P

P

P

P

P

P

P

P

2.3

X

P

-

A

X

A

A

DS

A

X

P

A

2.4

X

P

A

-

X

A

A

DS

A

X

DS

A

3

P

P

X

X

-

P

A

A

X

X

DS

A

4.1

P

P

A

A

P

-

A

DS

X

X

DS

A

4.2

A

P

A

A

A

A

-

DS

X

X

DS

A

4.3

DS

P

DS

DS

A

DS

DS

-

X

X

DS

X

5.1

X

P

A

A

X

X

X

X

-

P

A

X

5.2

X

P

X

X

X

X

X

X

P

-

X

X

6

X

P

P

DS

DS

DS

DS

DS

A

X

-

A

8

X

P

A

A

A

A

A

X

X

X

A

-

�� X Incompatible goods, do not store together in same fire compartment.

�� A Incompatible goods, separate by minimum 1 m horizontal distance.

�� P Permitted, goods are permitted to be stored together.

DS Refer to Material Safety Data Sheet.

Notes to Table 3.2.7.6.:

(1) The numbers refer to the class and division of dangerous goods in Table 3.2.7.1.

3.2.7.7. Corrosion Protection

������������ 1)�� Measures shall be taken to prevent or minimize corrosion or deterioration of shelving, racks, and piping system components, due to contact with stored dangerous goods.

3.2.7.8. Flooring Materials

������������ 1)�� Floors in areas where dangerous goods are stored shall be constructed of impermeable materials to prevent the absorption of chemicals.

������������ 2)�� Class 5 oxidizing substances shall not be stored on combustible floors or platforms.

3.2.7.9. Fire Suppression Systems

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2) and (3) and in Part 4, buildings used for the storage of dangerous goods regulated by this Subsection shall be equipped throughout with a sprinkler or other fire suppression system, designed in conformance with Part 6 and good engineering practice with respect to specific dangerous goods. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Buildings described in Sentence (1) need not be equipped throughout with a sprinkler or other fire suppression system provided that

����������������������� a)�� the sum of individual storage areas in the building used for the storage of dangerous goods, other than Class 9 dangerous goods with no other classification and those covered in Part 4 of this Code, does not exceed 100 m2, and

����������������������� b)�� the dangerous goods are

������������������������������������ i)��� separated in conformance with Table 3.2.7.6., and

����������������������������������� ii)��� stored in fire compartments separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

������������ 3)�� Buildings described in Sentence (1) need not be equipped throughout with a sprinkler or other fire suppression system provided that storage consists only of Class 2.2 gas with no Class 5 subsidiary classification.

3.2.7.10. Smoke Venting

������������ 1)�� Where the collective individual storage areas for dangerous goods exceed 10 m2 in a fire compartment, means shall be provided for manual or automatic venting of smoke and toxic gases from the storage area under fire conditions. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.7.11. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Measures to control spilled liquid or solid dangerous goods shall be provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Materials or liquids used in cleanup of spills and leakages of dangerous goods shall be

����������������������� a)�� compatible and non-reactive with the dangerous goods being cleaned up, and

����������������������� b)�� disposed of in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

3.2.7.12. Fire Department Access

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), fire department access to buildings described in Article 3.2.7.1. shall be in conformance with Section 2.5.

������������ 2)�� When the collective individual storage area for dangerous goods exceeds 10 m2, buildings regulated by Sentence (1) shall be accessible to fire department vehicles from at least 2 sides for the purpose of fire fighting. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� In buildings regulated by Sentence (1), access openings to each storey provided in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code shall be not less than 750 mm wide by 1 100 mm high. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.7.13. Labels

������������ 1)�� Products classified as dangerous goods shall display appropriate identifying labels from the time they enter a facility until they are issued as finished products or waste material. (See Appendix A.)

3.2.7.14. Placards

������������ 1)�� Individual storage areas used for storage of dangerous goods shall be clearly designated as such by posted placards conforming to the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations," and Sentences (2) to (4). (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Where storage consists of a single product, only the UN Product Identification Number (PIN) need be posted.

������������ 3)�� Where storage consists of multiple products within the same class, the individual class and division placard shall be posted.

������������ 4)�� Where storage consists of more than one class, a placard for each individual class, or the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations" Danger symbol shall be posted at the entrance to the storage area.

������������ 5)�� Individual storage areas described in Sentence (1) shall be identified in the fire safety plan as required in Article 3.2.2.6.

3.2.7.15. Training

������������ 1)�� In a building regulated by this Subsection, at least one person shall be

����������������������� a)�� trained in conformance with Sentence (2),

����������������������� b)�� in responsible charge during operating hours, and

����������������������� c)�� available to respond to a day or night emergency.

������������ 2)�� The person in responsible charge specified in Sentence (1) shall be trained in the correct procedures for the handling, storing and offering for transport of dangerous goods in accordance with

����������������������� a)�� the appropriate federal, provincial, or territorial occupational safety and health regulations, or

����������������������� b)�� in the absence of regulations mentioned in Clause (a),

������������������������������������ i)��� the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations," or

����������������������������������� ii)��� the "Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System" (WHMIS).

������������ 3)�� All employees involved in the storage and handling of dangerous goods shall be trained in safe handling procedures and correct responses to an emergency situation.

3.2.7.16. Unauthorized Access

������������ 1)�� An area used for the storage of dangerous goods shall be secured against unauthorized access.

3.2.7.17. Separation from Combustible Products

������������ 1)�� Dangerous goods and other products described in Sentence 3.2.1.1.(1) shall not be stored in the same individual storage area.

3.2.8. �� Indoor Storage of Compressed Gases

3.2.8.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Subsection 3.1.1., this Subsection shall apply to the storage of Class 2 gases inside buildings.

3.2.8.2. Flammable Gases

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), cylinders of Class 2.1 flammable gases stored indoors shall be located in a room that

����������������������� a)�� is separated from the remainder of the building by a gas-tight fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of at least 2 h,

����������������������� b)�� is located on an exterior wall of the building,

����������������������� c)�� can be entered from the exterior, and any doors into the interior of the building shall be

������������������������������������ i)��� equipped with self-closing devices, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� constructed so as to prevent migration of gases from the room into other parts of the building,

����������������������� d)�� is designed to prevent critical structural and mechanical damage from an internal explosion in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations" (see Appendix A),

����������������������� e)�� is provided with natural or mechanical ventilation in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7.,

������������������������ f)�� does not contain fuel-fired appliances or high temperature heating elements, and

����������������������� g)�� is used for no purpose other than the storage of Class 2 gases.

������������ 2)�� Cylinders of Class 2.1 flammable, lighter than air gases are permitted to be stored outside of a room described in Sentence (1) provided that,

����������������������� a)�� in an unsprinklered building of combustible construction, the aggregate capacity of expanded gas outside of the room is not more than 60 m3, and

����������������������� b)�� in a sprinklered building or in a building of noncombustible construction, the aggregate capacity of expanded gas outside of the room is not more than 170 m3.

(See Appendix A.)

3.2.8.3. Indoor Storage of Poisonous, Corrosive or Oxidizing Gases

������������ 1)�� When stored indoors, cylinders of Class 2.3 poisonous, Class 2.4 corrosive or Class 2.2 (5.1) oxidizing gases shall be located in a room that

����������������������� a)�� is separated from the remainder of the building by gas-tight fire separations having a fire-resistance rating of at least 1 h,

����������������������� b)�� is located on an exterior wall,

����������������������� c)�� can be entered from the exterior, and any doors into the interior of the building shall be

������������������������������������ i)��� equipped with self-closing devices, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� constructed so as to prevent migration of gases from the room into other parts of the building, and

����������������������� d)�� is provided with ventilation to the outdoors.

������������ 2)�� Cylinders of gases described in Sentence (1) shall not be stored in a room containing combustible materials.

3.2.9. �� Indoor Storage of Ammonium Nitrate

3.2.9.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to the storage of Class 5.1 ammonium nitrate mixtures that contain 60% or more by weight of ammonium nitrate in quantities exceeding 1 000 kg inside buildings.

3.2.9.2. Clearance from Property Line

������������ 1)�� The distance between an ammonium nitrate storage facility and the nearest property line shall conform to General Order No. O-36, "Ammonium Nitrate Storage Facilities Regulations" of Transport Canada, but in no case shall this distance be less than 8 m.

3.2.9.3. Storage Buildings

������������ 1)�� Ammonium nitrate shall not be stored in buildings that

����������������������� a)�� are more than 1 storey in building height,

����������������������� b)�� contain basements or crawl spaces, or

����������������������� c)�� contain open floor drains, tunnels, elevator pits or other pockets which might trap molten ammonium nitrate.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Buildings and bins containing bulk storage ammonium nitrate shall be designed to prevent contact with material that will cause the ammonium nitrate to become unstable or with material which may corrode or deteriorate by reason of contact with the ammonium nitrate. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� When ammonium nitrate is stored in a building, a ventilation system shall be provided to dissipate gases generated by the ammonium nitrate in the event of a fire.

3.2.9.4. Bagged Storage

������������ 1)�� Piles of bagged ammonium nitrate shall not exceed

����������������������� a)�� 6 m in height,

����������������������� b)�� 6 m in width, and

����������������������� c)�� 15 m in length.

������������ 2)�� Aisles not less than 1 m wide shall be provided in warehouses to separate piles of ammonium nitrate, and at least one aisle not less than 1.2 m wide shall be provided for the entire length of the storage area.

������������ 3)�� Bags of ammonium nitrate shall not be stored closer than 400 mm from walls and partitions and not closer than 900 mm from a roof, overhead supporting beam or sprinkler head deflector.

������������ 4)�� In palletized storage of bagged ammonium nitrate, pallet channels shall be at right angles to aisles.

3.2.9.5. Bin Storage

������������ 1)�� Bins in which ammonium nitrate is stored in bulk shall be kept free of materials which may contaminate their contents.

3.2.9.6. Explosives

������������ 1)�� Explosives shall not be used to break up caked ammonium nitrate.

3.2.9.7. Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� Bagged ammonium nitrate in quantities in excess of 600 000 kg shall be stored only in buildings sprinklered in conformance with Article 6.5.1.1.

3.2.9.8. Industrial Trucks

������������ 1)�� Fuelling of industrial trucks shall not be carried out in buildings in which ammonium nitrate is stored.

������������ 2)�� When industrial trucks powered by internal-combustion engines are parked in buildings in which ammonium nitrate is stored, they shall be separated from the storage area by fire separations having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 h.

������������ 3)�� Industrial trucks transporting ammonium nitrate shall be cleaned of remaining material following use.

Section 3.3. �� Outdoor Storage

3.3.1. �� Scope

3.3.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), this Section shall apply to the short or long term outdoor storage of the following products, whether raw or waste materials, goods in process or finished goods:

����������������������� a)�� Class III and IV commodities, and Group A, B and C plastics, as described in Section 3.2.,

����������������������� b)�� rubber tires,

����������������������� c)�� forest products, including lumber, timber and wood pallets,

����������������������� d)�� forest by-products, including wood chips and hogged material (see Appendix A),

����������������������� e)�� manufactured buildings (see Appendix A),

������������������������ f)�� wrecked vehicles in salvage yards, and

����������������������� g)�� dangerous goods as described in Subsection 3.3.4.

������������ 2)�� This Section shall not apply to:

����������������������� a)�� a site where the total storage area is not more than 100 m2, except for distance requirements between stored products and a building,

����������������������� b)�� Class I and II commodities, as classified in Section 3.2.,

����������������������� c)�� intermodal shipping containers, except when containing dangerous goods (see Appendix A),

����������������������� d)�� buried products and landfill operations,

����������������������� e)�� products stored on the roof of a building,

������������������������ f)�� vehicles in parking areas or parking lots,

����������������������� g)�� logs and similar untreated forest products in ranked piles (see Appendix A), or

����������������������� h)�� bulk products, except as described in Clause (1)(d).

3.3.2. �� General

3.3.2.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Unless otherwise specified, this Subsection shall apply to the outdoor storage of any product covered in this Section.

3.3.2.2. Height

������������ 1)�� Except as required in Subsections 3.3.3. and 3.3.4., the maximum permitted height of any individual storage area shall be determined by its base area, shape and the stability of the stored products.

3.3.2.3. Individual Storage Areas and Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the size limits and clearances for individual storage areas shall conform to Subsections 3.3.3. and 3.3.4.

������������ 2)�� An outdoor storage area shall be arranged such that there is a clear space of not less than

����������������������� a)�� 30 m between stored products and brush or forested areas, and

����������������������� b)�� 6 m between stored products and uncontrolled grass or weeds.

3.3.2.4. Storage beneath Power Lines

������������ 1)�� Products covered in this Section shall not be stored beneath electrical power lines.

3.3.2.5. Fire Department Access

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), an access route constructed in conformance with Subsection 3.2.5. of the British Columbia Building Code shall be provided to permit the approach of fire department vehicles to within 60 m travelling distance of any part of an individual storage area.

������������ 2)�� Where the total storage area exceeds 6000 m2, the access route required in Sentence (1) shall be connected with a public thoroughfare in at least 2 locations.

3.3.2.6. Fencing

������������ 1)�� An outdoor storage area shall be surrounded by a firmly anchored fence that is

����������������������� a)�� substantially constructed to discourage climbing and unauthorized entry,

����������������������� b)�� not less than 1.8 m high, and

����������������������� c)�� provided with gates that shall be locked when the storage area is not staffed.

������������ 2)�� When in a fire department access route, the gates required in Clause (1)(c) shall be of adequate width, design and in such a location as to readily permit the entry of fire department vehicles, in conformance with Article 3.3.2.5. (See Appendix A.)

3.3.2.7. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Any access route, gateway or clear space required in this Section shall be

����������������������� a)�� maintained in conformance with Section 2.5., and

����������������������� b)�� kept free of obstructions and piles of snow.

������������ 2)�� Private hydrants, fire department connections and private valves controlling water supplies to fire protection systems shall be

����������������������� a)�� maintained in conformance with Part 6, and

����������������������� b)�� kept accessible to fire fighters and their equipment at all times.

3.3.2.8. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Unless controlled in a manner that will not create a fire hazard, a device, operation or activity that produces open flames, sparks or heat shall not be permitted in an outdoor storage area. (See A-4.1.5.3.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Subsection 2.4.2., smoking shall not be permitted in an outdoor storage area.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Subsection 2.6.2., the burning of materials in an outdoor storage area shall be performed only in a burner that is:

����������������������� a)�� designed, constructed and maintained in conformance with good engineering practice, and

����������������������� b)�� located not less than 15 m from a building or stored products.

3.3.2.9. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� A fire safety plan conforming to Section 2.8. and Sentences (2) and (3) shall be prepared.

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan required in Sentence (1) shall identify

����������������������� a)�� the location and classification of the products currently stored, as described in Sentence 3.3.1.1.(1),

����������������������� b)�� the method of storage, including the clear spaces required and the maximum permitted size of individual storage areas,

����������������������� c)�� the location of fire alarm systems and fire fighting equipment, and

����������������������� d)�� the control of fire hazards in and around the outdoor storage area.

������������ 3)�� At least one copy of the fire emergency procedures shall be prominently posted at the outdoor storage site.

3.3.2.10. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Any building located in an outdoor storage area shall be provided with portable extinguishers in conformance with Part 6.

������������ 2)�� Each motorized vehicle operating in an outdoor storage area shall be equipped with at least one portable extinguisher having a minimum rating of 2-A:10-B:C and conforming to Part 6.

3.3.2.11. Site Preparation

������������ 1)�� The storage site shall be

����������������������� a)�� level, and

����������������������� b)�� solid ground or paved with asphalt, concrete or other hard surface material.

3.3.2.12. Fuel Dispensing

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the dispensing of flammable liquids or combustible liquids into the fuel tank of a vehicle shall conform to Section 4.5.

������������ 2)�� A clear space of not less than 6 m shall be maintained between the stored products and fuel dispensers.

3.3.2.13. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Provision shall be made for the safe drainage and containment mof waste oils or dangerous goods emptied or escaping from stored products under normal storage conditions or in a fire situation, in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

3.3.2.14. Fire Separation

������������ 1)�� It is permitted to reduce the clear space between individual storage areas prescribed in this Section if a noncombustible fire separation or a dirt berm, not less than 1.5 times the height of the stored products, is provided.

3.3.2.15. Fire Protection

������������ 1)�� It is permitted to increase the height and size of individual storage areas prescribed in this Section if fire extinguishing measures conforming to good engineering practice are provided.

3.3.3. �� General Outdoor Storage

3.3.3.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection applies to the outdoor storage of products other than dangerous goods.

3.3.3.2. Individual Storage Areas and Clearance

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) to (4), the size and clearances for individual storage areas shall conform to Table 3.3.3.2. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (3) and (4), a clear space of not less than 15 m shall be maintained between stored products and a building on the same property.

������������ 3)�� It is permitted to waive the clearance required in Sentence (2) if

����������������������� a)�� the stored products do not consist of wood chips, hogged material, rubber tires or combustible pallets,

����������������������� b)�� the exposed wall of the building is a fire separation having a fire resistance rating of not less than 2 h, and

����������������������� c)�� the stored products are separated from any unprotected wall opening by a horizontal distance of not less than

������������������������������������ i)��� 3 m on either side of the opening, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� 6 m perpendicularly in front of the opening.

������������ 4)�� It is permitted to waive the clearance required in Sentence (2) if an individual storage area has a base area not greater than 5 m2.

Table 3.3.3.2.

Size and Clearances for Individual Storage Areas (ISA)

Forming Part of Sentence 3.3.3.2.(1)

Product Classification (1)

Max. Base Area, m2

Max. Height of Storage, m

Min. Clear Space Around Each ISA, m

Class III and IV commodities, Group A, B and C plastics, lumber, timber, manufactured buildings , wrecked vehicles

1 000

3

6

1 000

<3 but 6

twice the height of storage

Wood chips, hogged material

15 000

18

9

Rubber tires, combustible pallets

1 000

3

15

Notes to Table 3.3.3.2.:

(1) See Sentence 3.3.1.1.(1).

3.3.3.3. Rubber Tires

������������ 1)�� Any access route required in Article 3.3.2.5. shall be located so that a clear space of not less than 6 m is provided between stored rubber tires and the nearest side of the access route.

3.3.4. �� Outdoor Storage of Dangerous Goods

3.3.4.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Part 4 or otherwise specified in this Code, this Subsection applies to the outdoor storage of dangerous goods in packages or containers.

������������ 2)�� The storage of dangerous goods in quantities greater than those shown in Table 3.2.7.1., in a single individual storage area, shall conform to this Subsection.

������������ 3)�� When a product has a primary and a subsidiary classification, the quantities referred to in Sentence (2) shall be determined by

����������������������� a)�� using the classification having precedence as established in Schedule I of Section 3.8. of the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations," or

����������������������� b)�� using the lesser of the two small quantity exemptions in Table 3.2.7.1. when the precedence referred to in Clause (a) is not established.

3.3.4.2. Individual Storage Areas and Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), the size of an individual storage area for dangerous goods shall be not greater than 1 000 m2.

������������ 2)�� A clear space of not less than 6 m shall be provided around each individual storage area for dangerous goods. (See A-3.3.3.2.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Dangerous goods shall not be stored to a height greater than 6 m.

3.3.4.3. Separation from Other Dangerous Goods

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), dangerous goods shall be separated from other dangerous goods in conformance with Article 3.2.7.6.

������������ 2)�� Incompatible dangerous goods that are not permitted in Table 3.2.7.6. to be stored in the same fire compartment shall be separated by a minimum horizontal distance of 3 m when in an outdoor storage area.

3.3.4.4. Separation from Combustible Products

������������ 1)�� Dangerous goods and other products described in Sentence 3.3.1.1.(1) shall not be stored in the same individual storage area.

3.3.4.5. Identification

������������ 1)�� The outdoor storage of dangerous goods shall conform to Articles 3.2.7.13. and 3.2.7.14.

3.3.4.6. Training

������������ 1)�� The training of personnel involved in the outdoor storage of dangerous goods shall conform to Article 3.2.7.15.

3.3.4.7. Safety Precautions

������������ 1)�� When dangerous goods are stored outside of a building, safety precautions shall be taken to prevent undesirable reactions from the effects of atmospheric conditions.

������������ 2)�� Damaged or leaking packages or containers of dangerous goods shall be moved to a safe location and the product repackaged and labelled as soon as possible.

3.3.4.8. Intermodal Shipping Containers

������������ 1)�� Intermodal shipping containers used for the transportation of dangerous goods shall be stored in conformance with the segregation requirements in Section 15 of the "International Maritime Dangerous Goods Code," of the International Maritime Organization. (See A-3.3.1.1.(2)(c) in Appendix A.)

3.3.5. �� Outdoor Storage of Compressed Gases

3.3.5.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Subsection 3.1.1., this Subsection shall apply to the storage of Class 2 gases outside buildings.

3.3.5.2. Location

������������ 1)�� Where cylinders of Class 2 gases are stored outdoors, they shall be

����������������������� a)�� supported on raised concrete or other noncombustible platforms, and

����������������������� b)�� located in an enclosure fenced in conformance with Article 3.3.2.6.

3.3.5.3. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), cylinders of Class 2.1 flammable, Class 2.3 poisonous or Class 2.4 corrosive gases stored outdoors shall be not less than

����������������������� a)�� 1.5 m from any building opening, if the aggregate capacity of expanded gas is not more than 170 m3,

����������������������� b)�� 7.5 m from any building opening, if the aggregate capacity of expanded gas is more than 170 m3 but less than 500 m3, and

����������������������� c)�� 15 m from any building opening, if the aggregate capacity of expanded gas is 500 m3 or more.

(See A-3.2.8.2.(2) in Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� The distances required in Sentence (1) need not apply when the opening referred to is into a room conforming to Subsection 3.2.8. which is used for storing Class 2 gases.

Part 4 ����� Flammable and Combustible Liquids

Section 4.1. �� General

4.1.1. �� Scope

4.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), this Part provides for the storage, handling, use and processing of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in buildings, structures and open areas. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Areas in process plants, where conditions must be addressed by design and operational details specific to the hazard, need not conform to this Part, where alternative protection is provided in conformance with Part 1 . (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� This Part shall not apply to

����������������������� a)�� the transportation of flammable liquids or combustible liquids under the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations,"

����������������������� b)�� appliances and their ancillary equipment within the scope of CAN/CSA-B139-M "Installation Code for Oil Burning Equipment,"

����������������������� c)�� the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids on farms for individual farm use and on isolated construction projects, or

����������������������� d)�� the storage of aerosol products covered under Subsection 3.2.5.

������������ 4)�� In addition to the requirements in this Part, the storage, handling and use of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in laboratories shall be in conformance with Section 5.7.

������������ 5)�� Unless otherwise specified, this Section shall apply to all areas involved in the storage, handling or use of flammable liquids and combustible liquids covered in this Part.

������������ 6)�� This part also provides for a permit system in connection with the construction and operation of bulk plants, process plants, distilleries and the installation and operation of fuel dispensing stations.

4.1.2. �� Classification

4.1.2.1. Classification

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� For the purposes of this Part, flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be classified in conformance with Sentences (2) and (3).

������������ 2)�� Flammable liquids shall be Class I liquids, and shall be subdivided into:

����������������������� a)�� Class IA liquids, which shall include those having a flash point below 22.8�C and a boiling point below 37.8�C,

����������������������� b)�� Class IB liquids, which shall include those having a flash point below 22.8�C and a boiling point at or above 37.8�C, and

����������������������� c)�� Class IC liquids, which shall include those having a flash point at or above 22.8�C and below 37.8�C.

������������ 3)�� Combustible liquids shall be Class II or Class IIIA liquids, and shall be subdivided into:

����������������������� a)�� Class II liquids, which shall include those having a flash point at or above 37.8�C and below 60�C, and

����������������������� b)�� Class IIIA liquids, which shall include those having a flash point at or above 60�C and below 93.3�C (see Appendix A).

4.1.2.2. Heated Liquids

������������ 1)�� When a liquid having a flash point at or above 37.8�C, is being processed, stored, handled or used at a temperature at or above its flash point, it shall be treated as a Class I liquid.

4.1.2.3. Used Lubricating Oil

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), used lubricating oil drained from motor vehicles shall be classified as a Class IIIA liquid.

������������ 2)�� When Class I or II liquids are added to used oils referred to in Sentence (1), the resulting mixture shall be classified by tests conforming to Subsection 4.1.3.

4.1.3. �� Flash Point

4.1.3.1. Determination of Flash Point

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (3) and (4), the flash point of liquids having a viscosity less than 6 mm2/s at 37.8�C and a flash point below 93.3�C shall be determined in conformance with ASTM D 56, "Flash Point by Tag Closed Tester."

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentences (3) and (4), the flash point of liquids having a viscosity of 6 mm2/s or more at 37.8�C or a flash point of 93.3�C or higher shall be determined in conformance with ASTM D 93, "Flash Point by Pensky-Martens Closed Cup Tester."

������������ 3)�� ASTM D 3828, "Flash Point by Small Scale Closed Tester" is permitted to be used for testing aviation turbine fuels within the scope of this procedure.

������������ 4)�� ASTM D 3278, "Flash Point of Liquids by Small Scale Closed-Cup Apparatus" is permitted to be used for paints, enamels, lacquers, varnishes and related products and their components having flash points between 0�C and 110�C, and having a viscosity less than 15 000 mm2/s (150 stokes) at 25�C.

4.1.4. �� Electrical Installations

4.1.4.1. Hazardous Locations

������������ 1)�� Electrical equipment in a location where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are present shall conform to the appropriate provincial or territorial legislation or, in the absence of such legislation, to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations." (See Appendix A.)

4.1.5. �� Fire Prevention and Protection

4.1.5.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided and maintained as required elsewhere in this Part and in Part 6.

4.1.5.2. Additional Fire Protection Equipment

������������ 1)�� In addition to extinguishers required in Article 4.1.5.1., fire protection equipment shall be provided where there are special hazards of operation, dispensing or storage.

4.1.5.3. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Unless controlled in a manner that will not create a fire or explosion hazard, a device, operation or activity that produces open flames, sparks or heat shall not be permitted in an area described in Article 4.1.1.1. (See Appendix A.)

4.1.5.4. Smoking

������������ 1)�� Except for designated safe smoking areas conforming to Subsection 2.4.2., smoking shall not be permitted in areas described in Article 4.1.1.1.

4.1.5.5. Removal of Combustibles

������������ 1)�� Areas described in Article 4.1.1.1. shall be kept clean and free of ground vegetation and accumulations of combustible materials not essential to operations.

������������ 2)�� Cleaning rags shall be stored in receptacles conforming to Article 2.4.1.3.

4.1.5.6. Emergency Planning

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), emergency planning measures conforming to Section 2.8. shall be provided for all buildings, parts of buildings and open areas described in Article 4.1.1.1.

������������ 2)�� The fire safety plan required as part of the emergency planning measures in Sentence (1) shall be retained on site for reference by the authority having jurisdiction and personnel.

4.1.5.7. Access for Fire Fighting

������������ 1)�� Required aisles and other access paths shall be maintained to permit the unobstructed movement of personnel and fire department apparatus so that fire fighting operations can be carried out in any part of an area used for the storage, use or handling of flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

4.1.5.8. Hot Works

������������ 1)�� Hot works shall be performed in conformance with Section 5.2.

4.1.5.9. Basement Storage

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2) and in dwelling units as described in Article 4.2.4.5., and in mercantile occupancies as described in Sentence 4.2.5.2.(3), Class I liquids shall not be stored, handled or used in basements or pits.

������������ 2)�� Not more than 5 L of Class I liquid is permitted to be stored in basements, provided it is stored in safety containers conforming toULC/ORD-C30, "Safety Containers."

4.1.6. �� Spill Control and Drainage Systems

4.1.6.1. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� A spill of flammable liquids or combustible liquids, including water used for fire fighting purposes, shall be prevented from flowing outside of the spill area and from reaching waterways, sewer systems and potable water sources by

����������������������� a)�� constructing a noncombustible barrier of sufficient height to contain the spill, or

����������������������� b)�� grading the site or sloping the floor to divert the spill to a drainage system conforming to Article 4.1.6.2. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� When barriers required in Sentence (1) are provided to contain accidental spillage from aboveground storage tanks, they shall conform to the requirements for secondary containment in Subsection 4.3.7.

4.1.6.2. Drainage Systems

������������ 1)�� A drainage system referred to in Clause 4.1.6.1.(1)(b) shall

����������������������� a)�� terminate at a location where such spill will not create a fire hazard or any risk to public health or safety, and

����������������������� b)�� direct the spill away from buildings, means of egress, fire department access roadways, or valves controlling the flow of flammable liquids or combustible liquids or water supplies for fire fighting.

������������ 2)�� Closed drainage systems shall be equipped with a trap. (See Appendix A.)

4.1.6.3. Spills and Leaks

������������ 1)�� Maintenance and operating procedures shall be established to prevent the escape of flammable liquids or combustible liquids to areas where they would create a fire or explosion hazard.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence (3), all reasonable steps shall be taken to recover escaped liquid and to remove or treat the contaminated soil.

������������ 3)�� Liquid spilled or leaked shall be

����������������������� a)�� flushed to a location conforming toArticle 4.1.6.2., or

����������������������� b)�� removed with the aid of an absorbent conforming to Sentence (4), and

������������������������������������ i)��� deposited in a receptacle conforming to Article 2.4.1.3., or

����������������������������������� ii)��� disposed of in a manner that does not create a fire or explosion hazard.

������������ 4)�� An absorbent required in Sentence (3) shall

����������������������� a)�� be noncombustible, or

����������������������� b)�� conform to ULC/ORD-C410A, "Absorbents for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

4.1.7. �� Ventilation

4.1.7.1. Rooms or Enclosed Spaces

������������ 1)�� Where flammable liquids and combustible liquids are processed, handled, stored, dispensed or used within rooms or enclosed spaces, ventilation shall conform to the applicable requirements of this Part and the British Columbia Building Code. (See Appendix A.)

4.1.7.2. Ventilation Measures

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), a room or enclosed space referred to in Article 4.1.7.1. shall be provided with one of the following ventilation systems:

����������������������� a)�� continuous mechanical ventilation where Class I liquids are processed, dispensed or used in a manner that releases flammable vapours into the room or enclosed space,

����������������������� b)�� either natural or continuous mechanical ventilation where

������������������������������������ i)��� Class I liquids are stored, processed, dispensed or used in a manner that does not release flammable vapours into the room or enclosed space, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� Class II liquids are processed, dispensed or used.

������������ 2)�� Ventilation referred to in Clause (1)(b) need not be provided for the storage of Class I liquids if

����������������������� a)�� storage consists of only closed containers, and

����������������������� b)�� no dispensing operations are performed.

������������ 3)�� Ventilation required in Sentence (1) shall be sufficient to ensure that flammable vapour concentrations outside the zone identified as Class I, Division 1 in conformance with Article 4.1.4.1., do not exceed 25% of the lower explosive limit of the flammable vapour. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 4)�� Where a mechanical ventilation system is installed to meet the conditions of Sentence (3), it shall be capable of exhausting at least 18 m3/h per square metre of room area, but not less than 250 m3/h.

������������ 5)�� Where continuous mechanical ventilation is installed in order to meet the conditions of Sentence (1), it shall

����������������������� a)�� be provided with automatic interlocks so that the activity generating flammable vapours cannot be performed when the ventilation system is not in operation, and

����������������������� b)�� sound an audible alarm in an attended area upon shut-down of the ventilation system.

4.1.7.3. Location of Air Inlets and Outlets

������������ 1)�� Ventilation air inlets and outlets within a room or enclosed space referred to in Article 4.1.7.1. shall be arranged in conformance with Sentences (2) to (4).

������������ 2)�� Where the flammable vapour being removed is heavier than air,

����������������������� a)�� at least one air inlet shall be located at a point near a wall, and no higher than 300 mm from the floor, and

����������������������� b)�� at least one air outlet shall be located near the opposite wall, no higher than 300 mm from the floor.

������������ 3)�� Where the flammable vapour being removed is lighter than air,

����������������������� a)�� at least one air inlet shall be located at a point near a wall, and no lower than 300 mm from the ceiling, and

����������������������� b)�� at least one air outlet shall be located near the opposite wall, no lower than 300 mm from the ceiling.

������������ 4)�� When the average air velocity in the room exceeds 0.5 m/s, make-up air shall be provided in conformance with Article 4.1.7.5.

4.1.7.4. Location of Mechanical Ventilation Exhaust Air Outlets

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.1.7.6., the exhaust air outlet from a mechanical ventilation system required in Article 4.1.7.2. shall be

����������������������� a)�� located outdoors, not less than 3 m from any building opening, and

����������������������� b)�� arranged so that the exhaust air does not discharge toward any unprotected opening within 7.5 m of the discharge point.

4.1.7.5. Make-up Air

������������ 1)�� Where make-up air for a mechanical ventilation system is taken from within the building, the opening into the room or enclosed space shall be provided with a fire damper.

������������ 2)�� Make-up air for a natural or mechanical ventilation system shall be taken from a point remote from any exhaust air discharge described in Article 4.1.7.4.

������������ 3)�� Make-up air for a natural ventilation system shall be taken from a point outside the building.

4.1.7.6. Recirculating Ventilation Systems

������������ 1)�� Where a mechanical ventilation system is installed in conformance with Article 4.1.7.2., and where exhaust air is recirculated, a fail-safe vapour detection and alarm system shall be provided

����������������������� a)�� to continuously monitor the flammable vapour concentration in the exhaust air, and

����������������������� b)�� if the vapour concentration in Clause (a) exceeds 25% of the lower explosive limit of the vapour, to

������������������������������������ i)��� sound an alarm,

����������������������������������� ii)��� stop the recirculation of air, and

���������������������������������� iii)��� redirect the exhaust air to an outdoor location.

4.1.7.7. Exclusive Use of Ducts

������������ 1)�� Ducts used in a ventilation system conforming to Article 4.1.7.2. shall not be used for any other ventilation or exhaust system.

4.1.7.8. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Inlet and exhaust openings and associated ducts shall be kept free of any obstructions that may interfere with the operation of the ventilation system.

4.1.8. �� Handling of Flammable and Combustible Liquids

4.1.8.1. Containers and Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� All flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be stored in containers conforming to Subsection 4.2.3. or in storage tanks conforming to Subsection 4.3.1.

������������ 2)�� Containers and storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be kept closed when not in use.

4.1.8.2. Control of Static Electric Charge

������������ 1)�� When Class I liquids are dispensed into a container or a storage tank,

����������������������� a)�� if made of metallic or electrically conducting material, such container or tank shall be electrically connected to the fill stem, or rest on a conductive floor that is electrically connected to the fill stem, or

����������������������� b)�� if the container or tank is made of non-electrically conducting material, measures shall be taken to minimize the potential for static electric charge to develop (see Appendix A).

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence (3), when Class I liquids are transferred into a storage tank through the top of the tank, the fill pipe shall terminate within 150 mm of the bottom of the tank.

������������ 3)�� Sentence (2) shall not apply when

����������������������� a)�� the storage tank vapour space cannot exceed 25% of the lower explosive limit or is filled with an inert gas that prevents the ignition of the vapour mixture, or

����������������������� b)�� the liquid being transferred has a minimum conductivity that prevents the accumulation of static electricity (see Appendix A).

������������ 4)�� Fill pipes referred to in Sentence (2) shall be installed in such a way as to minimize vibration of the pipe.

4.1.8.3. Transfer

������������ 1)�� Class I liquids shall be drawn from or transferred into containers or storage tanks within a building

����������������������� a)�� through a piping or transfer system conforming to Section 4.4.,

����������������������� b)�� by means of a pump designed in conformance with good engineering practice on top of the container or storage tank, or

����������������������� c)�� by gravity through a self-closing valve designed in conformance with good engineering practice.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Subsection 4.4.10., the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids by means of pneumatic pressure applied to a container or storage tank shall not be permitted.

4.1.8.4. Fuel Tanks of Vehicles

������������ 1)�� It is permitted to use movable tanks for dispensing flammable liquids or combustible liquids into the fuel tanks of vehicles or other motorized equipment provided such movable tanks are used in conformance with the requirements of this Part for storage tanks.

������������ 2)�� Only enclosed pumping equipment designed in conformance with good engineering practice shall be used to transfer Class I liquids to or from the fuel tanks of vehicles inside buildings. (See A-4.1.8.3.(1) in Appendix A.)

Section 4.2. �� Container Storage and Handling

4.2.1. �� Scope

4.2.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), this Section shall apply to the storage, handling and use of flammable liquids or combustible liquids in

����������������������� a)�� containers conforming toClauses 4.2.3.1.(1)(a) to (d) having a capacity of not more than 230 L, or

����������������������� b)�� portable tanks conforming to Clause 4.2.3.1.(1)(e) having an individual capacity of not more than 2 500 L.

������������ 2)�� Except as otherwise stated in this Code, this Section shall not apply to

����������������������� a)�� fuel dispensing stations, bulk plants, refineries and distilleries,

����������������������� b)�� liquids in the fuel tank of motors or engines,

����������������������� c)�� distilled beverage alcohol in closed containers when stored in conformance with Part 3,

����������������������� d)�� food and pharmaceutical products when in closed containers having a capacity of not more than 5 L, or

����������������������� e)�� products containing not more than 50% by volume of water-miscible flammable liquids or combustible liquids with the remainder of the solution being non-flammable, when in closed containers having a capacity of not more than 5 L.

������������ 3)�� Portable tanks having a capacity greater than 2 500 L shall be installed in conformance with Section 4.3.

������������ 4)�� For the purpose of this Section, unstable liquids shall meet the requirements for Class IA liquids.

������������ 5)�� Except as otherwise stated, requirements for containers in this Part shall also apply to portable tanks described in Sentence (1).

4.2.2. �� General

4.2.2.1. Prohibited Locations

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be stored in or adjacent to exits, elevators or principal routes that provide access to exits.

4.2.2.2. Storage Arrangement

������������ 1)�� In addition to the provisions of this Section, the method of storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be determined to ensure stability of the stored products.

4.2.2.3. Separation from Other Dangerous Goods

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be separated from other dangerous goods in conformance with Sections 3.2. and 3.3.

������������ 2)�� For the purposes of applying Table 3.2.7.6., Class IIIA liquids shall be treated as Class 3 dangerous goods. (See Appendix A.)

4.2.3. �� Containers and Portable Tanks

4.2.3.1. Design and Construction

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Articles 4.2.3.3. and 4.2.3.4., containers and portable tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be built in conformance with the following:

����������������������� a)�� the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations,"

����������������������� b)�� CSA B376-M, "Portable Containers for Gasoline and Other Petroleum Fuels,"

����������������������� c)�� CSA B306-M, "Portable Fuel Tanks for Marine Use,"

����������������������� d)�� ULC/ORD-C30, "Safety Containers," or

����������������������� e)�� Section 6 of CSA B620, "Highway Tanks and Portable Tanks for the Transportation of Dangerous Goods."

4.2.3.2. Markings or Labels

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2) and Article 4.2.3.1., containers for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be distinctly marked or labelled in easily legible type which is in contrast to any other printed matter on the label with a warning to indicate that

����������������������� a)�� the material in the container is flammable,

����������������������� b)�� it should be kept away from heat, sparks and open flames, and

����������������������� c)�� it should be kept closed when not in use.

������������ 2)�� Markings referred to in Sentence (1) are not required when the container is labelled in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Act (Canada)" and its Regulations,

����������������������� b)�� the "Hazardous Products Act" and its Regulations, or

����������������������� c)�� the "Pest Control Products Act" and its Regulations.

4.2.3.3. Plastic and Glass Containers

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Article 4.2.3.4., the storage, handling and use of flammable liquids or combustible liquids in a glass or plastic container shall be permitted only if the required liquid purity would be affected by storage in a metal container or if the liquid would cause excessive corrosion of the metal container.

4.2.3.4. Other Containers

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2) and (3), the storage and use of Class I or II liquids, in containers other than those described in Article 4.2.3.1., shall not be permitted within a building.

������������ 2)�� A container of not more than 1 L capacity in the case of Class I liquids and 5 L in the case of Class II or IIIA liquids need not conform to Article 4.2.3.1.

������������ 3)�� It is permitted to use sample containers not conforming to Article 4.2.3.1. for quality control purposes or for testing by regulatory officials.

4.2.4. �� Assembly and Residential Occupancies

4.2.4.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to the storage and handling of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in buildings classified as assembly or residential occupancies, except that it shall not apply to nonresidential schools, universities or colleges covered in Subsection 4.2.6.

4.2.4.2. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4) and in Articles 4.2.4.5. and 4.2.4.6., the maximum quantity of flammable liquid or combustible liquid stored in a building shall conform to Sentences (2) and (3).

������������ 2)�� When a single class of liquid is stored in a building, the total quantity of liquid shall not exceed

����������������������� a)�� 30 L of Class I liquids,

����������������������� b)�� 150 L of Class II liquids, or

����������������������� c)�� 600 L of Class IIIA liquids.

������������ 3)�� When 2 or more classes of liquid are stored in the same building, the total quantity permitted for each class of liquid shall be calculated as follows:

where

�������������������������� qI = ����� the actual quantity of Class I liquid present,

������������������������� qII =����� the actual quantity of Class II liquid present,

�������������������� qIIIA =����� the actual quantity of Class IIIA liquid present.

������������ 4)�� Quantities of flammable liquids or combustible liquids exceeding those permitted in Sentence (1) are permitted, provided they are kept

����������������������� a)�� in storage cabinets conforming to Subsection 4.2.10. except that the total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in such cabinets shall not exceed the quantity permitted for one cabinet, or

����������������������� b)�� in a storage room conforming to Subsection 4.2.9. and having no openings that communicate directly with the public portions of the building.

4.2.4.3. Storage Cabinets and Storage Rooms

������������ 1)�� The storage cabinets and storage rooms referred to in Sentence 4.2.4.2.(4) shall not be located above or below the first storey.

4.2.4.4. Exterior Balconies

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall not be stored on exterior balconies.

4.2.4.5. Dwelling Units

������������ 1)�� Not more than 15 L of flammable liquids and combustible liquids, of which not more than 5 L shall be Class I liquids, are permitted to be stored in each dwelling unit. (See Sentence 4.1.1.1.(3) for oil burning appliances.)

4.2.4.6. Attached Garages and Sheds

������������ 1)�� Not more than 50 L of flammable liquids and combustible liquids, of which not more than 30 L shall be Class I liquids, are permitted to be stored in a garage or shed attached to a dwelling unit.

4.2.5. �� Mercantile Occupancies

4.2.5.1. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (5), the quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in mercantile occupancies shall not exceed those in Sentences (2) to (4).

������������ 2)�� In unsprinklered mercantile occupancies, the maximum quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids permitted to be stored in a single suite shall be the lesser of

����������������������� a)�� 8 L/m2 of the total area of the suite, provided that not more than 2 L/m2 is Class I liquid, of which not more than 0.3 L/m2 shall be Class IA, Class IB, or any combination of these 2 classes, or

����������������������� b)�� 8000 L, provided that not more than 2000 L is Class I liquid, of which not more than 300 L shall be Class IA, Class IB, or any combination of these 2 classes.

������������ 3)�� In sprinklered mercantile occupancies, the maximum quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids permitted to be stored in a single suite shall be the lesser of

����������������������� a)�� 24 L/m2 of the total area of the suite, provided that not more than 6 L/m2 is Class I liquid, of which not more than 1 L/m2 shall be Class IA, Class IB, or any combination of these 2 classes, or

����������������������� b)�� 24000 L, provided that not more than 6000 L is Class I liquid, of which not more than 1 000 L shall be Class IA, Class IB, or any combination of these 2 classes.

������������ 4)�� For the purposes of calculating permissible quantities in Sentences (2) and (3), mercantile occupancies of less than 250 m2 floor area shall be assumed to be 250 m2 in area.

������������ 5)�� Quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in excess of those permitted in Sentences (2) to (4), shall be kept in a storage area conforming to Subsection 4.2.7.

4.2.5.2. Containers

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids in mercantile occupancies shall be kept in closed containers.

������������ 2)�� Closed containers of Class I and II liquids shall not be stacked more than 1.5 m high on floors, or 1 m high on individual fixed shelves.

������������ 3)�� Class I liquids in closed containers are permitted to be stored in basements of mercantile occupancies.

4.2.5.3. Transfer

������������ 1)�� In mercantile occupancies, transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids into containers shall only be permitted in a storage room conforming to Subsection 4.2.9. (See Appendix A.)

4.2.6. �� Business and Personal Services, Educational and Care or Detention Occupancies

4.2.6.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to the storage, handling and use of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in business and personal services occupancies and care or detention occupancies and shall include nonresidential schools, universities and colleges.

4.2.6.2. Storage Cabinets and Storage Rooms

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Article 4.2.6.3., flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be kept in closed containers and stored

����������������������� a)�� in cabinets conforming to Subsection 4.2.10. except that the total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in such cabinets shall not exceed the quantity permitted for one cabinet, or

����������������������� b)�� in a room having no openings communicating directly with the public portions of the building and conforming to Subsection 4.2.9.

4.2.6.3. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids outside of a cabinet or room required in Article 4.2.6.2. is permitted, provided such storage does not exceed

����������������������� a)�� 10 L, including not more than 5 L of Class I liquid, in a single room, or

����������������������� b)�� 250 L, including not more than 60 L of Class II liquid, or 10 L of Class I liquid, in a single fire compartment having at least a 45 min fire separation.

������������ 2)�� In the automotive shops or industrial arts area of an educational facility, storage of up to 75 L of flammable liquids and combustible liquids, including not more than 25 L of Class I liquid, shall be permitted outside of a cabinet or room as specified in Article 4.2.6.2.

4.2.6.4. Containers

������������ 1)�� Where individual containers with a capacity of more than 5 L are required for storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids in a building, safety containers conforming to ULC/ORD-C30, "Safety Containers," and of not more than 25 L capacity, shall be used.

4.2.6.5. Separation of Dangerous Goods

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids or combustible liquids stored in cabinets or rooms shall be separated from other dangerous goods in conformance with Article 4.2.2.3.

4.2.7. �� Industrial Occupancies

4.2.7.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection applies to the storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in closed containers in industrial occupancies.

4.2.7.2. Storage Facilities

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids in industrial occupancies shall be stored

����������������������� a)�� in storage areas conforming to Article 4.2.7.5.,

����������������������� b)�� in rooms conforming to Subsection 4.2.9.,

����������������������� c)�� in cabinets conforming to Subsection 4.2.10., or

����������������������� d)�� in conformance with Subsection 4.2.8.

4.2.7.3. Fire Compartments

������������ 1)�� Fire compartments regulated by this Subsection shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of at least 2 h.

4.2.7.4. Dispensing and Transfer

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Subsection 4.2.8. and in Sentence (2), the dispensing or transfer of Class I or II liquids shall be conducted in rooms conforming to Subsection 4.2.9.

������������ 2)�� It is permitted to dispense or transfer Class I or II liquids in a storage area conforming to Article 4.2.7.5. provided

����������������������� a)�� the storage area does not exceed 100 m2, and

����������������������� b)�� the dispensing or transfer operations conform to the applicable requirements of Subsection 4.2.9.

4.2.7.5. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in storage areas specified in Clause 4.2.7.2.(1)(a) shall

����������������������� a)�� conform to Table 4.2.7.5.A.

������������������������������������ i)��� where it consists of palletized or solid piled storage, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� where stored in racks in buildings not protected in conformance with Article 4.2.7.7., or

����������������������� b)�� conform to Table 4.2.7.5.B. where stored in racks in buildings protected in conformance with Article 4.2.7.7.

������������ 2)�� Where a building is designed for the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids, there is no limit on the total quantity of storage per fire compartment provided

����������������������� a)�� the building is separated from adjacent buildings by

������������������������������������ i)��� a firewall having a fire-resistance rating of at least 4 h, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� spatial separation in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code, and

����������������������� b)�� in protected rack storage, the quantities in each individual storage area do not exceed those specified in Table 4.2.7.5.B.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Where containers for 2 or more liquids having different flash points are stored together in a single individual storage area, the maximum quantity permitted in the individual storage area shall equal that permitted for the liquid with the lowest flash point.

������������ 4)�� When 2 or more classes of liquids are stored in a single fire compartment, the maximum quantity permitted for each class of liquid shall be calculated as follows:

where

qIA, IB or IC ���� = the actual quantity of Class IA, IB or IC liquid present,

��������������������� qII ���� = the actual quantity of Class II liquid present,

���������������� qIIIA ���� = the actual quantity of Class IIIA liquid present,

��� QIA, IB, IC ���� = the maximum quantity of Class IA, IB or IC liquid permitted in Table 4.2.7.5.A. or 4.2.7.5.B. for the arrangement,

�������������������� QII ���� = the maximum quantity of Class II liquid permitted in Table 4.2.7.5.A. or 4.2.7.5.B. for the arrangement,

��������������� QIIIA ���� = the maximum quantity of Class IIIA liquid permitted in Table 4.2.7.5.A. or 4.2.7.5.B. for the arrangement.

Table 4.2.7.5.A.

Indoor Container Storage (Palletized or Solid Piled Storage and
Unprotected Rack Storage)

Forming Part of Sentences 4.2.7.5.(1) and (4), 4.2.8.4.(3) and 4.2.9.1.(3)

Class of Liquid

Storage Level

Protected Storage(1)

Unprotected Storage

Maximum Quantity per I.S.A. (2) , L

Maximum Storage Height, m

Maximum Quantity per Fire Compartment , L

Maximum Quantity per I.S.A. (2) , L

Maximum Storage Height, m

Maximum Quantity per Fire Compartment , L

Class IA

First storey

Storeys above the first storey

Basement

10 000

7 500


Not Permitted

1.5

1.5


Not Permitted

50 000

30 000


Not Permitted

2 500

2 500


Not Permitted

1.5

1.5


Not Permitted

2 500

2 500


Not Permitted

Class IB
or IC

First storey

Storeys above the first storey

Basement

20 000

10 000


Not Permitted

2.0

2.0


Not Permitted

60 000

50 000


Not Permitted

10 000

10 000


Not Permitted

1.5

1.5


Not Permitted

10 000

10 000


Not Permitted

Class II

First storey and storeys above the first storey

Basement

40 000

25 000

3.0

1.5

100 000

25 000

15 000

Not Permitted

3.0

Not Permitted

30 000

Not Permitted

Class IIIA

First storey and storeys above the first storey

Basement

60 000

40 000

6.0

3.0

200 000

100 000

50 000

Not Permitted

4.5

Not Permitted

100 000

Not Permitted

Notes to Table 4.2.7.5.A.:

����� 1��� See Article 4.2.7.7.

����� 2��� Individual storage area

Table 4.2.7.5.B.

Indoor Container Storage (Protected Rack Storage)(1)

Forming Part of Sentences 4.2.7.5.(1), (2) and (4)

Class of Liquid

Storage Level

Maximum Height, m

Maximum Quantity per Fire Compartment, L

Class IA

First storey

Storeys above first storey

Basement

7.5

4.5


Not Permitted

30 000

17 000


Not Permitted

Class IB or IC

First storey

Storeys above first storey

Basement

7.5

4.5


Not Permitted

60 000

35 000


Not Permitted

Class II

First storey

Storeys above first storey

Basement

7.5

7.5


4.5

100 000

100 000


35 000

Class IIIA

First storey

Storeys above first storey

Basement

12.0

6.0


6.0

200 000

200 000


100 000

Notes to Table 4.2.7.5.B.:

����� 1��� See Article 4.2.7.7.

4.2.7.6. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Measures to control spilled flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.2.7.7. Fire Suppression Systems

������������ 1)�� Where protection is required by this Code, storage areas for flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be

����������������������� a)�� sprinklered in conformance with NFPA 30, "Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code," or

����������������������� b)�� protected by an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Part 6.

(See Appendix A.)

4.2.7.8. Clearances

������������ 1)�� The clearance between the top of storage and the lowest structural members, sprinkler head deflectors or other overhead fire protection system components shall be not less than 450 mm.

������������ 2)�� A clearance of not less than 400 mm shall be maintained between stored flammable liquids and combustible liquids and walls, except that where the width of storage adjacent to the wall is not more than 1.5 m, such wall clearance is not required. (See Appendix A.)

4.2.7.9. Aisles

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.2.7.10., main aisles, access aisles and aisles defining individual storage areas, shall be in conformance with Article 3.2.2.2.

4.2.7.10. Separation from Other Dangerous Goods

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall not be stored with other dangerous goods unless in conformance with Article 4.2.2.3.

4.2.7.11. Separation from Combustible Products

������������ 1)�� Combustibles other than those used for the packaging of the flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be stored in the same individual storage area with such liquids.

4.2.7.12. Absorbents

������������ 1)�� Absorbent materials shall be available in the storage area for use in clean-up of spilled flammable liquids or combustible liquids in conformance with Article 4.1.6.3.

4.2.7.13. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Storage areas described in Article 4.2.7.1. shall be ventilated in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7.

4.2.8. �� Incidental Use

4.2.8.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as otherwise noted in this Part, this Subsection applies to industrial occupancies where the use, storage and handling of flammable liquids or combustible liquids is secondary to the principal activity. (See Appendix A.)

4.2.8.2. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3) and in Article 4.2.8.4., the quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids permitted to be located outside of storage rooms conforming to Subsection 4.2.7., 4.2.9. or 4.3.13., or storage cabinets conforming to Subsection 4.2.10., in any one fire compartment of a building, shall not be more than

����������������������� a)�� 600 L of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in closed containers, of which not more than 100 L shall be Class IA liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� 5000 L of Class IB, IC, II and IIIA liquids in storage tanks or portable tanks.

������������ 2)�� Where required for normal plant activity, quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids are permitted to exceed those specified in Sentence (1), but shall not be greater than the supply for one day of normal operation.

������������ 3)�� Where larger quantities than are permitted by Sentence (2) are required, such quantities shall be in storage tanks installed in conformance with Sentence 4.3.12.4.(2).

4.2.8.3. Handling

������������ 1)�� Areas in which flammable liquids or combustible liquids are transferred from one container or storage tank to another, or are used in such a way as to release potentially explosive concentrations of flammable vapours, shall be

����������������������� a)�� separated from possible sources of ignition by a spatial separation of not less than 6 m, or by a fire separation (see A-4.1.5.3.(1) and A-4.2.8.3.(1)(a) in Appendix A),

����������������������� b)�� provided with a drainage system to control spills in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.,

����������������������� c)�� provided with absorbent materials to assist in clean-up of small liquid spills in conformance with Article 4.1.6.3.,

����������������������� d)�� provided with either natural or mechanical ventilation in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7., and

����������������������� e)�� separated from other dangerous goods in conformance with Article 4.2.2.3.

4.2.8.4. General Storage Areas

������������ 1)�� In a general storage area covered in Subsection 3.2.3., quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids are permitted to exceed those in Sentence 4.2.8.2.(1) provided the storage area is in conformance with Sentences (2) to (6).

������������ 2)�� The storage area referred to in Sentence (1) shall be sprinklered in conformance with Article 3.2.3.3., providing a level of protection not less than that required for Class IV commodities stored up to a height of 6 m.

������������ 3)�� The height of storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be not more than those permitted for unprotected storage in Table 4.2.7.5.A.

������������ 4)�� When a single class of liquid is stored, the total quantity in a single fire compartment shall be not more than

����������������������� a)�� 2500 L of Class IB and IC liquid,

����������������������� b)�� 5000 L of Class II liquid, or

����������������������� c)�� 10000 L of Class IIIA liquid.

������������ 5)�� When 2 or more classes of liquid are stored in the same fire compartment, the total quantity permitted for each class of liquid shall be calculated as follows:

where

��������������������������� qI �� = the actual quantity of Class IB and IC liquid present,

�������������������������� qII �� = the actual quantity of Class II liquid present,

�������������������� qIIIA �� = the actual quantity of Class IIIA liquid present.

������������ 6)�� When 2 or more classes of liquid are stored in the same individual storage area, the maximum quantity permitted in the individual storage area shall be that permitted for the liquid with the lowest limit listed in Sentence (4).

4.2.9. �� Rooms for Container Storage and Dispensing

4.2.9.1. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), where flammable liquids and combustible liquids are stored in a room required in this Part, the storage densities averaged over the total room area and the total quantities of such liquids shall conform to Table 4.2.9.1.

Table 4.2.9.1.

Rooms for Container Storage and Dispensing

Forming Part of Sentences 4.2.9.1.(1) and (2)

Maximum Quantity, L

Minimum Fire Separation Around Room, h

Maximum Density, L/m2

10 000

1 500

2

1

200

100

������������ 2)�� The maximum quantities and densities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids shown in Table 4.2.9.1. are permitted to be doubled provided the storage room is protected by an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Article 4.2.7.7.

������������ 3)�� The maximum quantities of Class I liquids in an unprotected storage room with a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h shall

����������������������� a)�� not exceed those specified for unprotected storage in Table 4.2.7.5.A., and

����������������������� b)�� comply with Sentences 4.2.7.5.(3) and (4).

4.2.9.2. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Storage rooms referred to in Article 4.2.9.1. shall be liquid-tight where the walls join the floor.

������������ 2)�� Storage rooms referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed to accommodate possible spills of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.2.9.3. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Storage rooms referred to in Article 4.2.9.1. shall be ventilated in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7.

4.2.9.4. Aisles

������������ 1)�� The contents of flammable liquid and combustible liquid storage rooms referred to in Article 4.2.9.1. shall be arranged to provide aisle widths of not less than 1 m.

4.2.9.5. Dispensing

������������ 1)�� Dispensing of flammable liquids or combustible liquids from containers having a capacity of more than 30 L shall be by pumps or through self-closing valves, designed in conformance with good engineering practice. (See A-4.1.8.3.(1) in Appendix A.)

4.2.9.6. Explosion Venting

������������ 1)�� Where Class IA or IB liquids are dispensed within a storage room, the room shall be designed to prevent critical structural and mechanical damage from an internal explosion in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations." (See A-3.2.8.2.(1)(d) in Appendix A.)

4.2.9.7. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided for storage rooms described in Article 4.2.9.1. in conformance with Part 6.

4.2.10. �� Cabinets for Container Storage

4.2.10.1. Containers

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in cabinets required in this Part shall be in closed containers conforming to Article 4.2.3.1.

4.2.10.2. Maximum Quantity per Cabinet

������������ 1)�� The maximum quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in a cabinet shall be 500 L, of which not more than 250 L shall be Class I liquids.

4.2.10.3. Maximum Quantity per Fire Compartment

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), the total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in cabinets in a single fire compartment shall not exceed the quantity permitted in Article 4.2.10.2. for 3 cabinets.

������������ 2)�� In industrial occupancies, quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids greater than those specified in Sentence (1) are permitted in a single fire compartment if

����������������������� a)�� the total quantity stored in a group of cabinets is not more than the quantity permitted for 3 cabinets, and

����������������������� b)�� the distance between groups of cabinets described in Clause (a) is not less than 30 m.

������������ 3)�� In care or detention occupancies, the total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in cabinets in a single fire compartment shall not exceed the quantity permitted for one cabinet.

4.2.10.4. Labelling

������������ 1) Cabinets for container storage shall be labelled in conspicuous lettering to indicate that the cabinet contains flammable materials and that open flames must be kept away.

4.2.10.5. Fire Endurance

������������ 1)�� Storage cabinets required in this Part shall conform to ULC-C1275, "Storage Cabinets for Flammable Liquid Containers."

4.2.10.6. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� When a storage cabinet required in this Part is provided with ventilation openings,

����������������������� a)�� the ventilation openings shall be sealed with materials providing a fire protection at least equivalent to that required for the construction of the cabinet, or

����������������������� b)�� the cabinet shall be vented outdoors using vent piping providing a fire protection at least equivalent to that required in Clause (a) for seals.

4.2.11. �� Outdoor Container Storage

4.2.11.1. Quantities and Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the quantities and clearances for flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in containers in outdoor storage areas shall conform to Table 4.2.11.1.

������������ 2)�� The clearances required in Sentence (1) do not apply where not more than 5000 L of flammable liquids or combustible liquids are stored adjacent to a building on the same property, provided that either

����������������������� a)�� the building is limited to 1 storey in building height and is used primarily for the storage or handling of flammable liquids or combustible liquids, or

����������������������� b)�� the exposed wall has a fire-resistance rating of at least 2 h and has no openings within 3 m of such outdoor storage.

Table 4.2.11.1.

Outdoor Container Storage

Forming Part of Sentences 4.2.11.1.(1)

Class of Liquid

Maximum Total Quantity, per Pile, L

Minimum Distance between Piles, m

Minimum Distance to a Property Line or to a Building on the Same Property, m

Class IA

5 000

1.5

6

Class IB or IC

15 000

1.5

6

Class II

35 000

1.5

6

Class IIIA

85 000

1.5

6

4.2.11.2. Mixed Storage

������������ 1)�� Where 2 or more liquids with different flash points are stored outdoors in containers that form a single pile, the maximum total quantity permitted in the pile shall be equal to that permitted for the liquid with the lowest flash point.

4.2.11.3. Fire Department Access

������������ 1)�� An access route not less than 6 m wide constructed in conformance with Subsection 3.2.5. of the British Columbia Building Code shall be provided in outdoor storage areas to permit the approach of fire department vehicles to within 60 m of any part of a pile.

4.2.11.4. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Outdoor storage areas for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be designed to accommodate possible spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.2.11.5. Fencing

������������ 1)�� An outdoor area used for the container storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be fenced in conformance with Article 3.3.2.6.

Section 4.3. �� Tank Storage

4.3.1. �� Design, Construction and Use of Storage Tanks

4.3.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to storage tanks for flammable liquids and combustible liquids.

4.3.1.2. Atmospheric Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (3) and in Section 4.9., atmospheric storage tanks shall be built in conformance with the following:

����������������������� a)�� API 12B, "Bolted Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids,"

����������������������� b)�� API 12D, "Field Welded Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids,"

����������������������� c)�� API 12F, "Shop Welded Tanks for Storage of Production Liquids,"

����������������������� d)�� API 650, "Welded Steel Tanks for Oil Storage,"

����������������������� e)�� ULC-S601, "Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Horizontal Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

������������������������ f)�� CAN/ULC-S602-M, "Aboveground Steel Tanks for Fuel Oil and Lubricating Oil,"

����������������������� g)�� CAN/ULC-S603, "Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� h)�� CAN/ULC-S603.1, "Galvanic Corrosion Protection Systems for Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

������������������������� i)�� CAN4-S615-M, "Reinforced Plastic Underground Tanks for Petroleum Products,"

������������������������� j)�� ULC-S630, "Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Vertical Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� k)�� CAN/ULC-S643-M, "Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Utility Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

������������������������� l)�� ULC-S652, "Tank Assemblies for Collection of Used Oil,"

���������������������� m)�� ULC-S653, "Aboveground Steel Contained Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� n)�� ULC/ORD-C58.10, "Jacketed Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� o)�� ULC/ORD-C142.5, "Concrete Encased Steel Aboveground Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� p)�� ULC/ORD-C142.16, "Protected Aboveground Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� q)�� ULC/ORD-C142.23, "Aboveground Waste Oil Tanks."

������������ 2)�� Tanks built in conformance with Clauses (1)(a), (b) and (c) shall be used only for the storage of crude petroleum at oil fields.

������������ 3)�� When necessitated by possible contamination of the liquid to be stored or possible rapid corrosion of the tank, storage tanks need not conform to Sentence (1), provided that they are designed and built in conformance with good engineering practice for the material being used.

������������ 4)�� Atmospheric storage tanks shall not be used for the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids at temperatures at or above their boiling points.

4.3.1.3. Low Pressure Storage Tanks and Pressure Vessels

������������ 1)�� Low pressure storage tanks shall be constructed in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� API 620, "Design and Construction of Large, Welded, Low-Pressure Storage Tanks," or

����������������������� b)�� ANSI/ASME, "Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code."

������������ 2)�� Pressure vessels shall be constructed in conformance with CSA B51, "Boiler, Pressure Vessel, and Pressure Piping Code."

������������ 3)�� Low pressure storage tanks and pressure vessels are permitted to be used as atmospheric storage tanks.

4.3.1.4. Operating Pressure

������������ 1)�� The normal operating pressure of a storage tank shall not exceed its design pressure.

4.3.1.5. Corrosion Protection

������������ 1)�� The exposed surface of every aboveground storage tank for flammable liquids or combustible liquids which is fabricated of any ferrous substance shall be thoroughly coated with rust-resisting material compatible with the tank.

4.3.1.6. Floating Roofs

������������ 1)�� Except for perimeter sealing material, floating roof assemblies or internal floating covers installed in storage tanks shall be constructed of metal, or other materials and design conforming to one of the tank construction standards listed in this Subsection.

4.3.1.7. Identification

������������ 1)�� A storage tank and its filling and emptying connections shall be identified in conformance with CPPI, "Using the CPPI Colour-Symbol System to Mark Equipment and Vehicles for Product Identification."

4.3.1.8. Overfill Protection

������������ 1)�� A storage tank shall be prevented from being overfilled by providing

����������������������� a)�� continuous supervision of the filling operations by personnel qualified to supervise such operations, or

����������������������� b)�� an overfill protection device conforming to ULC/ORD-C58.15, "Overfill Protection Devices for Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks" (see Appendix A).

4.3.2. �� Installation of Outside Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.2.1. Location

������������ 1)�� Every outside aboveground storage tank for the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be located in conformance with Sentences (2) to (5) with respect to a property line or a building on the same property.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentences (6) and (7), every aboveground storage tank containing stable liquids and having a working pressure of not more than 17 kPa (gauge) shall be separated from a property line or a building on the same property by distances

����������������������� a)�� half those in Table 4.3.2.1. where protection is provided against fire or explosion in the tank in conformance with Sentence 4.3.2.5.(2), or

����������������������� b)�� equal to those in Table 4.3.2.1. where protection referred to in Clause (a) is not provided.

Table 4.3.2.1.

Location of Aboveground Storage Tanks

Forming Part of Sentences 4.3.2.1.(2), (3) and (4), and 4.8.2.1.(2) and (3)

Maximum Tank Capacity, L

Minimum Distance to a Property Line or to a Building on the Same Property, m

250 000

500 000

2 500 000

5 000 000

over 5 000 000

3

4.5

9

12

15

������������ 3)�� Every aboveground storage tank containing unstable liquids and having a working pressure of not more than 17 kPa (gauge) shall be separated from a property line or a building on the same property by distances

����������������������� a)�� equal to those in Table 4.3.2.1., but not less than 7.5 m, where protection is provided against fire or explosion in the tank in conformance with Sentence 4.3.2.5.(2), or

����������������������� b)�� 3 times those in Table 4.3.2.1., but not less than 15 m, where protection referred to in Clause (a) is not provided.

������������ 4)�� Every aboveground storage tank containing boil-over liquids shall be separated from a property line or a building on the same property by distances

����������������������� a)�� 0.75 times those in Table 4.3.2.1. where protection is provided against fire or explosion in the tank in conformance with Sentence 4.3.2.5.(2), or

����������������������� b)�� equal to those in Table 4.3.2.1. where protection referred to in Clause (a) is not provided.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 5)�� Where a storage tank containing stable liquids or unstable liquids has a working pressure greater than 17 kPa (gauge), the distances from a property line or a building on the same property shall be those specified in Sentences (2) and (3) multiplied by 1.5, but shall be not less than 7.5 m.

������������ 6)�� The minimum distance required in Sentence (2) from a storage tank containing only Class II or IIIA liquids to a building on the same property is permitted to be reduced to

����������������������� a)�� 1.5 m provided the tank capacity is not more than 50 000 L, or

����������������������� b)�� zero provided the tank capacity is not more than 2 500 L.

������������ 7)�� The minimum distance required in Sentence (2) is permitted to be waived provided the storage tank

����������������������� a)�� is in conformance with ULC/ORD-C142.16, "Protected Aboveground Tank Assemblies for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," and

����������������������� b)�� has a capacity of not more than 50 000 L.

������������ 8)�� Where end failure of horizontal storage tanks may endanger adjacent property, the tanks shall be placed with the longitudinal axis parallel to such property.

4.3.2.2. Spacing between Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� Except as required in Sentences (2) and (3) and in Article 4.3.2.3., the minimum distance between every combination of 2 aboveground storage tanks shall be 0.25 times the sum of their diameters, but shall be not less than 1 m.

������������ 2)�� The minimum distance between any 2 storage tanks, neither of which has a capacity of more than 250 000 L, shall be 1 m.

������������ 3)�� Where either of 2 aboveground storage tanks contains unstable liquids, the distance required in Sentences (1) and (2) shall be doubled.

4.3.2.3. Clearances from Liquefied Petroleum Gas Cylinders and Tanks

������������ 1)�� The minimum separation between a flammable liquid or combustible liquid storage tank and a liquefied petroleum gas cylinder or tank shall be 6 m.

������������ 2)�� Secondary containments for flammable liquid and combustible liquid storage tanks shall not contain any liquefied petroleum gas cylinder or tank, and the centre line of the secondary containment wall shall be not less than

����������������������� a)�� 3 m away from a liquefied petroleum gas cylinder, and

����������������������� b)�� 6 m away from a liquefied petroleum gas tank.

4.3.2.4. Fire Department Access

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be spaced so that each storage tank is accessible for fire fighting purposes.

������������ 2)�� An access route constructed in conformance with Subsection 3.2.5. of the British Columbia Building Code shall be provided in outdoor storage areas to permit the approach of fire department vehicles to within 60 m travelling distance of any storage tank.

������������ 3)�� Where fire fighting access to storage tanks containing Class I or II liquids is not provided, fire extinguishing measures conforming to Sentence 4.3.2.5.(2) shall be provided.

4.3.2.5. Fire Protection Systems

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Where the diameter of a storage tank exceeds 45 m, the storage tank shall be provided with protection against fires or explosions in conformance with Sentence (2).

������������ 2)�� Protection against fires or explosions required for a storage tank shall consist of fixed protection systems designed in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in

����������������������� a)�� NFPA 11, "Low Expansion Foam and Combined Agent Systems,"

����������������������� b)�� NFPA 15, "Water Spray Fixed Systems for Fire Protection," and

����������������������� c)�� NFPA 69, "Explosion Prevention Systems."

4.3.2.6. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� At the time of installation, aboveground storage tanks and associated piping shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Subsections 4.3.15. and 4.4.6.

4.3.3. �� Supports, Foundations and Anchorage for Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.3.1. Foundations and Supports

������������ 1)�� Storage tanks shall rest on the ground or on foundations, supports or piling made of concrete, masonry or steel in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� Appendix B of API 650, "Welded Steel Tanks for Oil Storage," and

����������������������� b)�� Appendices C and D of API 620, "Design and Construction of Large, Welded, Low-Pressure Storage Tanks."

������������ 2)�� Tank supports shall be installed on firm foundations designed to minimize uneven settling of the tank and to minimize corrosion of the part of the tank resting on the foundation.

������������ 3)�� Except for steel saddles that are less than 300 mm high at their highest point, supports for storage tanks shall provide a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

������������ 4)�� Every aboveground storage tank shall be supported in a manner that will prevent the allowable design stress of the tank from being exceeded.

4.3.3.2. Earthquake Protection

������������ 1)�� In areas subject to earthquake forces, storage tanks, supports and connections shall be designed to resist such forces in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� Part 4 of the British Columbia Building Code, and

����������������������� b)�� Appendix A of ULC-S630, "Shop Fabricated Steel Aboveground Vertical Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

4.3.3.3. Protection against Flooding

������������ 1)�� When aboveground storage tanks are located in an area that may be subjected to flooding, the tanks shall be securely anchored to prevent floating.

4.3.4. �� Normal and Emergency Venting for Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.4.1. Design and Installation

������������ 1)�� Atmospheric and low pressure storage tanks shall be provided with normal and emergency venting in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� API 2000, "Venting Atmospheric and Low-Pressure Storage Tanks," or

����������������������� b)�� the tank design standards listed in Sentence 4.3.1.2.(1).

4.3.4.2. Unstable Liquids

������������ 1)�� When unstable liquids are stored, the effects of heat or gas resulting from polymerization, decomposition, condensation or self-reactivity shall be allowed for in the determination of the total venting capacity.

4.3.5. �� Vent Piping for Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.5.1. Materials and Construction

������������ 1)�� Vent piping materials and construction shall conform to Section 4.4.

4.3.5.2. Location of Vent Pipe Outlets

������������ 1)�� Vent pipe outlets for storage tanks of Class I liquids

����������������������� a)�� shall be located outside buildings not less than

������������������������������������ i)��� 3.5 m above the adjacent ground level, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� 1.5 m from any building opening, and

����������������������� b)�� shall discharge so that flammable vapours will not enter the building or be trapped near any part of the building.

������������ 2)�� Vent pipe outlets for Class II or IIIA liquids shall discharge outside buildings not less than

����������������������� a)�� 2 m above the adjacent ground level, and

����������������������� b)�� 1.5 m from any building opening.

4.3.5.3. Interconnection of Vent Piping

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), 2 or more storage tanks are permitted to be connected to a common vent pipe for normal relief venting provided the vent pipe size is designed to vent the combined vapours produced in the connected tanks without exceeding the allowable stresses of the tanks.

������������ 2)�� Vent piping for storage tanks for Class I liquids shall not be connected to vent piping for storage tanks for Class II or IIIA liquids unless an effective arrangement is provided to prevent the vapours from the Class I liquids from entering the other tanks.

4.3.6. �� Openings Other than Vents in Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.6.1. Provision of Valves

������������ 1)�� Connections to aboveground storage tanks at any level below the highest level to which the liquid will rise shall be provided with valves located as close as practicable to the shell.

4.3.6.2. Materials

������������ 1)�� Valves and their connections to a storage tank shall be made of steel, except that when the chemical characteristics of the liquid stored are incompatible with steel, materials other than steel are permitted to be used.

������������ 2)�� Materials for valves and their connections to a storage tank shall be suitable for the pressures, stresses and temperatures that may be expected, including those of possible fire exposure.

4.3.6.3. Openings for Liquid Level Measurements

������������ 1)�� Openings for measuring liquid levels in storage tanks for Class I liquids shall be equipped with caps or covers which shall be opened only when measuring the liquid level.

4.3.6.4. Connections for Filling and Emptying

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (3), connections used as part of normal operating conditions for filling or emptying storage tanks for flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be located

����������������������� a)�� outside buildings,

����������������������� b)�� at a location free of sources of ignition, and

����������������������� c)�� not less than 1.5 m away from building openings.

������������ 2)�� Connections for filling or emptying storage tanks shall be kept closed to prevent leakage when not in use.

������������ 3)�� A filling connection described in Sentence (1) is permitted to be located inside a building if

����������������������� a)�� this is made necessary

������������������������������������ i)��� by a process or activity located indoors and to which the tank is directly associated, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� for the collection of used liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� the fill piping is provided with means to prevent flammable vapours from returning to the building.

4.3.7. �� Secondary Containment for Aboveground Storage Tanks

4.3.7.1. General

������������ 1)�� The area surrounding a storage tank or group of storage tanks shall be designed to accommodate accidental spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Where barriers described in Sentence 4.1.6.1.(1) are provided to contain accidental spillage from aboveground storage tanks, they shall conform to the requirements for secondary containment in this Subsection.

������������ 3)�� A storage tank conforming to Sentence 4.3.7.4.(2) shall be considered as conforming to this Subsection provided it is used and maintained in conformance with Articles 4.3.7.8. and 4.3.7.9.

4.3.7.2. Construction

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), the base and walls of a secondary containment shall be made of noncombustible materials, and shall be designed, constructed and maintained to

����������������������� a)�� withstand full hydrostatic head, and

����������������������� b)�� provide a permeability of not more than 10 - 6 cm/s to the flammable liquids or combustible liquids contained in the storage tanks.

������������ 2)�� Where a membrane provides the level of impermeability required in Sentence (1), it shall

����������������������� a)�� conform to ULC/ORD-C58.9, "Secondary Containment Liners for Underground and Aboveground Flammable and Combustible Liquid Tanks," and

����������������������� b)�� when the membrane is combustible, be covered with a noncombustible material of such nature and thickness that the membrane will not fail when the secondary containment is exposed to fire.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4), openings shall not be permitted in a secondary containment.

������������ 4)�� Where piping passes through a secondary containment, such passages shall conform to Sentences (1) and (2).

4.3.7.3. Capacity

(See A-4.1.6.1.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (3), a secondary containment for a single storage tank shall have a volumetric capacity of not less than 110% of the capacity of the tank.

������������ 2)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (3), a secondary containment for more than one storage tank shall have a volumetric capacity of not less than the sum of

����������������������� a)�� the capacity of the largest storage tank located in the contained space, and

����������������������� b)�� 10% of the greater of

������������������������������������ i)��� the capacity specified in Clause (a), or

����������������������������������� ii)��� the aggregate capacity of all other storage tanks located in the contained space.

������������ 3)�� When the secondary containment is designed to prevent the entry of precipitation and water used for fire fighting purposes into the contained space, it shall have a volumetric capacity of not less than the capacity of the largest storage tank located in the contained space.

4.3.7.4. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), no part of a secondary containment wall shall be less than 1.5 m from a storage tank shell.

������������ 2)�� It is permitted to waive the distance required in Sentence (1) provided the storage tank

����������������������� a)�� is constructed in accordance with

������������������������������������ i)��� Clauses 4.3.1.2.(1)(l), (m), (o), (p) or (q), incorporating secondary containment, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� Clauses 4.3.1.2.(1)(e) or (j) for double-walled storage tanks,

����������������������� b)�� has a capacity of not more than 50 000 L, and

����������������������� c)�� is protected by posts or guardrails when exposed to collision damage.

4.3.7.5. Access to Storage Tanks and Ancillary Equipment

������������ 1)�� A secondary containment shall permit

����������������������� a)�� access to storage tanks, valves and ancillary equipment,

����������������������� b)�� egress from the contained space, and

����������������������� c)�� access for fire fighting as specified in Article 4.3.2.4.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Where a storage tank contains Class I liquids, provisions shall be made for the normal operation of valves and for access to the storage tank roof without entering the contained space created by the secondary containment when

����������������������� a)�� the average height of the secondary containment exceeds 3.5 m, measured from the ground level of the interior of the contained area, or

����������������������� b)�� the distance between the tank shell and the top inside edge of the secondary containment wall is less than the height of this wall.

(See Appendix A.)

4.3.7.6. Emergency Venting

������������ 1)�� Where the secondary containment is not open to the atmosphere, emergency venting shall be provided to relieve any buildup of internal pressure in the contained space when exposed to heat or fire.

4.3.7.7. Leak Detection

������������ 1)�� Where the contained space created by the secondary containment is not accessible for visual examination, a monitoring device shall be provided to indicate the presence of liquid in, or the loss of integrity of the secondary containment.

4.3.7.8. Drainage

������������ 1)�� Liquids, debris and precipitation shall not accumulate in the contained space created by the secondary containment.

������������ 2)�� Provisions shall be made for removing liquid from the secondary containment in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 3)�� Controls for the liquid removal system required in Sentence (2) shall be

����������������������� a)�� normally closed,

����������������������� b)�� accessible under fire exposure conditions, and

����������������������� c)�� located so they can be operated from outside the contained space.

4.3.7.9. Use of Secondary Containment

������������ 1)�� The contained space created by a secondary containment shall not be used for storage purposes.

4.3.8. �� Installation of Underground Storage Tanks

4.3.8.1. Location

������������ 1)�� Underground storage tanks shall be located so that

����������������������� a)�� foundations of existing buildings will not be undermined during excavation, and

����������������������� b)�� loads from building foundations and supports are not transmitted to the tank.

������������ 2)�� Underground storage tanks shall be located not less than

����������������������� a)�� 600 mm from adjacent tanks,

����������������������� b)�� 1 m from a building or street line, and

����������������������� c)�� 1.5 m from other property lines.

4.3.8.2. Ground Cover

������������ 1)�� Except as required in Sentences (2) to (4), underground storage tanks shall be installed with not less than 600 mm of ground cover over the tank.

������������ 2)�� Except as required in Sentence (3), storage tanks subjected to vehicular traffic shall be installed not less than 1 m below finished ground level.

������������ 3)�� Either a 150 mm reinforced concrete slab or a 200 mm unreinforced concrete slab over not less than 450 mm of sand is permitted in lieu of the protection described in Sentence (2) provided the slab extends at least 300 mm beyond the storage tank.

������������ 4)�� Where subsurface conditions make it impracticable to install a storage tank totally below adjacent ground level, an underground storage tank shall be installed so that at least

����������������������� a)�� 75% of its mass is below adjacent ground level provided there is not less than 600 mm of ground cover over the portion of the tank above adjacent ground level, or

����������������������� b)�� 50% of its mass is below adjacent ground level provided there is not less than 1 m of ground cover over the portion of the tank above adjacent ground level.

4.3.8.3. Damage Repair

������������ 1)�� Underground storage tanks in the process of being installed shall be inspected, and any damage to the protective coating or anodes shall be repaired before they are lowered into the excavation.

������������ 2)�� Damage to storage tank shells shall not be repaired on site.

4.3.8.4. Damage Prevention

������������ 1)�� Underground storage tanks shall be lowered into the excavation by the use of lifting lugs and hooks and, where necessary, spreader bars to prevent damage to the protective coating.

������������ 2)�� Any method of handling that might result in damage to the protective coating of the tank shall not be used.

4.3.8.5. Installation

������������ 1)�� Underground steel storage tanks shall be installed in conformance with Appendix B of CAN/ULC-S603.1, "Galvanic Corrosion Protection Systems for Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 2)�� Underground reinforced plastic storage tanks shall be installed in conformance with Appendix A of CAN4-S615-M, "Reinforced Plastic Underground Tanks for Petroleum Products."

������������ 3)�� Underground storage tanks shall not be placed in direct contact with reinforced concrete slabs but shall be separated by not less than 150 mm of sand or other suitable material to distribute evenly the weight of the tank on the supporting base.

4.3.8.6. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� At the time of installation, underground storage tanks and associated piping shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Subsections 4.3.15. and 4.4.6.

4.3.8.7. Filling

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be placed in an underground storage tank until

����������������������� a)�� the fill pipe and vent line have been installed in the tank, and

����������������������� b)�� all other openings have been sealed.

4.3.8.8. Spillage

������������ 1)�� If a spillage occurs, the escaped liquid and all soil contaminated by the spill shall be removed in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.3.8.9. Anchorage

������������ 1) Where a high water table is anticipated, underground storage tanks shall be protected against uplift due to hydrostatic forces when the tanks are empty. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Where anchors and ground straps are used to resist uplift forces referred to in Sentence (1), they shall be

����������������������� a)�� electrically isolated from the tank, and

����������������������� b)�� installed in such a manner that they do not damage the protective coating on the tank.

4.3.9. �� Corrosion Protection of Underground Steel Storage Tanks

4.3.9.1. Corrosion Protection

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), underground steel storage tanks and associated piping and fitting subject to corrosion shall be protected in conformance with CAN/ULC-S603.1, "Galvanic Corrosion Protection Systems for Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 2)�� A steel storage tank not conforming to Sentence (1) is permitted provided

����������������������� a)�� it conforms to ULC/ORD-C58.10, "Jacketed Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� b)�� it has corrosion protection conforming to good engineering practice such as described in PACE Report No. 87-1, "Impressed Current Method of Cathodic Protection of Underground Petroleum Storage Tanks" published by the Canadian Petroleum Products Institute.

4.3.10. �� Vents for Underground Storage Tanks

4.3.10.1. Vent Design

������������ 1)�� Underground storage tanks shall be provided with vent openings and piping of sufficient cross-sectional area designed to vent the tanks during the maximum filling or withdrawal rate without causing the allowable stress for the tank to be exceeded.

4.3.10.2. Materials and Construction

������������ 1)�� Vent piping materials and construction shall conform to Section 4.4.

4.3.10.3. Installation

������������ 1)�� Vent pipe outlets from underground storage tanks for Class I liquids

����������������������� a)�� shall be located outside buildings higher than the fill pipe openings but not less than

������������������������������������ i)��� 3.5 m above the adjacent ground level,

����������������������������������� ii)��� 1.5 m from any building opening, and

���������������������������������� iii)��� 7.5 m from any dispenser, and

����������������������� b)�� shall discharge so that flammable vapours will not enter building openings or be trapped near any part of the building.

������������ 2)�� Vent pipe outlets from underground storage tanks for Class II or IIIA liquids shall be located outside buildings at a height that is above the fill pipe opening but not less than 2 m above finished ground level.

������������ 3)�� Vent pipes from underground storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be obstructed by any device that may cause excessive back pressure, except that vent pipes from underground storage tanks for Class II or IIIA liquids are permitted to be fitted with return bends, coarse screens or other devices to minimize the entry of foreign material.

������������ 4)�� Vent piping shall enter the storage tank through the top of the tank and shall not extend into the tank more than 25 mm except when the vent is equipped with a vent alarm.

������������ 5)�� Vent piping shall be

����������������������� a)�� installed so that any nominally horizontal run shall slope towards the storage tank,

����������������������� b)�� constructed without traps,

����������������������� c)�� adequately supported to prevent sagging, and

����������������������� d)�� where necessary, protected against mechanical damage.

4.3.10.4. Interconnection of Vent Pipes

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), where vent piping connects 2 or more storage tanks, pipe sizes shall be designed to vent the combined vapours produced in the connected underground storage tanks without exceeding the allowable stresses of the tanks when being filled simultaneously.

������������ 2)�� Where it is not possible to fill the connected storage tanks referred to in Sentence (1) simultaneously, or where the connected vents have a vapour recovery system, the vent piping shall be sized to accommodate the maximum vapour flow possible in the system.

������������ 3)�� Vent piping for an underground storage tank containing a Class I liquid shall not be connected to the vent piping for a storage tank containing a Class II or IIIA liquid unless an effective method is provided to prevent the vapours from the Class I liquid storage tank from entering the other tank.

4.3.11. �� Openings Other than Vents in Underground Storage Tanks

4.3.11.1. Connections

������������ 1)�� Connections for all openings in underground storage tanks shall be liquid and vapour tight.

4.3.11.2. Openings for Measuring Liquid Level

������������ 1)�� Openings for measuring liquid levels in underground storage tanks if independent of the fill pipe shall be equipped with a vapour-tight cap or cover which shall be opened only when measuring the liquid level.

4.3.11.3. Fill Piping and Discharge Piping

������������ 1)�� Fill piping and discharge piping shall enter underground storage tanks only through the top of the tank and discharge piping used in suction systems shall be sloped toward the storage tanks.

������������ 2)�� Remote fill outlets from an underground storage tank shall not be located higher than other outlets from the tank.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Sentence (5), connections used as part of normal operating conditions for filling or emptying storage tanks for flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be located

����������������������� a)�� outside buildings

����������������������� b)�� at a location free of sources of ignition, and

����������������������� c)�� not less than 1.5 m away from building openings.

������������ 4)�� Connections for filling or emptying storage tanks described in Sentence (3) shall be kept closed to prevent leakage when not in use.

������������ 5)�� A filling connection described in Sentence (3) is permitted to be located inside a building if

����������������������� a)�� this is made necessary

������������������������������������ i)��� by a process or activity located indoors and to which the tank is directly associated, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� for the collection of used liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� the fill piping is provided with means to prevent flammable vapours from returning to the building.

4.3.12. �� Installation of Storage Tanks inside Buildings

4.3.12.1. Occupancy

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.3.12.2., storage tanks shall not be permitted in other than industrial occupancies.

4.3.12.2. Stationary Combustion Engines

������������ 1)�� Installations using Class I liquids as fuel supplies for stationary engines inside buildings shall conform to NFPA 37, "Installation and Use of Stationary Combustion Engines and Gas Turbines."

4.3.12.3. Maximum Static Head

������������ 1)�� The static head imposed on a storage tank inside a building shall not exceed 70 kPa (gauge) at the bottom of the tank when the vent or fill pipe is filled with liquid unless the tank is designed for greater pressures.

4.3.12.4. Maximum Quantities and Location

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Subsection 4.2.8. and in Sentence (2), storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be

����������������������� a)�� located in dedicated storage rooms conforming to Subsection 4.3.13., and

����������������������� b)�� located in conformance with Table 4.3.12.4.

������������ 2)�� When quantities greater than are permitted for incidental use in Subsection 4.2.8. are required for special process operations, storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids are permitted to be located outside of a storage room referred to in Sentence (1), provided that

����������������������� a)�� total quantities per fire compartment are not more than one-half the quantities permitted in Table 4.3.12.4.,

����������������������� b)�� they are located on the first storey, and

����������������������� c)�� the installation conforms to Articles 4.3.12.7. to 4.3.12.10. and Article 4.3.13.4.

Table 4.3.12.4.

Indoor Tank Storage

Forming Part of Sentences 4.3.12.4.(1) and (2), and 4.3.12.6.(1)

Class of Liquid

Storage Level

Maximum Quantity per Storage Room (1) , L One or More Tanks

Protected (2)

Unprotected Storage

Class I

First storey Storeys above the first storey Basement

40 000

7 500

Not Permitted

25 000

Not Permitted

Not Permitted

Class II and IIIA

First storey Storeys above the first storey Basement

200 000

20 000

20 000

100 000

Not Permitted

Not Permitted

Notes to Table 4.3.12.4.:

����� 1��� See Subsection 4.3.13.

����� 2��� See Article 4.2.7.7.

4.3.12.5. Fire Compartments

������������ 1)�� Fire compartments regulated by this Subsection shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

4.3.12.6. Mixed Storage

������������ 1)�� When 2 or more classes of liquids are stored in a single storage room referred to in Sentence 4.3.12.4.(1), the total quantity permitted for each class of liquid shall be calculated as follows:

where

����������������������� qI �� = the actual quantity of Class I liquid present,

������� qII + IIIA �� = the actual quantity of Class II and IIIA liquid present,

���������������������� QI �� = the maximum quantity of Class I liquid permitted in Table 4.3.12.4.,

��������������������� QII + IIIA �� = the maximum quantity of Class II and IIIA liquid permitted in Table 4.3.12.4.

4.3.12.7. Storage Tanks outside Storage Rooms

������������ 1)�� Where storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids are located outside of storage rooms conforming to Subsection 4.3.13.,

����������������������� a)�� provision shall be made to contain 100% of the volume of the largest storage tank, or to drain away spilled flammable liquids or combustible liquids in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.,

����������������������� b)�� all electrical equipment and wiring in the vicinity of the storage tank and the exterior vent shall be installed in conformance with Subsection 4.1.4., and

����������������������� c)�� the floor area in which the storage tank is located shall be ventilated in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7.

4.3.12.8. Vents

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), normal and emergency vents for storage tanks in buildings shall be provided in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� Subsections 4.3.4. and 4.3.5. and the applicable requirements in Subsection 4.3.10., or

����������������������� b)�� good engineering practice for emergency venting of storage tanks inside buildings.

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� The use of weak roof-to-side shell seams, designed to rupture before the allowable design stress of the storage tank is reached, shall not be permitted as a means of emergency venting of storage tanks inside buildings.

4.3.12.9. Supports, Foundations and Anchorage

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), where storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids are installed inside buildings, the supports, foundations and anchorage for such storage tanks shall be in conformance with Subsection 4.3.3.

������������ 2)�� Where a storage tank is suspended, rather than supported on a foundation, supports shall be designed and installed in conformance with good engineering practice. (See Appendix A.)

4.3.12.10. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Where storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids are installed inside buildings, tanks, piping and discharge equipment shall be bonded and grounded.

4.3.13. �� Rooms for Storage Tanks

4.3.13.1. Design and Construction

������������ 1)�� Rooms for storage tanks inside buildings shall be

����������������������� a)�� separated from the rest of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of at least 2 h,

����������������������� b)�� designed to contain 100% of the volume of the largest storage tank, or to drain away spilled flammable liquids or combustible liquids in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.,

����������������������� c)�� made liquid-tight where the walls join the floor,

����������������������� d)�� provided with natural or mechanical ventilation in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7., and

����������������������� e)�� used for no other purposes than the storage and handling of flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

4.3.13.2. Clearances

������������ 1)�� A minimum clear space of 550 mm shall be maintained between the walls of a room described in Article 4.3.13.1. and the sides of any storage tanks within the room.

4.3.13.3. Explosion Venting

������������ 1)�� Where Class IA or IB liquids are dispensed within a storage room, the room shall be designed to prevent critical structural and mechanical damage from an internal explosion in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations." (See A-3.2.8.2.(1)(d) in Appendix A.)

4.3.13.4. Hose Stations and Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� In buildings not required to be equipped with a standpipe and hose system by the British Columbia Building Code, hose stations conforming to Article 6.2.3.4. shall be provided in the vicinity of the storage room, such that all parts of the room are within reach of a hose stream. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Portable extinguishers for Class B fires shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

4.3.13.5. Placards

������������ 1)�� Placards conforming to Article 3.2.7.14., identifying the liquids stored as flammable liquids or combustible liquids and the capacities of the storage tanks, shall be posted in a conspicuous location outside of the room, and that information shall be included in the fire safety plan required in Article 4.1.5.6.

4.3.14. �� Openings Other than Vents in Storage Tanks in Buildings

4.3.14.1. Connections

������������ 1)�� Connections for all openings in storage tanks in buildings shall be liquid and vapour tight.

������������ 2)�� Connections to storage tanks through which liquid can flow shall be provided with valves located as close as practicable to the tank.

4.3.14.2. Openings for Liquid Level Measurement

������������ 1)�� Openings that are independent of the fill pipe and are used for measuring the liquid level in storage tanks containing Class I or II liquids shall be equipped with a vapour-tight cap which shall be opened only when measuring the liquid level.

������������ 2)�� Openings referred to in Sentence (1) shall be protected against overflow and vapour pressure by means of a spring-loaded check valve.

4.3.15. �� Leakage Testing of Storage Tanks

4.3.15.1. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� Every storage tank shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Sentences (2) to (4)

����������������������� a)�� whenever a leak is suspected, and

����������������������� b)�� at the time of installation

������������������������������������ i)��� before backfilling in the case of an underground tank, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� before filling or putting into service in the case of an aboveground tank.

������������ 2)�� When a leakage test is required by Sentence (1) on an aboveground storage tank, it is permitted to determine the source of leakage

����������������������� a)�� by a visual examination of the tank shell, and

����������������������� b)�� where the bottom is not amenable to such examination, by testing the bottom of the tank in conformance with Sentence (3).

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Articles 4.3.15.4. and 4.3.15.5., when a leakage test is required by Sentence (1) on an underground storage tank, it shall be done by qualified personnel using equipment conforming to

����������������������� a)�� ULC/ORD-C58.12, "Leak Detection Devices (Volumetric Type) for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks," or

����������������������� b)�� ULC/ORD-C58.14, "Nonvolumetric Leak Detection Devices for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks" (see Appendix A).

������������ 4)�� Where field test methods are included in the tank construction standards referred to in Articles 4.3.1.2. and 4.3.1.3., such tests shall be permitted for storage tanks conforming to those standards.

4.3.15.2. Retention of Records

������������ 1)�� Records of tests referred to in Article 4.3.15.1. shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.2.

4.3.15.3. Remedial Action

������������ 1)�� When a leak is detected in a storage tank by a leakage test required in this Subsection or by a leakage detection measure required in Subsection 4.3.16.,

����������������������� a)�� the storage tank shall

������������������������������������ i)��� be replaced, in the case of an underground tank, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� be repaired or replaced, in the case of an aboveground tank, and

����������������������� b)�� the escaped liquid shall be removed in conformance with Article 4.1.6.3.

������������ 2)�� The authority having jurisdiction shall be notified within 24 h of detection of a leak referred to in Sentence (1).

4.3.15.4. Pneumatic Leakage Tests

������������ 1)�� Pneumatic leakage tests shall not be performed on field-erected aboveground storage tanks.

������������ 2)�� Pneumatic leakage tests shall not be performed on storage tanks with flammable liquids or combustible liquids in the tanks.

������������ 3)�� Where a pneumatic leakage test is performed on an underground storage tank, the tank shall be considered to be leaking when the test indicates a pressure drop within a 2 h period after steady temperature conditions have been established and the source of pressure has been removed.

������������ 4)�� Pneumatic test pressures applied to underground storage tanks shall be measured by an instrument calibrated in increments of not more than 1 kPa.

������������ 5)�� Where a pneumatic leakage test is conducted before an underground tank is backfilled in the case of a new tank, or after the tank is uncovered in the case of a previously installed tank, the test pressure shall be in conformance with the production testing requirements of

����������������������� a)�� CAN/ULC-S603, "Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� b)�� CAN4-S615-M, "Reinforced Plastic Underground Tanks for Petroleum Products."

������������ 6)�� Where a pneumatic leakage test is performed on a completely buried storage tank, the test pressure shall be not less than 35 and not more than 70 kPa (gauge).

������������ 7)�� Measures shall be taken to guard against the hazards associated with pneumatic leakage testing where explosive mixtures of vapours from flammable liquids or combustible liquids and air may be present in the area of a tank that has been in use.

4.3.15.5. Liquid Media Leakage Tests

������������ 1)�� Where a leakage test incorporating a liquid test medium, including a flammable liquid or combustible liquid, is performed on an underground storage tank, the tank shall be considered to be leaking when, with compensation for volume differentials caused by effects of temperature and tank shell distortion, the test indicates a liquid loss.

������������ 2)�� The pressure at the bottom of a storage tank shall not exceed 70 kPa (gauge) during the leakage test referred to in Sentence (1).

4.3.16. �� Leakage Detection of Storage Tanks

4.3.16.1. Liquid Level Measurements

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.3.16.2., the liquid level in any storage tank shall be measured at intervals not greater than 7 days in conformance with Sentences (2) to (4), except that at fuel dispensing stations the measurements shall be taken each day the station is in operation.

������������ 2)�� The level of water at the bottom of an underground storage tank shall be measured at intervals not greater than 7 days, except that at fuel dispensing stations the measurements shall be taken each day the station is in operation.

������������ 3)�� A comparison of the measurements described in Sentences (1) and (2) with meter readings and a computation of any gain or loss of liquid shall be done each time a required measurement is taken.

������������ 4)�� A record for each storage tank showing the measurements and computations described in Sentence (3) shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

4.3.16.2. Continuous Leakage Detection

������������ 1)�� The measurements described in Article 4.3.16.1. are not required for an underground storage tank when

����������������������� a)�� it is provided with a continuous leakage detection device conforming to

������������������������������������ i)��� ULC/ORD-C58.12, "Leak Detection Devices (Volumetric Type) for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks," or

����������������������������������� ii)��� ULC/ORD-C58.14, "Nonvolumetric Leak Detection Devices for Underground Flammable Liquid Storage Tanks," and

����������������������� b)�� its associated underground piping is provided with continuous leakage detection conforming to Article 4.4.6.7.

4.3.16.3. Corrective Action

������������ 1)�� Immediate corrective action shall be taken in conformance with Subsection 4.3.15. when

����������������������� a)�� a loss of liquid or a gain of water is indicated by any of the leakage detection measures described in Articles 4.3.16.1. and 4.3.16.2., or (See Appendix A.)

����������������������� b)�� the level of water at the bottom of an underground storage tank exceeds 50 mm.

Section 4.4. �� Piping and Transfer Systems

4.4.1. �� Scope

4.4.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to piping and transfer systems for flammable liquids and combustible liquids.

������������ 2)�� Except where otherwise stated in this Part, this Section shall not apply to the following:

����������������������� a)�� tubing or casings and piping for oil or gas wells,

����������������������� b)�� piping for vehicles, aircraft, watercraft and portable or stationary engines,

����������������������� c)�� piping systems in fuel dispensing stations and distilleries,

����������������������� d)�� piping systems on piers and wharves, and

����������������������� e)�� piping within the scope of the applicable provincial boiler and pressure vessel codes.

4.4.2. �� Materials for Piping, Valves and Fittings

4.4.2.1. Materials

������������ 1)�� Materials for piping systems containing flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be suitable for the maximum anticipated working pressures and operating temperatures and for the chemical properties of the contained liquid.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence (3), the use of the following materials for piping systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall not be permitted:

����������������������� a)�� materials that are subject to failure from internal stress or rupture by mechanical damage, or

����������������������� b)�� combustible or low-melting-point materials that are subject to failure even in moderate fires.

������������ 3)�� Non-metallic piping systems are permitted to be used for underground installations provided they conform to

����������������������� a)�� ULC/ORD-C107.7, "Glass Fibre Reinforced Plastic Pipe and Fittings for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� b)�� ULC/ORD-C107.4, "Ducted Flexible Underground Piping Systems for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 4)�� Except as provided in Sentence (5), where steel piping is used, it shall conform to

����������������������� a)�� API 5L, "Line Pipe,"

����������������������� b)�� ASTM A 53, "Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated, Welded and Seamless," or

����������������������� c)�� CSA Z245.1, "Steel Line Pipe."

������������ 5)�� Where service pressures exceeding 875 kPa (gauge) may occur, piping and fittings shall be designed in conformance with ANSI/ASME B31.3, "Chemical Plant and Petroleum Refinery Piping."

4.4.2.2. Special Materials

������������ 1)�� Where problems of corrosion, contamination, or sanitation or standards of purity require special materials, it is permitted to use non-metallic materials for piping, valves and fittings in conformance with Subsection 1.1.2.

4.4.3. �� Corrosion Protection of Piping Systems

4.4.3.1. Corrosion Protection

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), all exposed and underground piping, valves, couplings, flanges and bolts for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be protected where necessary against external corrosion.

������������ 2)�� Underground steel piping, valves and fittings shall be protected against corrosion in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� CAN/ULC-S603.1, "Galvanic Corrosion Protection Systems for Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� b)�� good engineering practice such as described in PACE Report No. 87-1, "Impressed Current Method of Cathodic Protection of Underground Petroleum Storage Tanks" published by the Canadian Petroleum Products Institute.

4.4.4. �� Identification of Piping Systems

4.4.4.1. Identification

������������ 1)�� Pipelines for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be marked with the contents of the line, and these markings shall be maintained in a clearly legible form.

������������ 2)�� Piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be painted red.

������������ 3)�� Transfer points in piping systems for flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be identified in conformance with CPPI, "Using the CPPI Colour-Symbol System to Mark Equipment and Vehicles for Product Identification."

4.4.4.2. Plans

������������ 1)�� Plans showing piping systems for flammable liquids or combustible liquids, including tank and pumping arrangements, shall be available to the fire department on request.

������������ 2)�� Sets of plans shall be kept at 2 separate locations.

4.4.5. �� Joints in Piping Systems

4.4.5.1. Threaded Joints

������������ 1)�� Threaded joints in piping systems for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be made using joint compound or polytetrafluoroethylene tape conforming to CAN/ULC-S642-M, "Compounds and Tapes for Threaded Pipe Joints."

4.4.5.2. Welded Piping

������������ 1) Welding of piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall conform to Section 5.2. and to provincial or territorial regulations or, in the absence of such regulations, to

����������������������� a)�� API 1104, "Welding Pipelines and Related Facilities," or

����������������������� b)�� API RP 1107, "Recommended Pipeline Maintenance Welding Practices."

������������ 2)�� Flanged joints for piping shall be provided in welded systems at intervals which will facilitate dismantling and avoid subsequent in-place cutting and welding operations.

4.4.5.3. Flanged Joints

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), flanged joints for piping shall be made with forged or cast steel flanges designed, constructed and installed in conformance with ANSI/ASME B16.5, "Pipe Flanges and Flanged Fittings."

������������ 2)�� Bronze flanges for 50 mm diameter or smaller size piping referred to in Article 4.4.5.2. are permitted to be used where copper and brass piping is permitted.

4.4.5.4. Bolting Materials

������������ 1)�� Bolting materials for flanged connections in steel piping systems for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be of alloy steel equivalent to ASTM A 193/A 193M, "Alloy-Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High Temperature Service," Grade B-7.

4.4.5.5. Gaskets

������������ 1)�� Gaskets in flanged connections shall be of a material resistant to the liquid being carried and capable of withstanding temperatures of 650�C and above without damage.

4.4.6. �� Leakage Testing of Piping Systems

4.4.6.1. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� Piping systems including those at fuel dispensing stations shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Sentences (2) and (3)

����������������������� a)�� whenever a leak is suspected, and

����������������������� b)�� at the time of installation

������������������������������������ i)��� before backfilling in the case of underground piping, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� before putting into service in the case of exposed piping.

������������ 2)�� Exposed piping systems in service are permitted to be visually inspected for leakage in conformance with Article 4.4.11.5.

������������ 3)�� When exposed piping systems are subjected to a pneumatic leakage test,

����������������������� a)�� it shall be in conformance with Article 4.4.6.4., and

����������������������� b)�� the piping, including the joints, shall be soaped to assist in the detection of leaks.

4.4.6.2. Retention of Records

������������ 1)�� Records of the pressure tests on piping systems shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

4.4.6.3. Remedial Action

������������ 1)�� If a leak is detected in a piping system during the leakage test, the piping system shall be repaired or replaced and the escaped liquid shall be removed in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.4.6.4. Pneumatic Leakage Tests

������������ 1)�� Piping systems referred to in Sentence 4.4.6.1.(3) shall be considered to be leaking when the test indicates a pressure drop or a volume loss within a 2 h period after steady temperature conditions have been established and the source of pressure has been removed.

������������ 2)�� Pressure measurements referred to in Sentence (1) shall be obtained by using instruments calibrated in increments of not more than

����������������������� a)�� 4 kPa for test pressures up to 700 kPa (gauge), and

����������������������� b)�� 1% of the test pressure where it exceeds 700 kPa (gauge).

4.4.6.5. Test Pressures

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3) and Article 4.4.6.6., piping systems shall be pressure tested at pressures of not less than 350 kPa (gauge) or 1.5 times the maximum operating pressure, whichever is greater.

������������ 2)�� Test pressures exceeding 700 kPa (gauge) shall not be permitted except when the piping system is designed for such pressures.

������������ 3)�� Where test pressures exceed the design pressures for pumps or similar components included in the piping system being tested, such pumps or components shall be isolated from the remainder of the system.

4.4.6.6. Class I Liquids as a Test Medium

������������ 1)�� Class I liquids shall not be used for pressure testing piping systems, except that pressure piping normally containing Class I liquids is permitted to be tested with such liquids at pressures not exceeding their maximum operating pressures.

4.4.6.7. Leakage Detection

������������ 1)�� When an underground piping system is provided with continuous leakage detection, it shall be in conformance with ULC/ORD-C107.12, "Line Leak Detection Devices for Flammable Liquid Piping."

4.4.7. �� Location and Arrangement of Piping

4.4.7.1. Location

������������ 1)�� Piping shall be installed outdoors whenever possible and located so it will not create a hazard to buildings or equipment.

������������ 2)�� Where piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids is installed within a building, the length of piping shall be as direct and as short as practicable.

4.4.7.2. Supports for Aboveground Outdoor Piping

������������ 1)�� Aboveground outdoor piping shall be supported and arranged to prevent excessive vibration and stress on equipment connected to it.

������������ 2)�� When vehicular impact or physical damage is possible, protective guarding devices shall be provided for piping referred to in Sentence (1) and for fill pipes for storage tanks.

4.4.7.3. Arrangement of Aboveground Outdoor Piping

������������ 1)�� Aboveground outdoor piping shall not be located

����������������������� a)�� on the exterior of walls except on those of noncombustible construction, or

����������������������� b)�� above windows.

������������ 2)�� Aboveground outdoor piping shall not be located above roofs except above roofs of impermeable and noncombustible construction, with provision for accidental spillage provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 3)�� Where aboveground piping crosses roadways or railway sidings, ample overhead clearance and warning signs indicating the clearance height shall be provided.

������������ 4)�� Piping passing though secondary containment walls shall be designed to prevent excessive stress resulting from settlement or fire exposure.

4.4.7.4. Underground Piping

������������ 1)�� Underground piping shall be located so it will not be damaged as a result of vibrations or settling of an adjacent building or structure.

������������ 2)�� Underground piping shall be located not less than 300 mm away from the foundations of any building or structure, except where such piping enters the building as permitted in Article 4.4.7.7.

������������ 3)�� Piping passing under railway tracks shall be installed in conformance with CTC 1977-3 RAIL, "Pipe Crossings Under Railways (No. E-10) Regulations," of Transport Canada.

������������ 4)�� Piping adjacent to railway tracks shall be installed in conformance with General Order No. O-32, "Flammable Liquids Bulk Storage Regulations," of Transport Canada.

4.4.7.5. Installation of Underground Piping

������������ 1)�� Underground piping shall be

����������������������� a)�� supported on undisturbed or compacted soil, and

����������������������� b)�� backfilled on the top and sides with not less than

������������������������������������ i)��� 300 mm of pea gravel or clean crushed stone, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� 300 mm of clean sand, free of cinders and stones and compacted in layers not more than 300 mm thick.

������������ 2)�� Where it is not practicable to support piping as required in Sentence (1) on undisturbed soil, it shall be supported on not less than 150 mm of clean sand, pea gravel or washed, crushed stone.

4.4.7.6. Piping in Service Tunnels

������������ 1)�� Piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall not be located in service tunnels that are used for pedestrian traffic.

4.4.7.7. Piping at Entrances to Buildings

������������ 1)�� Piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be located aboveground where the piping enters a building.

������������ 2)�� Piping referred to in Sentence (1) shall be provided with inside and outside shut-off valves.

������������ 3)�� Where piping referred to in Sentence (1) passes through a wall which would restrict the expansion or contraction of the piping, pipe sleeves shall be provided at the wall penetration to facilitate such movement.

4.4.7.8. Indoor Piping

������������ 1)�� Indoor piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall either be supported overhead or be located in trenches conforming to Article 4.4.7.9.

������������ 2)�� Piping referred to in Sentence (1) shall not be installed under combustible flooring.

4.4.7.9. Piping in Trenches

������������ 1)�� Where indoor piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids is installed in trenches, a trapped drainage system conforming to Subsection 4.1.6. shall be provided.

������������ 2)�� When piping referred to in Sentence (1) contains Class I liquids, the trench shall be

����������������������� a)�� provided with positive ventilation to the outdoors, or

����������������������� b)�� designed to prevent the accumulation of flammable vapours.

4.4.7.10. Overhead Piping

������������ 1)�� Overhead piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be installed close to the ceiling or beams or along walls not less than 1.8 m above the floor to protect it against mechanical damage.

������������ 2)�� Where practicable, overhead piping referred to in Sentence (1) shall be supported from building framing members.

������������ 3)�� In buildings of steel frame construction, piping referred to in Sentence (1) shall be fastened to steel beams or columns by pipe hangers attached to the flanges.

������������ 4)�� Piping under concrete ceilings shall be suspended with the use of through bolts or expansion shields.

4.4.7.11. Supports for Overhead Piping

������������ 1)�� Piping shall be supported on pipe hangers or other supports so that allowable stresses in the pipe are not exceeded. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Anchors of the expansion shield type used to suspend piping shall not be used to suspend piping from unsound or lightweight concrete or from gypsum assemblies.

4.4.7.12. Protection of Pipe Risers

������������ 1)�� Exposed pipe risers shall be protected against mechanical damage by

����������������������� a)�� installing such risers

������������������������������������ i)��� adjacent to walls or pilasters,

����������������������������������� ii)��� between flanges of steel columns, or

���������������������������������� iii)��� within securely anchored larger perforated pipe, and

����������������������� b)�� providing mechanical guards where the risers are exposed to mobile equipment.

4.4.7.13. Provision for Expansion and Contraction

������������ 1)�� In the design of flammable liquid or combustible liquid piping systems, provision shall be made for thermal expansion and contraction.

������������ 2)�� Flexible hose connectors conforming to CAN/ULC-S633-M, "Flexible Underground Hose Connectors for Flammable and Combustible Liquids" are permitted to be used where necessary in systems carrying flammable liquids or combustible liquids to prevent excessive stresses resulting from vibration, settling or temperature changes.

4.4.8. �� Valves in Piping Systems

4.4.8.1. Design

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), valves in piping systems for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be designed to accommodate the temperatures and pressures of those systems and shall conform to ULC-C842-M, "Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 2)�� Every hose nozzle valve shall conform to CAN/ULC-S620-M, "Hose Nozzle Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 3)�� Every emergency valve shall conform to CAN/ULC-S651-M, "Emergency Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

4.4.8.2. Shut-Off Valves

������������ 1) Shut-off valves shall be provided in all flammable liquid or combustible liquid piping and pumping systems.

������������ 2)�� Where practicable, valves referred to in Sentence (1) shall be located outdoors or be immediately accessible from outdoors.

������������ 3)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (4), steel shut-off valves shall be provided

����������������������� a)�� at connections to all aboveground storage tanks,

����������������������� b)�� on supply piping where it enters buildings or structures,

����������������������� c)�� on branch lines from the main supply line,

����������������������� d)�� on supply lines at dispensing locations, and

����������������������� e)�� to isolate one part of a piping system from another.

������������ 4)�� Stainless steel, monel metal or lined steel bodied valves are permitted to be used when special conditions warrant their use.

4.4.8.3. Diaphragm Valves

������������ 1) Diaphragm valves shall have no direct connections between the liquid and air sections that might permit leakage of the liquid past the packing into the air lines.

4.4.8.4. Globe Valves

������������ 1)�� Globe valves shall be arranged so that the packing is on the low pressure side.

4.4.8.5. Indicating Valves

������������ 1)�� Rising stem or other indicating valves shall be used where necessary to determine whether the valves are open or shut.

4.4.8.6. Meters

������������ 1) Where cast iron meters are used, they shall be isolated by the use of steel valves.

4.4.8.7. Identification

������������ 1)�� All valves shall be identified in conformance with CPPI, "Using the CPPI Colour-Symbol System to Mark Equipment and Vehicles for Product Identification."

������������ 2)�� Every identification tag shall be kept clean so that its colour and inscription are easily recognizable.

4.4.9. �� Heating of Piping Systems

4.4.9.1. Design

������������ 1)�� Heating equipment for piping systems containing flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be designed not to overheat or create an ignition source for the liquids being heated.

4.4.9.2. Steam Heating

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquid and combustible liquid piping is permitted to be heated by steam lines provided the minimum steam temperature and pressure to make the liquid fluid are used and Sentences (2) and (3) are complied with.

������������ 2)�� A pressure regulator shall be provided in the steam line with a relief valve on the downstream side of the regulator.

������������ 3)�� Piping and steam lines shall be enclosed in insulation conforming to the British Columbia Building Code.

4.4.9.3. Electrical Heating Cables

������������ 1)�� Electrical heating cables including electrical induction heating shall conform to Subsection 4.1.4.

4.4.9.4. Thermal Electrical Conduction Heating

������������ 1)�� Thermal electrical conduction heating conforming to Sentence (2) is permitted to be used by passing a low-voltage alternating current through the pipe.

������������ 2)�� Systems permitted in Sentence (1) shall be installed and tested as complete units and shall conform to the following:

����������������������� a)�� unheated sections of piping shall be isolated from heated sections by means of nonconductive fittings;

����������������������� b)�� thermostatic controls, high temperature limit controls and fuses shall have the lowest practical rating to ensure satisfactory operation;

����������������������� c)�� all parts of the piping and fittings shall be enclosed by insulating coverings of a type which will prevent accidental grounding of the systems; and

����������������������� d)�� switches, transformers, contactors and other spark-producing equipment shall be located in an area not subject to flammable vapours.

������������ 3)�� Upon completion of installation, systems permitted in Sentence (1) shall be tested to ensure that all components are functioning as intended.

4.4.9.5. Open Flames

������������ 1) The use of open flames as a heat source shall not be permitted for heating piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

4.4.10. �� Methods of Transfer in Piping Systems

4.4.10.1. Location of Outdoor Pumps

������������ 1)�� Pumps for flammable liquid or combustible liquid piping systems installed aboveground and outside of buildings shall be located not less than

����������������������� a)�� 3 m from the property line, and

����������������������� b)�� 1.5 m from building openings.

4.4.10.2. Pump Houses and Pump Rooms

������������ 1)�� Pumps located indoors shall be in rooms that conform to Subsection 4.2.9.

������������ 2)�� Pump houses and pump rooms shall not be used for any purpose other than to serve the pumping equipment.

4.4.10.3. Pits

������������ 1)�� Pits for subsurface pumps for piping systems or for piping connected to submersible pumps shall be designed to withstand the forces to which they may be subjected without causing damage to the system.

������������ 2)�� Pits provided in conformance with Sentence (1) shall not be larger than necessary for inspection and maintenance and shall be provided with a cover.

4.4.10.4. Control Switches

������������ 1)�� Pumps for piping systems shall be provided with duplicate control switches to shut down the pumps in case of emergency, with one located in the operating area and the other at a remote location.

4.4.10.5. Hydraulic Transfer Systems

������������ 1)�� Where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are transferred by water pressure as a result of displacement, such system shall not be used for liquids that are miscible in water.

������������ 2)�� All pressure vessels for hydraulic transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be constructed, installed and tested in conformance with ANSI/ASME, "Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code."

������������ 3)�� Hydraulic transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed to prevent water pressure in excess of the design pressure of the tank or piping.

������������ 4)�� Operating pressures shall be controlled by a constant-level float valve or a pressure-regulating valve on the water supply side of the hydraulic transfer system referred to in Sentence (1).

������������ 5)�� Hydraulic transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be arranged so that there is no water pressure on the system except when liquid is being discharged.

������������ 6)�� Check valves shall be provided for both water and flammable liquid or combustible liquid piping to prevent back-flow in hydraulic transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1).

4.4.10.6. Inert Gas Transfer Systems

������������ 1)�� Where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are transferred as a result of displacement by the expansion of nitrogen, carbon dioxide or other inert gases, all pressure vessels involved shall be constructed, installed and tested in conformance with ANSI/ASME, "Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code."

������������ 2)�� Pressure regulators for inert gas transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be provided in the gas line to control the pressure of the gas at the minimum pressure required to force the liquid through the piping system at the required rate.

������������ 3)�� A relief valve with a slightly higher setting than the pressure required in Sentence (1) shall be provided on the downstream side of the regulator or on the tank.

������������ 4)�� Means of automatically shutting off the gas supply and bleeding the gas pressure in the event of fire shall be provided on all inert gas transfer systems referred to in Sentence (1).

4.4.10.7. Non-Inert Gas Transfer

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids in a closed piping system by means of compressed air or other non-inert gas pressure shall not be permitted.

������������ 2)�� A non-inert gas pressure is permitted to be used in a closed piping system referred to in Sentence (1) provided

����������������������� a)�� it is the vapour or gas of the flammable liquid or combustible liquid being transferred, or

����������������������� b)�� it is a vapour or gas that will not support combustion reaction and is non-reactive with the flammable liquid or combustible liquid being transferred.

4.4.11. �� Operating Procedures for Piping Systems

4.4.11.1. Procedures

������������ 1)�� Standard procedures for normal operation and for emergencies shall be given in printed form to all employees engaged in the operation of equipment for the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids and shall be posted for convenient reference.

4.4.11.2. Training

������������ 1)�� All employees concerned with transfer operations involving flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be trained in

����������������������� a)�� the emergency procedures referred to in Article 4.4.11.1.,

����������������������� b)�� the importance of constant attendance during all loading or unloading operations,

����������������������� c)�� extinguishing procedures for fires involving flammable liquids and combustible liquids, and

����������������������� d)�� the flammable liquid and combustible liquid colour coding and identification system required in Article 4.4.8.7.

������������ 2)�� Employees engaged in the operation of equipment for the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be trained in the location, function and operation of valves used for the operation of fire protection equipment and manual emergency shut-off valves.

4.4.11.3. Emergency Valves

������������ 1)�� Signs indicating the location of valves used for the operation of fire protection equipment and manual emergency shut-off valves shall be posted in conspicuous locations.

4.4.11.4. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� One 80-B:C rated portable extinguisher or two 40-B:C units shall be provided in the vicinity of pumps and ancillary equipment used for the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

4.4.11.5. Visual Inspections

������������ 1)�� A visual inspection routine for the prompt detection of obviously abnormal conditions shall be established and shall be performed at least once each shift.

������������ 2)�� A visual inspection shall be made at least once during each day of operation of all aboveground piping systems, pumps and other ancillary equipment, to detect leakage, and any such leakage shall be repaired as quickly as practicable.

������������ 3)�� Where necessary, flammable vapour indicators shall be used to detect leakage.

������������ 4)�� Open flames and spark-producing devices shall not be used for leakage detection referred to in Sentence (2).

4.4.11.6. Operational Tests

������������ 1)�� To ensure proper operation, frequent inspections and tests shall be made of all safety shut-off valves and other fire safety devices, with particular attention directed to normally open, fusible-link-operated valves, float valves and automatic controls.

4.4.11.7. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (6), maintenance shall not be carried out on piping systems while they are under pressure.

������������ 2)�� If connections or piping are to be opened, the system shall be drained of flammable liquids and combustible liquids.

������������ 3)�� Where equipment for handling flammable liquids or combustible liquids has to be repaired, it shall be removed and taken to maintenance areas when possible.

������������ 4)�� Tags shall be attached to all valves on piping systems that are shut off for maintenance purposes to indicate that such valves are not to be opened.

������������ 5)�� Piping that has been used for the transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be removed or capped when it is no longer intended to be used.

������������ 6)�� Connections to pressurized piping systems shall be made in conformance with good practice such as described in

����������������������� a)�� API RP 1107, "Recommended Pipeline Maintenance Welding Practices,"

����������������������� b)�� API 2200, "Repairs to Crude Oil, Liquefied Petroleum Gas and Products Pipelines," or

����������������������� c)�� API 2201, "Welding or Hot Tapping on Equipment Containing Flammables."

Section 4.5. �� Fuel Dispensing Stations

4.5.1. �� Scope

4.5.1.1. Application

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to the storage, handling and use of flammable liquids and combustible liquids at fuel dispensing stations and includes airports not regulated by Federal legislation.

4.5.2. �� Storage and Handling

4.5.2.1. Outside Aboveground Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), the installation of outside aboveground storage tanks at fuel dispensing stations shall be in conformance with Subsection 4.3.2.

������������ 2)�� Outside aboveground storage tanks at fuel dispensing stations shall have an individual capacity of not more than 50 000 L, and their aggregate capacity shall not exceed 150 000 L.

������������ 3)�� Outside aboveground storage tanks at fuel dispensing stations shall be provided with

����������������������� a)�� physical protection against collision damage,

����������������������� b)�� measures to prevent unauthorized access to the storage tank and its ancillary equipment, and

����������������������� c)�� measures to contain accidental spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.3.7.

4.5.2.2. Class I Liquids in Buildings

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence 4.1.8.4.(2), Class I liquids shall not be stored or handled within a fuel dispensing station unless the building conforms to Subsection 4.2.9.

������������ 2)�� Class I liquids shall not be stored or handled within any building having a basement, cellar or pit in which flammable vapours may accumulate. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� The location of dispensers of Class I liquids within a building shall conform to Subsection 3.3.5. of the British Columbia Building Code.

4.5.2.3. Storage Tanks in Buildings

������������ 1)�� Where Class IIIA liquids are stored and dispensed inside buildings from storage tanks, the individual tanks shall have a capacity of not more than 2 500 L and the aggregate capacity of all the tanks shall not exceed 10 000 L.

������������ 2)�� All fill pipes, vent piping and valves associated with the storage tanks referred to in Sentence (1)

����������������������� a)�� shall conform to Subsections 4.3.5. and 4.3.6., and

����������������������� b)�� shall be permanently marked to indicate the liquid in each tank and the equipment controlled by the valves.

4.5.2.4. Marine Fuel Dispensing Stations

������������ 1)�� Dispensers at marine fuel dispensing stations shall be at a location which will permit safe access by watercraft.

4.5.2.5. Containers

������������ 1)�� All packaged flammable liquid and combustible liquid products stored or sold at a fuel dispensing station shall be in closed containers conforming to Article 4.2.3.1., distinctly marked with the generic name of the liquid they contain.

������������ 2)�� At fuel dispensing stations, every container for dispensing flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be kept tightly closed when disconnected from its pumping apparatus.

������������ 3)�� Every container referred to in Sentence (2) that is equipped with a pump shall have a vapour-tight connection between the pump and the container.

4.5.2.6. Empty Containers

������������ 1)�� The storage of empty containers which previously contained flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall conform to Sentences 4.5.2.2.(1) and (2) and 4.5.2.5.(2).

4.5.2.7. Filling of Containers

������������ 1)�� Containers shall not be filled beyond their safe filling level.

4.5.2.8. Piping

������������ 1)�� All piping for flammable liquids or combustible liquids at a fuel dispensing station shall be in conformance with Article 4.4.2.1.

4.5.2.9. Corrosion Protection for Piping

������������ 1)�� All piping, valves and fittings at a fuel dispensing station shall be protected against corrosion in conformance with Article 4.4.3.1.

4.5.2.10. Piping Supports and Guards

������������ 1)�� Piping shall be firmly supported and protected by installing guards when necessary to prevent vehicle impact or other mechanical damage.

4.5.2.11. Pits

������������ 1)�� Pits for subsurface pumps or for piping connected to submersed pumps shall conform to Article 4.4.10.3.

4.5.3. �� Dispensing Systems

4.5.3.1. Dispensers

������������ 1)�� Fixed dispensers for flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall conform to CSA B346-M, "Power-Operated Dispensing Devices for Flammable Liquids."

4.5.3.2. Location

������������ 1)�� Fixed dispensers for Class I liquids shall be installed outside buildings and not less than

����������������������� a)�� 3 m from any right-of-way and any property line,

����������������������� b)�� 3 m from any propane gas dispenser,

����������������������� c)�� 1.5 m from any natural gas dispenser,

����������������������� d)�� 6 m horizontally from any fixed source of ignition, and

����������������������� e)�� 3 m from any building opening, except those openings in buildings for the shelter of operating personnel in which electrical installations conform to Article 4.1.4.1.

������������ 2)�� Fixed dispensers for Class II or IIIA liquids are permitted to be installed inside a building when

����������������������� a)�� the building is not open to the public,

����������������������� b)�� the dispensers are located on the first storey,

����������������������� c)�� drainage is provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6., and

����������������������� d)�� ventilation is provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7. of this Code and with the requirements for storage garages in Part 6 of the British Columbia Building Code.

4.5.3.3. Protection against Collision Damage

������������ 1)�� Fixed dispensers shall be protected against collision damage by

����������������������� a)�� a concrete island not less than 100 mm high, or

����������������������� b)�� posts or guardrails.

4.5.4. �� Shut-Off Devices

4.5.4.1. Location and Identification

������������ 1)�� Devices to shut off the power to all dispensers shall be provided at a remote location or shielded from any fire that might occur in the dispensing area.

������������ 2)�� The shut-off devices required in Sentence (1) shall be clearly identified and easily accessible.

4.5.4.2. Self-Service Outlets

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), an emergency shut-off switch to stop all dispensers at self-service outlets shall be located at the central control console described in Sentence 4.5.8.2.(2) so that it is readily accessible to the attendant.

������������ 2)�� At card or key activated self-service outlets, the emergency shut-off switch required in Sentence (1) shall be readily accessible to the customer.

4.5.4.3. Marine Fuel Dispensing Stations

������������ 1)�� At marine fuel dispensing stations a readily accessible valve shall be provided in each pipeline at or within 7.5 m of the pier to shut off the supply from shore.

4.5.5. �� Delivery Hose and Nozzles

4.5.5.1. Delivery Hose

������������ 1)�� Delivery hose shall conform to CAN/ULC-S612-M, "Hose for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 2)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (3) and (4), hose through which flammable liquids or combustible liquids are dispensed at a fuel dispensing station shall be restricted to a maximum extended length of 4.5 m.

������������ 3)�� Where a retracting mechanism is used, a maximum extended length of 6 m shall be permitted.

������������ 4)�� At marine fuel dispensing stations or at card or key activated dispensers, the length of extended hose is permitted to exceed the values in Sentences (2) and (3).

4.5.5.2. Hose Nozzle Valves

������������ 1)�� Every hose nozzle valve through which a Class I or II liquid is dispensed by a motorized dispenser into a vehicle tank shall

����������������������� a)�� be automatic closing as required in Sentence (2), and

����������������������� b)�� conform to CAN/ULC-S620-M, "Hose Nozzle Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentences (3) and (4), a hose nozzle valve shall be constructed so that the valve

����������������������� a)�� can be kept open only by the continuous application of manual pressure, or

����������������������� b)�� is equipped with a hold-open device that is an integral part of the nozzle which will

������������������������������������ i)��� allow automatic dispensing,

����������������������������������� ii)��� automatically shut off when the vehicle tank is filled, and

���������������������������������� iii)��� shut off if the nozzle is dropped or falls from the fill pipe.

������������ 3)�� When a hose nozzle valve with a hold-open device is used at an attended self-service outlet, a break-away coupling conforming to CAN/ULC-S644-M, "Emergency Breakaway Fittings for Flammable and Combustible Liquids" shall be provided.

������������ 4)�� When the flow of liquid can be stopped other than by the hose nozzle valve, a hose nozzle valve with a hold-open device is permitted to be used only if it is provided with a device that will automatically close the hose nozzle valve upon a drop of pressure in the dispensing hose.

4.5.6. �� Remote Pumping Systems

4.5.6.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to systems for dispensing flammable liquids or combustible liquids where such liquids are transferred from bulk storage to individual or multiple dispensers by pumps located elsewhere than at the dispensers.

4.5.6.2. Pumps and Control Equipment

������������ 1)�� Pumps, including associated control equipment, shall be designed so that the system will not be subject to pressures above the design working pressure.

������������ 2)�� Pumps shall be securely anchored and protected against damage from vehicles.

4.5.6.3. Emergency Valves

������������ 1)�� An emergency valve conforming to CAN/ULC-S651-M, "Emergency Valves for Flammable and Combustible Liquids" shall be installed in the supply line so that the shear point of the valve is at a level not higher than the base of the dispenser nor more than 25 mm below it.

������������ 2)�� The emergency valve required in Sentence (1) shall be maintained in operating condition and serviced at intervals not greater than 12 months.

4.5.6.4. Pump Location

������������ 1)�� Pumps installed aboveground and outside buildings shall be located not less than

����������������������� a)�� 3 m from any property line, and

����������������������� b)�� 1.5 m from any building opening.

������������ 2)�� When an outside pump location is impractical, pumps are permitted to be installed inside buildings as provided in Article 4.5.2.2. or in pits as provided in Article 4.5.2.11.

4.5.6.5. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� After the completion of the installation, including paving, all underground piping connected to tanks shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Subsection 4.4.6.

4.5.6.6. Marine Fuel Dispensing Stations

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), tanks and pumps not integral with the dispenser at marine fuel dispensing stations shall be located on the shore or on a pier of the solid-fill type.

������������ 2)�� Where shore locations would result in excessively long supply lines to the dispenser, storage tanks are permitted to be installed on a pier provided that

����������������������� a)�� the applicable portions of Subsection 4.3.7. relating to spacing, secondary containment and piping are complied with, and

����������������������� b)�� the quantity stored does not exceed 5000 L aggregate capacity.

������������ 3)�� No storage tank at a marine fuel dispensing station shall be located closer than 4.5 m horizontally from the normal annual high-water mark.

������������ 4)�� Storage tanks located on shore and supplying marine fuel dispensing stations are permitted to be located aboveground where rock or a high water table make underground tanks impracticable.

������������ 5)�� Where storage tanks at a marine fuel dispensing station are at an elevation above the dispenser, an electrically operated solenoid valve, designed to open only when the dispenser is being operated, and to prevent gravity draining of the tank in the event of a rupture of the supply line to the dispenser, shall be provided at the storage tank outlet, positioned adjacent to and outside the valve specified in Article 4.3.6.1.

������������ 6)�� Piping between storage tanks located on shore and dispensers at a marine fuel dispensing station shall conform to Section 4.4., except that where dispensing is from a floating structure, it is permitted to use suitable lengths of flexible hose designed in conformance with good engineering practice between the piping on shore and the piping on the floating structure.(See A-4.7.8.1.(1)(a) in Appendix A.)

4.5.7. �� Spill Control

4.5.7.1. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Areas where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are dispensed shall be designed to accommodate accidental spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.5.8. �� Supervision and Dispensing Procedures

4.5.8.1. Attendants

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), every fuel dispensing station shall have at least one attendant on duty when the station is open for business.

������������ 2)�� Fuel dispensing stations which do not serve the general public do not require an attendant.

������������ 3)�� Except as permitted at self-service outlets, a qualified attendant shall be in constant control of the dispensing of Class I and II liquids into the fuel tanks of motor vehicles or watercraft or into containers.

������������ 4)�� Duties of attendants and fuel dispensing procedures, as stated in Articles 4.5.8.5. and 4.5.8.6., shall be posted at every fuel dispensing station.

������������ 5)�� At card/keylock fuel dispensing stations with on-site attendant(s) and when permitted by the authority having jurisdiction at fuel dispensing stations which provide full attended service, the attendant is permitted to dispense flammable liquids and combustible liquids into portable tanks conforming to either CSA B620 "Highway Tanks and Portable Tanks for the Transportation of Dangerous Goods" or drums meeting the requirements of the Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations, provided

����������������������� a)�� a grounding strap is installed at the dispenser, and

����������������������� b)�� the portable tank or drum is electrically connected to the grounding strap for protection against static charge during the filling procedure.

4.5.8.2. Self-Service Outlets

������������ 1)�� Instructions for the operation of dispensers in self-service outlets shall be posted in a conspicuous location.

������������ 2)�� A control console shall be provided at self-service outlets within 25 m of all dispensers so that the attendant has an unobstructed view of all units at the same time.

������������ 3)�� The control console referred to in Sentence (2) shall be equipped to regulate the operation of each dispenser.

������������ 4)�� A 2-way communication system between the control console and each pump island shall be provided at self-service outlets.

������������ 5)�� At fuel dispensing stations which provide both attended service and self-service, the attendant required in Sentence 4.5.8.1.(1) is permitted to dispense flammable liquids or combustible liquids at the attended service island, provided that

����������������������� a)�� each island has an emergency shut-off switch as described in Article 4.5.4.2., and

����������������������� b)�� the attendant is never more than 25 m from the self-service island or control console.

4.5.8.3. Special Dispensers

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.5.8.4. for card or key activated equipment, special dispensers including coin operated, card operated and preset units, shall not be permitted at self-service outlets unless there is at least one qualified attendant on duty for each 12 hoses which can be operated simultaneously while the outlet is open to the public.

4.5.8.4. Card or Key Activated Dispensers

������������ 1)�� Card or key activated dispensers are permitted at unattended self-service outlets and fuel dispensing stations that are not open to the general public, in conformance with Sentences (2) to (6). (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentences (3) to (6), installation of card or key activated dispensers shall conform to the requirements for self-service outlets and fuel dispensing stations in this Section.

������������ 3)�� Access to card or key activated dispensers shall be restricted to persons authorized by the supply agent to possess a card or key to operate the dispensers.

������������ 4)�� Clearly legible operating instructions, visible at all times, shall be posted at every dispenser island.

������������ 5)�� A telephone or other clearly identified means to notify the fire department shall be provided in a location readily accessible to the user.

������������ 6)�� Emergency instructions, including the telephone number for the local fire department, shall be conspicuously posted to advise the user, in the event of a spill or accident,

����������������������� a)�� to use the emergency shut-off switch required in Article 4.5.4.2., and

����������������������� b)�� to call the fire department.

������������ 7)�� When permitted by the authority having jurisdiction, persons authorized in Sentence (3) are permitted to dispense flammable liquids and combustible liquids into portable tanks conforming to either CSA B620 "Highway Tanks and Portable Tanks for the Transportation of Dangerous Goods" or drums meeting the requirements of the Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations, provided

����������������������� a)�� a grounding strap is installed at the dispenser, and

����������������������� b)�� the portable tank or drum is electrically connected to the grounding strap for protection against static charge during the filling procedure.

4.5.8.5. Duties of Attendants

������������ 1)�� Attendants on duty at fuel dispensing stations shall

����������������������� a)�� supervise the dispensing of flammable liquids and combustible liquids,

����������������������� b)�� activate the controls to permit the dispensing of fuel at an individual dispenser only after the customer at the unit is ready to activate the nozzle,

����������������������� c)�� prevent the dispensing of flammable liquids and combustible liquids into containers not conforming to Article 4.2.3.1.,

����������������������� d)�� take appropriate measures to prevent sources of ignition from creating a hazard at the dispensers,

����������������������� e)�� take appropriate action in the event of a spill to reduce the risk of fire, and

������������������������ f)�� shut off the power to all dispensers in the event of a spill or fire.

������������ 2)�� In addition to the requirements in Sentence (1), attendants on duty at marine fuel dispensing stations shall

����������������������� a)�� activate the controls to permit the dispensing of fuel at an individual dispenser only after all ports and hatches on the watercraft have been closed, and

����������������������� b)�� ensure that containers for flammable liquids and combustible liquids,

������������������������������������ i)��� are not filled beyond their safe filling level, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� are filled only after they have been removed from the watercraft.

4.5.8.6. Fuel Dispensing Procedures

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall not be dispensed into the fuel tank of a motor vehicle or watercraft while its engine is running.

������������ 2)�� It is permitted to dispense a Class II or IIIA liquid into the fuel tank of a motor vehicle while its engine is running provided it is dispensed not less than 6 m away from any Class I liquid dispenser. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Class I and II liquids shall not be dispensed at a fuel dispensing station into the fuel tank of a motor vehicle while any part of the motor vehicle or any vehicle attached to it is on a street.

������������ 4)�� Every person dispensing flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall

����������������������� a)�� take precautions to prevent overflow or spillage of the liquid being dispensed,

����������������������� b)�� not knowingly overfill the fuel system,

����������������������� c)�� subject to Article 4.5.8.5., in the event of spillage immediately apply an absorbent material to soak up the spillage in conformance with Article 4.1.6.3.,

����������������������� d)�� not dispense Class I or II liquids in proximity to open sources of ignition, and

����������������������� e)�� not use any object or device that is not an integral part of the hose nozzle valve assembly to maintain the flow of fuel.

4.5.8.7. Sources of Ignition

������������ 1)�� Smoking and non-fixed sources of ignition shall not be permitted within 7.5 m of a dispenser at a fuel dispensing station.

4.5.8.8. Signs

������������ 1)�� At least one weather-resistant sign conforming to Sentences (2) to (4) shall be provided for each dispenser in a location visible to every driver approaching the dispenser.

������������ 2)�� The sign required in Sentence (1) shall indicate that smoking is not permitted in the vicinity of the dispenser and that the ignition must be turned off while the vehicle is being refuelled. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� The sign required in Sentence (1) shall

����������������������� a)�� have a minimum dimension of 200 mm, and

����������������������� b)�� except as permitted in Sentence (4), have letters not less than 25 mm high.

������������ 4)�� The sign required in Sentence (1) is permitted to display the international "No Smoking - Ignition Off" symbol not less than 100 mm in diameter.

4.5.9. �� Leakage Detection

4.5.9.1. Liquid Level Measurement

������������ 1)�� The liquid level in storage tanks at fuel dispensing stations shall be measured in conformance with Subsection 4.3.16. (See Article 4.3.15.1. for leakage testing.)

4.5.10. �� Fire Prevention and Protection

4.5.10.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� At least 2 portable extinguishers, each having a rating of not less than 10-B:C, shall be provided at every fuel dispensing station in conformance with Part 6.

4.5.10.2. Absorbent Materials

������������ 1)�� Absorbent material to soak up liquid spillage shall be provided for use by attendants at fuel dispensing stations in conformance with Article 4.1.6.3.

Section 4.6. �� Bulk Plants

4.6.1. �� Scope

4.6.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to that portion of a property where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are received in bulk quantities and are stored or handled for the purpose of being distributed.

4.6.2. �� Storage

4.6.2.1. Storage

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be stored in

����������������������� a)�� closed containers in conformance with Article 4.6.2.4., or

����������������������� b)�� storage tanks located outside buildings in conformance with Section 4.3.

4.6.2.2. Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� At bulk plant rail loading and unloading facilities, the minimum distance from a storage tank to a railway line shall be in conformance with General Order No. O-32, "Flammable Liquids Bulk Storage Regulations" of Transport Canada.

4.6.2.3. Shock Pressure

������������ 1)�� Bulk storage tanks, piping, pumps, valves and associated components shall be designed, installed and maintained to accommodate shock pressure on the system.

4.6.2.4. Container Storage

������������ 1)�� Containers for flammable liquids or combustible liquids stored indoors shall be arranged in conformance with Subsection 4.2.7.

������������ 2)�� Containers for flammable liquids or combustible liquids stored outdoors shall be stored in conformance with Subsection 4.2.11., except that the distance between the piles and property lines and the distance between piles need not apply when the containers are stored in an area that does not present a hazard to neighbouring property.

4.6.2.5. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� An outdoor storage area shall be designed to accommodate accidental spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.6.2.6. Fencing

������������ 1)�� The outdoor area occupied by aboveground storage tanks, container storage, ancillary equipment and unloading facilities shall be fenced in conformance with Article 3.3.2.6.

4.6.3. �� Dispensing

4.6.3.1. Interconnection

������������ 1)�� Dispensing systems for Class I liquids shall not be interconnected with dispensing systems for Class II and IIIA liquids.

4.6.3.2. Dispensing into Vehicles

������������ 1)�� Dispensers serving the general public for dispensing Class I liquids into fuel tanks of vehicles shall not be located at a bulk plant unless separated by a fence or equivalent barrier from the area in which the bulk storage operations are conducted.

������������ 2)�� Where a dispenser referred to in Sentence (1) is supplied from an aboveground storage tank

����������������������� a)�� an electrically-operated solenoid valve, designed to open only when the dispenser is being operated, shall be provided at the tank outlet, and

����������������������� b)�� an emergency valve shall be provided for the dispenser in conformance with Sentence 4.5.6.3.(1).

4.6.3.3. Dispensing and Transfer inside Buildings

������������ 1)�� Class I liquids shall be dispensed or transferred inside buildings only in conformance with Subsections 4.1.7. and 4.1.8.

4.6.3.4. Dispensing into Metal Containers or Tanks

������������ 1)�� Class I liquids shall not be dispensed into a metal container or storage tank unless it is electrically connected in conformance with Article 4.1.8.2.

4.6.4. �� Loading and Unloading Facilities

(See Appendix A.)

4.6.4.1. Clearances

������������ 1)�� At a loading or unloading facility for tank vehicles or tank cars, the horizontal distance from the fill stem to an aboveground storage tank, a building or a property line shall be not less than

����������������������� a)�� 7.5 m for Class I liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� 4.5 m for Class II and IIIA liquids.

������������ 2)�� At bulk plant rail loading and unloading facilities, the minimum distance from a loading structure to a railway line shall be in conformance with General Order No. O-32, "Flammable Liquids Bulk Storage Regulations" of Transport Canada.

������������ 3)�� Buildings for the shelter of personnel or pumps shall be considered a part of the loading or unloading facility.

4.6.4.2. Multi-Purpose Facilities

������������ 1)�� When piping and pumping systems have been used for the transfer of either flammable liquids or combustible liquids at loading or unloading facilities, the system shall be cleaned of vapours before the other class of liquid is introduced.

4.6.4.3. Check Valves

������������ 1)�� Systems through which tank cars or tank vehicles discharge into aboveground storage tanks by means of pumps shall be provided with check valves conforming to Subsection 4.4.8.

������������ 2)�� Systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be designed, installed and maintained to prevent leakage or spillage.

4.6.4.4. Control Valves

������������ 1)�� Valves installed to control the filling of tank vehicles shall be of the self-closing type when used for Class I or II liquids.

������������ 2)�� Control valves referred to in Sentence (1) shall be held open manually, except where automatic devices are provided for shutting off the flow when the vehicle is full or filled to a preset amount.

4.6.4.5. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Bonding, grounding and isolation components for protection against static charges during the loading of tank vehicles or tank cars shall be provided when transferring flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

������������ 2)�� Where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are transferred into railway tank cars, railway tracks shall be bonded throughout their length and permanently grounded in conformance with CTC 1982-8 RAIL, "Railway Prevention of Electric Sparks Regulations" of Transport Canada.

������������ 3)�� Bonding required in Sentence (1) shall consist of a metallic bond wire connected to the fill stem or to some part of the loading structure in electrical contact with the fill stem in conformance with Subsection 4.1.4.

������������ 4)�� Bonding wires for tank vehicles shall be provided with a pull-off connector attached so as to be in electrical contact with the cargo tank of the tank vehicle.

������������ 5)�� The bonding connection required in Sentence (1) shall be fixed to the tank vehicle or storage tank before dome covers are raised and shall remain in place until filling is completed and all dome covers have been closed and secured.

4.6.4.6. Downspouts

������������ 1)�� Filling of tank vehicles or tank cars through open domes shall be in conformance with Sentence 4.1.8.2.(2).

4.6.5. �� Fire Protection

4.6.5.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� At least 2 portable extinguishers, each having a rating of not less than 20-B:C, shall be provided at hazardous locations in bulk storage plants for flammable liquids and combustible liquids, except that such portable extinguishers are permitted to be provided from the tank vehicles operated as part of a bulk plant which is not required in Article 4.6.2.6. to be fenced.

4.6.6. �� Spill Control

4.6.6.1. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Facilities to control possible spills of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be provided at loading and unloading points in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

Section 4.7. �� Piers and Wharves

4.7.1. �� Scope

4.7.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to flammable liquid and combustible liquid installations on piers and wharves, but does not include marine fuel dispensing stations.

4.7.2. �� General

4.7.2.1. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Piers and wharves at which flammable liquid or combustible liquid cargoes are to be transferred in bulk quantities to or from marine tank vessels shall be not less than 30 m from

����������������������� a)�� any bridge over a navigable waterway, and

����������������������� b)�� an entrance to a superstructure of any vehicular or railroad tunnel under a waterway.

������������ 2)�� The termination of fixed piping for loading and unloading flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be not less than 60 m from a bridge or from an entrance to a tunnel.

4.7.2.2. Construction

������������ 1)�� The substructure and deck of a pier or wharf shall be designed for its intended use and shall be constructed of heavy timber or material that will provide adequate flexibility, resistance to shock, durability, strength and fire resistance.

4.7.3. �� Storage Tanks

4.7.3.1. Installation

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2) and (3), storage tanks shall be installed on shore in conformance with Subsections 4.3.2. to 4.3.7.

������������ 2)�� Storage tanks are permitted to be located in buildings on piers and wharves of solid-fill or noncombustible construction provided they conform to Subsections 4.3.12. to 4.3.1.4.

������������ 3)�� Storage tanks are permitted to be buried in piers and wharves of the solid-fill type provided they conform to Subsections 4.3.8. to 4.3.11.

4.7.4. �� Piping, Valves and Fittings

4.7.4.1. Installation and Materials

������������ 1)�� The method of installation and materials used for piping, valves and fittings shall conform to Section 4.4.

4.7.4.2. Pipe Supports

������������ 1)�� Piping shall be properly supported and arranged to prevent excessive vibration or strain on equipment connected to it.

������������ 2)�� Piping supports shall consist of

����������������������� a)�� wood having no dimension less than 150 mm,

����������������������� b)�� steel, or

����������������������� c)�� concrete.

������������ 3)�� Where pipe is supported more than 1.2 m above the pier deck, piping supports shall have a minimum fire-resistance rating of 2 h.

4.7.4.3. Guards

������������ 1)�� In areas where general cargo is handled or where piping might be subject to mechanical damage from vehicles or watercraft, the piping shall be protected by means of guards.

4.7.4.4. Flexible Connections

������������ 1)�� Piping between the shore and piers or wharves shall be provided with swing joints or flexible connections designed in conformance with good engineering practice to permit the independent movement of the pier or wharf and shore piping without strain on the pipe.

4.7.4.5. Shut-Off Valves

������������ 1)�� A readily accessible valve to shut off the supply from shore shall be provided in each pipeline within 7.5 m of piers and wharves.

4.7.4.6. Access Openings for Inspection

������������ 1)�� Access openings for inspection purposes below deck shall be provided for valves required in Article 4.7.4.5. and for connections to pipelines, and suitable signs shall be posted indicating their locations.

������������ 2)�� No freight or materials shall be placed on piers and wharves in such a manner as to obstruct the access openings required in Sentence (1).

4.7.4.7. Identification

������������ 1)�� Identification tags or labels of metal or other material impervious to water and to the flammable liquids or combustible liquids being transferred shall be attached to and maintained on all pipelines and control valves to designate their use.

4.7.4.8. Leakage Testing

������������ 1)�� Piping systems shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Subsection 4.4.6. before being put into service and before reactivation when used on a seasonal basis.

������������ 2)�� Underground piping systems referred to in Sentence (1) shall be tested at intervals no greater than 12 months.

4.7.5. �� Bonding and Grounding

4.7.5.1. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Railway tracks on piers and wharves shall be bonded throughout their length and permanently grounded in conformance with CTC 1982-8 RAIL, "Railway Prevention of Electric Sparks Regulations" of Transport Canada.

������������ 2)�� Insulating joints shall be placed in all rails where entering upon the pier or wharf.

4.7.6. �� Fire Protection

4.7.6.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers having a rated capacity of 20-B:C shall be provided in the vicinity of Class I liquid pumps and fuel dispensers in conformance with Part 6.

������������ 2)�� Portable extinguishers shall be kept in the pump house or other suitable location where they will be accessible in the event of an emergency, but not accessible to the public.

������������ 3)�� Where vessels are loading or unloading flammable liquids or combustible liquids or are being refuelled, portable extinguishers with a rating of not less than 20-B:C shall be placed on the pier or wharf in the vicinity of loading or unloading operations, so that they will be accessible in the event of a fire emergency.

������������ 4)�� Portable extinguishers provided in conformance with Sentence (3) shall be in addition to those provided on board the vessels.

4.7.6.2. Training

������������ 1)�� Operating personnel shall be trained in how to summon the nearest fire department in the event of fire.

4.7.7. �� Bulk Transfer Stations

4.7.7.1. Location

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), the bulk transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be permitted only on piers and wharves used exclusively for that purpose.

������������ 2)�� Where it is not practicable to locate bulk transfer stations on separate piers and wharves, such stations are permitted to be located on general purpose piers and wharves provided that guards or fences are installed around valves or pumping equipment to prevent entry of unauthorized personnel.

4.7.7.2. Leakage and Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Measures to accommodate possible leakage or spillage from hose couplings shall be provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Provision shall be made to prevent spillage resulting from the disconnection of hoses.

4.7.7.3. Hose Connections

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), hose connections on piping shall be of the bolted flange type, and all such connections shall be provided with shut-off valves.

������������ 2)�� The use of cam-locking connections up to 100 mm in size shall be permitted.

������������ 3)�� Hose connections shall not project beyond the face of piers and wharves.

4.7.8. �� Cargo Hose

4.7.8.1. Cargo Hose

������������ 1)�� The transfer of flammable liquids or combustible liquids between tank vessels and piers or wharves shall be through

����������������������� a)�� flexible cargo hose designed in conformance with good engineering practice (see Appendix A), or

����������������������� b)�� jointed tubing or piping

������������������������������������ i)��� suitable for the cargo to be transferred, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� designed to withstand the maximum design working pressure.

4.7.8.2. Maintenance and Testing

������������ 1)�� Cargo hose shall be maintained in satisfactory operating condition and be pressure tested, at intervals not greater than 12 months, to 1.5 times the maximum working pressure but not less than 350 kPa (gauge).

4.7.8.3. Supports

������������ 1)�� Cargo hose shall be supported where it is not run on a solid foundation.

4.7.9. �� Cargo Pumps

4.7.9.1. Design and Installation

������������ 1)�� Cargo pumps shall be designed and installed in conformance with Subsection 4.4.10.

4.7.9.2. Pressure Relief

������������ 1)�� Cargo pumps capable of producing pressures in excess of the safe working pressure of the cargo hose shall be provided with pressure relief devices such as return lines or relief valves.

4.7.9.3. Location

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), cargo pumps shall be located

����������������������� a)�� on shore or on piers and wharves either of noncombustible construction or of the solid-fill type, and

����������������������� b)�� not less than 3 m from other buildings or structures.

������������ 2)�� Where it is not practicable to install cargo pumps as required in Sentence (1), they are permitted to be installed on piers and wharves of combustible construction if located in pump houses

����������������������� a)�� conforming to Subsection 4.7.10., and

����������������������� b)�� located not less than 3 m from other buildings.

4.7.10. �� Pump Houses

4.7.10.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� Pump houses shall be of noncombustible construction with floors that are chemically resistant to the liquid being handled, liquid-tight and equipped with curbs or flashings around the base of the wall not less than 100 mm in height to contain any spilled liquid.

4.7.10.2. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Ventilation shall be provided in pump houses in conformance with Subsection 4.1.7.

4.7.11. �� Transfer Operations

4.7.11.1. Supervision

������������ 1)�� Transfer operations shall be carried out only under the continuous supervision of a person qualified to supervise such operations.

������������ 2)�� Cargo shall not be transferred to or from a marine tank vessel unless sufficient personnel are on board to control the operation.

������������ 3)�� The person responsible for directing the operations shall

����������������������� a)�� prior to transfer of cargo, ascertain that no unauthorized repair work is being carried out on the pier or wharf and that there are no open flames in the vicinity,

����������������������� b)�� during the transfer of cargo, monitor the progress of the loading and unloading to prevent overflow, and

����������������������� c)�� inspect the hose and connections for leakage and, if leakage occurs, stop the operations.

4.7.11.2. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Tank vessels shall be electrically connected to the shore piping prior to the connecting of cargo hose, except when cathodic protection facilities are operating.

������������ 2)�� Electrical connections to tank vessels shall be maintained until the cargo hose has been disconnected and any spillage has been removed.

4.7.11.3. Equipment

������������ 1)�� The cargo hose shall be of adequate length to allow for the movement of the vessel.

������������ 2)�� Gaskets shall be used in all hose joints and pipe couplings to prevent leakage.

������������ 3)�� Flanged joints shall be tightly bolted to prevent leakage.

������������ 4)�� Drip pans shall be placed under hose connections on piers and wharves, except where a sump pit or settling basin is provided.

4.7.11.4. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� When transfer operations are completed,

����������������������� a)�� the valves on the hose connections shall be closed, and

����������������������� b)�� the cargo hose shall be drained into appropriate containers that shall be emptied in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Care shall be taken that no liquid is discharged on a pier or wharf or overboard during draining and emptying operations.

Section 4.8. �� Process Plants

4.8.1. �� Scope

4.8.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), this Section applies to those process plants, including refineries, which contain industrial processes involving flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

������������ 2)�� This Section does not apply to distilleries.

4.8.2. �� Outdoor Processing Equipment

4.8.2.1. Location

������������ 1)�� The location of outdoor processing equipment in process plants shall be based on its flammable liquid or combustible liquid capacity as described in Sentences (2) to (4).

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4), outdoor processing equipment having emergency relief venting and a working pressure of not more than 17 kPa (gauge) shall be separated from property lines and buildings on the same property by distances

����������������������� a)�� equal to those in Table 4.3.2.1. for stable liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� 2.5 times those in Table 4.3.2.1. for unstable liquids.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4), outdoor processing equipment having emergency relief venting and a working pressure more than 17 kPa (gauge) shall be separated from property lines and buildings on the same property by distances

����������������������� a)�� 1.5 times those in Table 4.3.2.1. for stable liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� 4 times those in Table 4.3.2.1. for unstable liquids.

������������ 4)�� Where protection is not provided against fires or explosions in processing equipment, the distances in Sentences (2) and (3) shall be doubled. (See Sentence 4.3.2.5.(2).)

4.8.3. �� Processing Buildings

4.8.3.1. Explosion Venting

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.8.4.2., where Class IA liquids or unstable liquids are processed within a room or a building, the room or building shall be designed to prevent critical structural and mechanical damage from an internal explosion in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations."(See A-3.2.8.2.(1)(d) in Appendix A.)

4.8.3.2. Fire Separations

������������ 1)�� Areas where unstable liquids are handled or where small scale unit chemical processes are carried on shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

4.8.3.3. Basements and Pits

������������ 1)�� Buildings where Class I and II liquids are handled in chemical processes shall not have basements or covered pits.

4.8.3.4. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Enclosed processing buildings handling flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be ventilated as specified in Subsection 4.1.7.

������������ 2)�� Equipment used in a building and the ventilation of the building shall be designed so as to limit flammable vapour-air mixtures under normal operating conditions to the interior of equipment, and to not more than 1.5 m from such equipment. (See Appendix A.)

4.8.4. �� Fire Prevention and Protection

4.8.4.1. Spill and Vapour Control

������������ 1)�� Processing equipment shall be designed and arranged to

����������������������� a)�� prevent the unintentional escape of liquids and vapours, and

����������������������� b)�� minimize the quantity escaping in the event of accidental release.

������������ 2)�� Measures to control spilled flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be provided in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

4.8.4.2. Explosion Protection

������������ 1)�� Processing equipment where an explosion hazard is present shall be

����������������������� a)�� designed to withstand the explosion pressure without damage to the equipment,

����������������������� b)�� provided with explosion venting in conformance with NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations," or

����������������������� c)�� provided with an explosion prevention system in conformance with NFPA 69, "Explosion Prevention Systems."

4.8.4.3. Fire Protection

������������ 1)�� Where the process warrants such protection, industrial process plants shall be supplied with

����������������������� a)�� water supplies with pressure and quantity adequate to meet the probable fire demands,

����������������������� b)�� hydrants,

����������������������� c)�� hoses connected to a permanent water supply and located so that all equipment containing flammable liquids or combustible liquids, including pumps, can be reached with at least one hose stream,

����������������������� d)�� nozzles capable of discharging a water spray, and

����������������������� e)�� automatic fire suppression systems conforming to Part 6.

4.8.4.4. Emergency Procedures

������������ 1)�� Emergency procedures conforming to Article 4.1.5.6. shall be established for refineries and process plants.

Section 4.9. �� Distilleries

4.9.1. �� Scope

4.9.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies only to those areas or buildings in distilleries where distilled beverage alcohols are concentrated, blended, mixed, stored or packaged. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� The storage, handling and use of flammable liquids or combustible liquids other than distilled beverage alcohols in a distillery shall conform to Part 4 of this Code.

������������ 3)�� Where there is a conflict between the requirements of this Section and other requirements in Part 4, this Section shall govern.

4.9.2. �� General

4.9.2.1. Building Classification

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), buildings or parts of buildings in which distilled beverage alcohol is distilled, processed or stored in bulk shall be classified as high hazard industrial occupancies.

������������ 2)�� Buildings or parts of buildings used for storage of closed containers of distilled beverage alcohols shall be classified as medium hazard industrial occupancies.

4.9.3. �� Storage Tanks and Containers

4.9.3.1. Design, Fabrication and Testing

������������ 1)�� Storage tanks , wooden vats, barrels, drums or containers used for the storage or processing of distilled beverage alcohols shall be designed, fabricated and tested for the anticipated maximum working pressure, operating temperature, internal corrosion conditions and structural stresses to which they could be subjected.

4.9.3.2. Supports, Foundations and Anchorage

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Supports, foundations and anchorage of storage tanks shall comply with Subsection 4.3.3., except that timber supports shall be permitted.

������������ 2)�� Storage tank supports having less than a 2 h fire-resistance rating shall be protected by an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Part 6.

������������ 3)�� The area underneath any storage tank greater than 1.2 m in diameter shall be protected by an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Part 6.

4.9.3.3. Storage Tank Vents

������������ 1)�� Normal and emergency vents shall be provided on storage tanks in conformance with good engineering practice. (See Appendix A.)

4.9.4. �� Storage

4.9.4.1. Storage Tanks, Drums and Barrels

������������ 1)�� Where more than 25000 L of distilled beverage alcohol in storage tanks, drums or barrels are stored inside buildings, such buildings shall be sprinklered in conformance with Article 6.5.1.1.

4.9.4.2. Closed Containers and Storage Aids

������������ 1)�� Storage of closed containers of distilled beverage alcohols, packaging materials and empty bottles, drums, barrels and pallets shall be in conformance with Part 3.

4.9.5. �� Piping and Pumping Systems

4.9.5.1. Design and Installation

������������ 1)�� The design, fabrication, assembly and inspection of piping and pumping systems containing distilled beverage alcohols shall be suitable for the anticipated maximum working pressures, operating temperatures, internal corrosion conditions and structural stresses to which they could be subjected. (See Appendix A.)

4.9.6. �� Ventilation

4.9.6.1. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Natural or mechanical ventilation shall be provided for all areas where alcohol vapours are released from storage tanks or process equipment under normal operating conditions, to prevent the concentration of vapours from exceeding 25% of the lower explosive limit, measured 1.5 m from any equipment or from any opening subject to vapour release.

4.9.7. �� Spill Control

4.9.7.1. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), emergency drainage systems shall be provided to direct any spills or leakage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids, together with water used for fire fighting, to a safe location in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Water miscible effluent from spills and fire fighting operations is permitted to be directed into a sewer system provided it does not create a fire hazard nor any risk to public health or safety.

4.9.8. �� Fire Protection

4.9.8.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) to (4), portable extinguishers shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

������������ 2)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (3), in maturing warehouses, at least one 4-A:30-B:C rated fire extinguisher shall be located adjacent to each exit.

������������ 3)�� Hose stations complying with Article 6.2.3.4. are permitted to be installed in lieu of portable extinguishers at locations required in Sentence (2), and spaced so that the travel distance to the nearest hose is not greater than 25 m.

������������ 4)�� At least one 10-B:C portable extinguisher shall be located on each industrial lift truck.

4.9.8.2. Standpipe and Hose Systems

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), standpipe and hose systems shall be provided and installed in distilleries in conformance with Article 2.1.3.1.

������������ 2)�� Where a building is sprinklered in conformance with Article 6.5.1.1., small hose (38 mm) stations are permitted to be supplied from interior sprinkler piping.

Section 4.10. �� Withdrawal of Storage Tanks from Service

4.10.1. �� Scope

4.10.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to the procedures to be followed when storage tanks for flammable liquids or combustible liquids are removed, abandoned or temporarily taken out of service.

4.10.2. �� Rendering Storage Tanks Temporarily Out of Service

4.10.2.1. Underground Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� When underground storage tanks will be out of service for a period not exceeding 180 days

����������������������� a)�� the liquid level in the storage tank shall be measured at intervals not greater than one month and a record of such measurements shall be retained for inspection,

����������������������� b)�� fill pipe covers and covers over openings to measure liquid levels, dispensers and power controls shall be kept locked when not in use, and

����������������������� c)�� vent piping shall be kept open.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence (3), when underground storage tanks will be out of service for a period exceeding 180 days

����������������������� a)�� the storage tanks, connected piping and dispensers shall be emptied of Class I liquid,

����������������������� b)�� the storage tanks, piping and dispensers shall be refilled with a Class II or IIIA liquid, or not less than 1 kg of dry ice for each 500 L of tank capacity shall be added to the storage tank,

����������������������� c)�� measurements of the liquid level of each storage tank containing a Class II or IIIA liquid shall be made at intervals not greater than one month, and a record of such measurements shall be retained for inspection, and

����������������������� d)�� fill pipe covers and covers over openings to measure liquid levels, dispensers and power controls shall be locked.

������������ 3)�� Where underground storage tank facilities are operated on a seasonal basis,

����������������������� a)�� at the close of each season of operation,

������������������������������������ i)��� the liquid level of each storage tank shall be measured,

����������������������������������� ii)��� a record of such measurements shall be retained for inspection, and

���������������������������������� iii)��� all fill pipe covers and covers over openings for measuring liquid levels, dispensers and power controls shall be locked, and

����������������������� b)�� prior to the start of an operating season,

������������������������������������ i)��� the liquid level in each storage tank shall be measured,

����������������������������������� ii)��� the measurements shall be compared with those recorded at the close of the previous season, and

���������������������������������� iii)��� when a loss of liquid or water intrusion is apparent, immediate action shall be taken to determine and correct the condition.

������������ 4)�� If a storage tank has been out of service for more than 12 months, the tank and piping shall be tested for leakage in conformance with Subsections 4.3.15. and 4.4.6.

4.10.2.2. Aboveground Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� When an aboveground storage tank will be out of service for a period not exceeding 180 days, the piping from the tank shall be capped or the valves necessary to achieve similar isolation of the tank shall be closed and securely locked.

������������ 2)�� When out-of-service storage tanks referred to in Sentence (1) contain flammable liquids or combustible liquids, the liquid level in the tank shall be measured and the readings compared at intervals not greater than one month.

������������ 3)�� Where an aboveground storage tank will be out of service for a period exceeding 180 days

����������������������� a)�� all liquid and vapours shall be removed from the storage tank and its connected piping, and

����������������������� b)�� the storage tank markings shall clearly indicate that the tank is empty.

4.10.2.3. Corrosion Protection

������������ 1)�� Corrosion protection systems shall be maintained in operating condition when a storage tank is temporarily out of service and during seasonal shutdowns.

4.10.3. �� Removal of Underground Storage Tanks

4.10.3.1. Removal

������������ 1)�� When underground storage tanks have no further use or have been out of service for 2 years, such tanks, together with connected piping and dispensers, shall

����������������������� a)�� have all flammable liquids and combustible liquids removed from them,

����������������������� b)�� be purged of vapours, and

����������������������� c)�� except as permitted in Article 4.10.3.2., be removed from the ground.

������������ 2)�� If contaminated, soil surrounding the storage tanks described in Sentence (1) shall be replaced with clean fill.

4.10.3.2. Abandonment in Place

������������ 1)�� Where the authority having jurisdiction determines that it is impractical to remove an underground storage tank described in Sentence 4.10.3.1.(1), such tank shall be filled with an inert material.

������������ 2)�� Where the authority having jurisdiction determines that it is impractical to remove underground piping described in Sentence 4.10.3.1.(1), such piping shall have the ends permanently sealed by capping or plugging.

4.10.4. �� Disposal and Reuse of Storage Tanks

4.10.4.1. Disposal

������������ 1)�� Where storage tanks are to be disposed of, sufficient openings shall be cut in the tanks to render them unfit for further use.

4.10.4.2. Reuse

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentence (2), a storage tank shall not be reused for the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

������������ 2)�� A storage tank is permitted to be reused for the storage of flammable liquids or combustible liquids only after having been

����������������������� a)�� refurbished and found to conform to one of the standards in Sentence 4.3.1.2.(1), or

����������������������� b)�� refurbished in conformance with Sentence (3).

������������ 3)�� A steel storage tank is permitted to be refurbished in conformance with the following:

����������������������� a)�� CAN4-S601(A), "Shop Refurbishing of Steel Aboveground Horizontal Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids,"

����������������������� b)�� CAN4-S603(A), "Refurbishing of Steel Underground Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids," or

����������������������� c)�� CAN4-S630(A), "Shop Refurbishing of Steel Aboveground Vertical Tanks for Flammable and Combustible Liquids."

4.10.4.3. Riveted Storage Tanks

������������ 1)�� Riveted storage tanks shall not be relocated.

Section 4.11. �� Tank Vehicles

4.11.1. �� Scope

4.11.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section applies to tank vehicles when located on a property covered in this Code.

4.11.2. �� General

4.11.2.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� A tank vehicle shall be provided with at least one portable extinguisher having a minimum rating of 20-B:C and conforming to Part 6.

������������ 2)�� When more than one portable extinguisher is provided, each extinguisher shall have a minimum rating of 10-B:C.

������������ 3)�� Portable extinguishers on a tank vehicle shall be readily accessible.

4.11.2.2. Hot Works

������������ 1)�� Hot works performed on or in close proximity to a tank vehicle shall conform to Section 5.2.

4.11.2.3. Parking inside Buildings

������������ 1)�� A tank vehicle shall not be parked inside a building unless the building is specifically designed for that purpose.

������������ 2)�� A tank vehicle parked inside a building shall have sufficient space in the tank to compensate for thermal expansion of the flammable liquid or combustible liquid.

������������ 3)�� A tank vehicle parked inside a building shall have no leaks of flammable liquid or combustible liquid.

4.11.2.4. Parking outside Buildings

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), a tank vehicle is permitted to be left unattended by the vehicle operator outside a building for not more than 1 h.

������������ 2)�� A tank vehicle is permitted to be left unattended by the vehicle operator outside a building for more than 1 h, but only in a parking space

����������������������� a)�� that is located not less than 15 m from a building, and

����������������������� b)�� where the tank vehicle is not exposed to undue hazard from accident or collision.

4.11.3. �� Loading and Unloading

4.11.3.1. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� During loading and unloading operations, a tank vehicle and its delivery equipment shall be separated from ignition sources by distances conforming to the requirements for dispensers in Articles 4.5.3.2. and 4.5.8.7.

4.11.3.2. Static Electric Charges

������������ 1)�� During loading and unloading of a tank vehicle, measures shall be taken against static electric charges in conformance with Articles 4.1.8.2. and 4.6.4.5.

4.11.3.3. Supervision

������������ 1)�� During loading and unloading of a tank vehicle, trained personnel shall be in a position to shut off the flow of liquid in an emergency.

4.11.3.4. Multi-Use Compartments

������������ 1)�� When a compartment of a tank vehicle has been used to carry a Class I liquid, the compartment, piping and accessory delivery equipment shall be drained of liquid before a Class II or IIIA liquid is loaded.

4.11.3.5. Engine

������������ 1)�� When loading or unloading of Class I liquids is done without the use of the engine of the tank vehicle, the engine ignition shall be shut off during the transfer operations.

4.11.3.6. Unloading

������������ 1)�� Before a tank vehicle is unloaded, the volume of liquid in the receiving tank shall be measured to ensure that the tank can accept the volume to be unloaded.

������������ 2)�� If tank vents are obstructed, the transfer of liquid shall be stopped.

������������ 3)�� A tank vehicle shall not be parked on a street, shoulder or sidewalk while unloading at a fuel dispensing station.

4.11.3.7. Mixed Cargo

������������ 1)�� Where both flammable liquids and combustible liquids are carried simultaneously and are dispensed from the same tank vehicle through a reel and meter system, the tank vehicle may be unloaded with a single reel and meter system provided the following safe product switching procedures are adhered to:

����������������������� a)�� the total combined capacity of the piping, meter and hose, referred to as the system amount, shall be clearly marked on the unit at the operators' position;

����������������������� b)�� the product in the hose at any time shall be identified by a tag conforming to Article 4.4.8.7. attached at the hose nozzle;

����������������������� c)�� when switching from a flammable liquid to a combustible liquid the last flammable liquid unloading shall be performed as follows:

������������������������������������ i)��� ensure that there is sufficient volume available in the consumers' tank to accommodate the requested amount;

����������������������������������� ii)��� off-load the consumers' requested amount less the system amount of flammable liquid into the consumer tank, taking into account that the system amount will be required to be flushed into the consumer tank;

���������������������������������� iii)��� the pump shall be slowed to idling speed and switched over to combustible liquid before removing the hose nozzle from the fill-pipe of the consumer tank;

���������������������������������� iv)��� flush the piping, meter and hose with combustible liquid into the consumer tank to the amount equal to the system amount, ensuring that no flammable liquid remains in the hose;

����������������������������������� v)��� change the tag at the nozzle;

����������������������� d)�� when switching from a combustible liquid to a flammable liquid, the last load of combustible liquid shall be unloaded as follows:

������������������������������������ i)��� off-load the consumers' requested amount of combustible liquid into the consumers' tank;

����������������������������������� ii)��� remove the hose from the fill pipe, slow the pump to idling speed and switch to flammable liquid;

���������������������������������� iii)��� flush the piping, meter and hose with flammable liquid into the compartment of the truck containing the combustible liquid with the amount equal to the system amount;

���������������������������������� iv)��� change the tag at the nozzle.

4.11.3.8. Fuelling of Vehicles

������������ 1)�� The fuelling of vehicles directly from a tank vehicle is permitted, provided

����������������������� a)�� only diesel fuel is dispensed into the fuel tanks of vehicles;

����������������������� b)�� the fuelling is only into the fuel tanks of vehicles used in connection with commercial, industrial, governmental or manufacturing establishments which do not include residential property;

����������������������� c)�� the vehicles to be fuelled are located outdoors on the property of the commercial, industrial, governmental or manufacturing establishments;

����������������������� d)�� the fuelling operation shall be by an approved hose reel and automatic closing type nozzle;

����������������������� e)�� appropriate training and equipment shall be provided to the tank vehicle operator for dealing with any incidental spillage that may occur during fuelling.

Section 4.12 ����� Permits

4.12.1. �� Application

4.12.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This section applies to obtaining permits for the construction and operation of bulk plants, process plants and distilleries, and the installation and operation of fuel dispensing stations.

������������ 2)�� No permit shall be issued unless the approval of the local government has first been obtained.

������������ 3)�� The permit shall be displayed in a location designated by the authority having jurisdiction for reference by the fire department and other personnel.

4.12.2. �� Bulk Plants, Process Plants and Distilleries

4.12.2.1. Permit Requirement

������������ 1)�� No person shall operate or modify a bulk plant, process plant or distillery without first obtaining a permit issued by the fire commissioner or an inspector.

4.12.2.2. Drawings

������������ 1)�� Application for the permit shall be made to the fire commissioner and accompanied by plans drawn to scale showing

����������������������� a)�� the location of the storage tanks in relation to the line of the adjoining property, buildings and fencing,

����������������������� b)�� the layout of all major piping, pumps, valves and associated components,

����������������������� c)�� the size, capacity and use of the storage tanks,

����������������������� d)�� the standard to which the storage tanks have been constructed,

����������������������� e)�� the location and type of vents and safety valves, and

������������������������ f)�� the location and layout of any key/card lock fuel dispensing station.

������������ 2)�� Construction of the bulk plant, process plant or distillery shall not be commenced until the plans have been accepted in writing.

4.12.3. �� Fuel Dispensing Stations

4.12.3.1. Permit Required

������������ 1)�� No person shall operate a fuel dispensing station or install any storage tank or any pump or measuring device to be used for the purpose of retailing flammable liquids or combustible liquids without first obtaining a permit issued by a local assistant to the fire commissioner.

4.12.3.2. Application for Permit

������������ 1)�� Application for the permit shall be made in writing to the local assistant to the fire commissioner for the municipality or the fire district in which the fuel dispensing station is located.

������������ 2)�� Where there is no local assistant, or in the absence of such officer, the application shall be made to the fire commissioner or an inspector who may issue the permit.

������������ 3)�� The application shall state

����������������������� a)�� the location of the fuel dispensing station,

����������������������� b)�� the capacity and type of storage tank,

����������������������� c)�� the type and trade name of the pump or measuring device to be installed, and

����������������������� d)�� any further information required by the officer.

Part 5 ����� Hazardous Processes and Operations

Section 5.1. �� General

5.1.1. �� Scope

5.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Part applies to processes and operations that involve a risk from explosion, high flammability or related conditions which create a hazard to life safety.

5.1.1.2. Explosives and Fireworks

������������ 1)�� The manufacturing, handling, transportation, sale and use of Class I explosives, blasting agents, detonators, propellant explosives, pyrotechnics, fireworks and ammunition shall be in conformance with the "Explosives Act" and its Regulations.

5.1.1.3. Display Fireworks

������������ 1)�� The handling and discharge of fireworks shall conform to the "Fireworks Manual," published by Natural Resources Canada.

5.1.2. �� Electrical Installations

5.1.2.1. Hazardous Locations

������������ 1)�� Where wiring or electrical equipment is located in areas in which flammable gases or vapours, combustible dusts or combustible fibres are present in quantities sufficient to create a hazard, such wiring and electrical equipment shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations" for hazardous locations. (See Appendix A.)

5.1.2.2. General

������������ 1)�� Electrical installations shall conform to the appropriate provincial or territorial legislation or, in the absence of such legislation, to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations" except that alternatives to these requirements are permitted as described in Part 1 of this Code in areas other than those described in Article 5.1.2.1.

5.1.3. �� Ventilation

5.1.3.1. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Ventilation shall be provided for hazardous locations and processes in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code and with this Part.

5.1.4. �� Flash Point

5.1.4.1. Flash Point

������������ 1)�� The flash points of flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be determined in conformance with Subsection 4.1.3.

5.1.5. �� Fire Safety Plan

5.1.5.1. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), a fire safety plan conforming to Section 2.8. shall be prepared for areas where processes and operations described in Article 5.1.1.1. take place.

������������ 2)�� In addition to the information required in Section 2.8., the fire safety plan shall include

����������������������� a)�� the location and identification of storage and use areas for specific products, in conformance with Article 3.2.2.6., and

����������������������� b)�� the names, addresses and telephone numbers of persons to be contacted in case of fire during non-operating hours.

������������ 3)�� In addition to the information required in Sentence (2), where Class 7 radioactive materials are used or handled, the fire safety plan shall include the information specified in Subsection 3.1.2.

Section 5.2. �� Hot Works

5.2.1. �� General

5.2.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to hot works involving open flames or producing heat or sparks, including, without being limited to, cutting, welding, soldering, brazing, grinding, adhesive bonding, thermal spraying and thawing pipes.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in this Section, hot works described in Sentence (1) shall conform to CSA W117.2, "Safety in Welding, Cutting, and Allied Processes."

5.2.1.2. Training

������������ 1)�� Hot works shall be performed only by personnel trained in the safe use of equipment in conformance with this Section.

5.2.2. �� Hot Work Equipment

5.2.2.1. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Hot work equipment shall be maintained in good operating condition.

5.2.2.2. Inspection

������������ 1)�� Hot work equipment shall be examined for leakage or defects prior to each use.

������������ 2)�� Leaks or defects found in hot work equipment shall be repaired prior to use.

5.2.2.3. Equipment Not in Use

������������ 1)�� All valves shall be closed and gas lines bled when Class 2 gas hot work equipment is not in use.

������������ 2)�� Electric hot work equipment shall be de-energized when not in use.

5.2.2.4. Compressed Gas Equipment

������������ 1)�� The design and installation of oxygen-fuel gas equipment shall conform to NFPA 51, "Design and Installation of Oxygen-Fuel Gas Systems for Welding, Cutting and Allied Processes."

������������ 2)�� Unalloyed copper piping shall not be used for acetylene gas.

������������ 3)�� Oil or grease shall not be used with equipment for oxygen.

������������ 4)�� Cylinders of Class 2 gases shall conform to Part 3.

5.2.3. �� Prevention of Fires

5.2.3.1. Location of Operations

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), hot work shall be carried out in an area free of combustible and flammable contents, with walls, ceilings and floors of noncombustible construction or lined with noncombustible materials.

������������ 2)�� When it is not practicable to undertake hot work in an area described in Sentence (1),

����������������������� a)�� combustible and flammable materials within a 15 m distance from the hot work shall be protected against ignition in conformance with Article 5.2.3.2.,

����������������������� b)�� a fire watch shall be provided during the hot work and for a period of not less than 60 min after its completion in conformance with Article 5.2.3.3., and

����������������������� c)�� a final inspection of the hot work area shall be conducted 4 h after completion of work.

������������ 3)�� When there is a possibility of sparks leaking onto combustible materials in areas adjacent to the area where hot work is carried out,

����������������������� a)�� openings in walls, floors or ceilings shall be covered or closed to prevent the passage of sparks to such adjacent areas, or

����������������������� b)�� Sentence (2) shall apply to such adjacent areas.

5.2.3.2. Protection of Combustible and Flammable Materials

������������ 1)�� Any combustible and flammable material, dust or residue shall be

����������������������� a)�� removed from the area where hot work is carried out, or

����������������������� b)�� protected against ignition by the use of noncombustible materials.

������������ 2)�� Combustible materials or building surfaces that cannot be removed or protected against ignition as required in Sentence (1) shall be thoroughly wetted where hot work is carried out.

������������ 3)�� Any process or activity creating flammable gases or vapours, combustible dusts or combustible fibres in quantities sufficient to create a fire or explosion hazard shall be interrupted where hot work is carried out.

5.2.3.3. Fire Watch

������������ 1)�� The exposed areas described in Sentences 5.2.3.1.(2) and (3) shall be examined for ignition of combustible materials by personnel equipped with and trained in the use of fire extinguishing equipment.

5.2.3.4. Work on Containers, Equipment or Piping

������������ 1)�� Hot work shall not be performed on containers, equipment, or piping containing flammable liquids or combustible liquids or Class 2.1 flammable gases unless they have been cleaned and tested with a gas detector to ascertain that they are free of explosive vapours.

������������ 2)�� Hot work shall not be performed on a totally enclosed container.

������������ 3)�� Hot work shall not be performed on metal objects that are in contact with combustible materials unless safety precautions are taken to prevent their ignition by conduction.

5.2.3.5. Work Adjacent to Piping

������������ 1)�� When hot work is to be carried out near piping containing Class 2.1 flammable gas, the piping shall

����������������������� a)�� conform to Sentence 5.2.3.4.(1), or

����������������������� b)�� be protected by a thermal barrier against the passage of heat.

5.2.3.6. Fire Extinguishing Equipment

������������ 1)�� At least one portable fire extinguisher conforming to Part 6 shall be provided in the hot work area.

5.2.3.7. Fire Safety Plan

������������ 1)�� In buildings or areas described in Article 2.8.1.1., the required fire safety plan shall include the safety measures described in this Subsection for the safe conducting of hot works.

Section 5.3. �� Dust Producing Processes

5.3.1. �� General

5.3.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to buildings or parts of buildings where combustible dusts are produced in quantities or concentrations that create an explosion or fire hazard.

5.3.1.2. Dust Removal

������������ 1)�� Building and machinery surfaces shall be kept clean of accumulations of combustible dusts using cleaning equipment that

����������������������� a)�� is made of materials that will not create electrostatic charges or sparks,

����������������������� b)�� is electrically conductive and bonded to ground, and

����������������������� c)�� except as permitted in Sentence (3), removes the dust to a safe location by suction.

������������ 2)�� When used in an atmosphere containing combustible dusts, the cleaning equipment required in Sentence (1) shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations."

������������ 3)�� Where it is not possible to effectively remove dust by suction, it is permitted to use compressed air or other means which cause dust to be suspended in air during removal if, in the dust removal area,

����������������������� a)�� all sources of ignition are eliminated, and

����������������������� b)�� all machinery and equipment isde-energized, unless such equipment is suitable for use in atmospheres containing combustible dusts, in conformance with CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations"

5.3.1.3. Dust-Collecting Systems

������������ 1)�� Dust-collecting systems shall be provided to prevent the accumulation of dust and keep suspended dusts at a safe concentration inside a building.

������������ 2)�� A dust-collecting system required in Sentence (1) shall be designed in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 91, "Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials" and the NFPA standards on dust explosion hazards, and shall

����������������������� a)�� be made of noncombustible materials, and

����������������������� b)�� prevent sparks due to physical contact in the fan assembly. (See Appendix A.)

5.3.1.4. Dust Collectors

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), a dust collector having a capacity greater than 0.5 m3/s shall

����������������������� a)�� be located outside of a building, and

����������������������� b)�� be equipped with explosion venting to the outdoors of not less than 0.1 m2 of vent area for each cubic metre of dust collector enclosure volume.

������������ 2)�� A dust collector described in Sentence (1) is permitted to be located inside a building if it is

����������������������� a)�� provided with explosion venting to the outdoors as specified in Clause (1)(b),

����������������������� b)�� equipped with an automatic explosion prevention system, or

����������������������� c)�� located in a room with fire separations having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 h and provided with explosion venting to the outdoors.

������������ 3)�� When air exhausted by a dust collector described in this Article is returned to a building, the dust collecting system shall be designed so that

����������������������� a)�� it will not create an explosion hazard inside the building, and

����������������������� b)�� the exhaust fan and ancillary equipment are automatically shut down in the event of a fire or an explosion inside the dust collector.

5.3.1.5. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Electrically conducting parts of conveying systems, dust collectors, dust producing machines and any equipment capable of accumulating static electricity located in an atmosphere containing combustible dusts shall be electrically bonded and grounded.

������������ 2)�� Static electricity shall be prevented from accumulating on machines or equipment subject to static electricity buildup by appropriate bonding, grounding and static eliminating devices.

5.3.1.6. Explosion Venting

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 5.3.1.7., an activity that creates an atmosphere containing significant concentrations of combustible dusts shall be located only in a building provided with explosion venting to the outdoors.

������������ 2)�� When explosion venting is required in this Section, it shall be designed to prevent critical structural and mechanical damage to the building in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations." (See A-3.2.8.2.(1)(d) in Appendix A.)

5.3.1.7. Explosion Prevention Systems

������������ 1)�� In processes where an explosion hazard is present and conditions exist that prevent adequate explosion venting as required in this Section, an explosion prevention system shall be provided.

������������ 2)�� When an explosion prevention system is required in this Section, it shall be designed in conformance with good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 69, "Explosion Prevention Systems."

5.3.1.8. Electrical Interlocks

������������ 1)�� Equipment required to have a dust-collecting system shall be interlocked to prevent it from operating if the dust-collecting system is not in operation.

5.3.1.9. Separators

������������ 1)�� Separators shall be provided to prevent the entrance of foreign materials that may cause sparks in conveying equipment, dust collectors, dust producing machines and any equipment located in an atmosphere containing combustible dusts.

5.3.1.10. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Unless controlled in a manner that will not create a fire or explosion hazard, a device, operation or activity that produces open flames, sparks or heat shall not be permitted. (See A-4.1.5.3.(1) in Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Portable electrical equipment used in atmospheres containing combustible dusts shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations."

������������ 3)�� Smoking shall not be permitted in atmospheres containing combustible dusts.

5.3.2. �� Woodworking Operations

5.3.2.1. Exhaust Systems

������������ 1)�� Every machine that produces wood dust, particles or shavings shall be provided with a blower and exhaust system installed in conformance with

����������������������� a)�� NFPA 91, "Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials," and

����������������������� b)�� NFPA 664, "Prevention of Fires and Explosions in Wood Processing and Woodworking Facilities."

������������ 2)�� Operations or machines that generate sparks or combustible vapours shall not be served by exhaust systems connected to woodworking machines referred to in Sentence (1).

5.3.2.2. Shavings and Sawdust Collection

������������ 1)�� Loose shavings and sawdust shall be collected at frequent intervals and deposited in receptacles described in Article 2.4.1.3.

5.3.2.3. Fire Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� A portable extinguisher conforming to Part 6 shall be provided within 7.5 m of any machine producing wood dust, particles or shavings.

5.3.3. �� Grain Handling and Storage Facilities

5.3.3.1. Storage Bins and Silos

������������ 1)�� A product subject to spontaneous heating shall be permitted to be stored in silos or bins only if measures are taken to

����������������������� a)�� monitor the temperature of the stored product, and

����������������������� b)�� prevent overheating of the stored product from creating a fire or explosion hazard.

������������ 2)�� Permanently open vent stacks are permitted to be used for the ventilation of storage bins where mechanical dust-collecting systems are not practical provided that the vent stacks

����������������������� a)�� have a cross-sectional area not less than twice that of all spouts discharging into the bin,

����������������������� b)�� are installed not more than 30� from the vertical,

����������������������� c)�� extend from the top of the bin to a point not less than 1.2 m above the roof, and

����������������������� d)�� are designed to prevent the entry of snow and rain.

5.3.3.2. Conveying Equipment

������������ 1)�� Belt conveyors and bucket elevator legs shall be equipped with safety devices to

����������������������� a)�� detect excessive misalignment, blockage, slipping or slow-down of the conveying equipment, and

����������������������� b)�� prevent conditions described in Clause (a) from creating a fire or explosion hazard by

������������������������������������ i)��� alerting personnel trained in taking appropriate actions, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� automatically stopping the conveying equipment.

������������ 2)�� Conveying equipment belts shall be made of static conductive materials to prevent buildup of static charges. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Conveying equipment bearings shall be

����������������������� a)�� accessible for inspection and maintenance,

����������������������� b)�� lubricated to prevent overheating, and

����������������������� c)�� kept free of accumulation of combustible dusts.

������������ 4)�� Belt conveyor galleries and tunnels and bucket elevator leg enclosures shall be provided with explosion venting to the outdoors in conformance with Sentence 5.3.1.6.(2).

5.3.3.3. Separators

������������ 1)�� Separators shall be provided at grain receiving points ahead of the conveying equipment. (See Article 5.3.1.9.)

5.3.3.4. Fire Protection

������������ 1)�� Portable fire extinguishers shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

������������ 2)�� When a standpipe and hose system is provided, fog and fine spray nozzles shall be used to prevent combustible dust from being raised into suspension upon application of solid stream water discharge.

Section 5.4. �� Spray Coating Operations

5.4.1. �� Scope

5.4.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to spray coating operations involving the use of combustible dry powders, flammable liquids or combustible liquids.

5.4.2. �� Location

5.4.2.1. Fire Separations and Fire Suppression Systems

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) to (4), spray coating operations shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of at least 2 h.

������������ 2)�� Spray coating operations need not be separated from the remainder of the building in conformance with Sentence (1), provided that

����������������������� a)�� the building is sprinklered in conformance with Article 6.5.1.1., and

����������������������� b)�� the spray coating operations are confined within a spray booth.

������������ 3)�� Where spray coating operations are confined within a spray booth, and where an automatic sprinkler or other fire suppression system is provided to protect the spray booth, exhaust ducts and spraying area in conformance with Part 6, the fire separation required in Sentence (1) need not have a fire-resistance rating, but shall be vapour tight. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 4)�� In low hazard industrial occupancies, where spray coating operations are confined within a spray booth, and where an automatic sprinkler or fire suppression system is provided as specified in Sentence (3) to protect the spray booth, exhaust ducts and spraying area, the spraying area need not be separated from the remainder of the building. (See Appendix A.)

5.4.3. �� Spray Booths

5.4.3.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� A spray booth shall consist of a steel frame covered with sheet steel having a minimum thickness of 1.14mm or be of equivalent noncombustible construction.

������������ 2)�� The interior surfaces of a spray booth shall be smooth and continuous.

������������ 3)�� The floor of a spray booth and the operators' working areas shall be of noncombustible material.

������������ 4)�� A spray booth shall be provided with an overspray collector to prevent a build-up of combustible deposits on the exhaust fan and ductwork. (See Appendix A.)

5.4.3.2. Baffles

������������ 1)�� Spray booth baffle plates shall be of a noncombustible material and be removable or arranged to facilitate cleaning.

������������ 2)�� Spray booth baffle plates shall not be located in exhaust ducts.

5.4.3.3. Filters

������������ 1)�� Filters in ducts used to ventilate spray booths shall be made from noncombustible material or have a rate of combustibility no greater than Class II filters conforming to CAN4-S111-M, "Fire Tests for Air Filter Units."

������������ 2)�� Filters shall not be used when applying spray material that is highly susceptible to spontaneous ignition.

������������ 3)�� All discarded filter pads and filter rolls shall be removed to a safe location or placed in a water-filled metal receptacle and disposed of after each day's operation.

5.4.3.4. Blowers

������������ 1)�� Fan blades and casings in exhaust blowers for spray booths shall be non-ferrous, or the fan shall be constructed so that a movement of the wheel or shaft will not permit 2 ferrous parts of the fan to rub or strike together.

5.4.4. �� Ventilation

5.4.4.1. Mechanical Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Mechanical ventilation with sufficient air movement to prevent dangerous flammable vapour or powder concentrations shall be provided in all spraying areas in conformance with Subsections 4.1.7. and 5.3.1.

5.4.4.2. Air Velocity

������������ 1)�� Where a mechanical exhaust ventilation system with horizontal air movement is provided in a spray booth, the air velocity at the face of the spray booth shall be not less than

����������������������� a)�� 0.5 m/s for non-electrostatic spraying, or

����������������������� b)�� 0.3 m/s for electrostatic spraying.

5.4.4.3. Exhaust Ducts

������������ 1)�� A separate exhaust duct shall be provided for each spray booth, except that a common duct is permitted to be used if it serves spray booths having a combined open frontal area of not more than 1.7 m2.

5.4.4.4. Air Exhausted

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 4.1.7.6. and in Sentence 5.3.1.4.(3), air exhausted from spray operations shall not be returned to the building.

5.4.5. �� Exhaust Ducts

5.4.5.1. Construction

������������ 1)�� Exhaust ducts for spray booths shall be securely supported and constructed of sheet steel in conformance with Table 5.4.5.1.

Table 5.4.5.1.

Minimum Thickness of Sheet Steel

Forming Part of Sentence 5.4.5.1.(1).

Maximum Dimension of Duct, mm

Minimum Thickness of Sheet Steel, mm

Up to 200

0.56

Over 200 to 450

0.69

Over 450 to 750

0.86

Over 750

1.14

5.4.5.2. Clearances

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), a clearance of 450 mm shall be maintained between exhaust ducts for spray booths and unprotected combustible material.

������������ 2)�� Where exhaust ducts pass through combustible roofs or partitions, a clearance of not less than 100 mm between the duct and combustible material shall be

����������������������� a)�� provided by metal collars, and

����������������������� b)�� sealed with noncombustible insulating material.

5.4.5.3. Access Doors

������������ 1)�� Exhaust ducts for spray booths shall be provided with access doors for cleaning purposes.

5.4.5.4. Exhaust Outlets

������������ 1)�� Except for water-wash types, the exhaust outlet to atmosphere from all spray booths shall be

����������������������� a)�� not less than 1.8 m from any combustible exterior wall or roof, and

����������������������� b)�� located so that air does not discharge toward any combustible surface or unprotected opening within 7.5 m of the exhaust outlet.

5.4.6. �� Electrical Equipment

5.4.6.1. Installation

������������ 1)�� Except where separated from the spraying area by vapour-tight separations with no openings, all electrical equipment within the spraying area, including lighting fixtures, shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations."

5.4.6.2. Electric Motors

������������ 1)�� Electric motors for exhaust fans shall not be placed inside spray booths or ducts.

5.4.6.3. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� All metal parts of spray booths, exhaust ducts and piping systems conveying flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be electrically bonded and grounded.

5.4.7. �� Flammable and Combustible Liquids

5.4.7.1. Storage and Handling

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids for use in spraying areas shall be stored and handled in conformance with Part 4, and at no time shall the amount of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in the spraying areas exceed one day's supply.

5.4.7.2. Containers

������������ 1)�� Flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be kept in closed containers when not in use.

5.4.7.3. Dispensing

������������ 1)�� Class I liquids shall be dispensed only from containers conforming to Article 4.2.3.1.

5.4.7.4. Relief Valves

������������ 1)�� Where Class I liquids are supplied to spray nozzles by positive displacement pumps, the pump discharge line shall be provided with a suitable relief valve discharging to the pump suction or to a safe remote location.

5.4.8. �� Control of Fire Hazards

5.4.8.1. Interlocks

������������ 1)�� The spraying equipment for a spray booth shall be interlocked to prevent operation when

����������������������� a)�� the ventilation system is shut down, or

����������������������� b)�� the circulating water pump of a water-wash booth is shut down.

5.4.8.2. Spray Residue

������������ 1)�� Where flammable liquid or combustible liquid finishes are being applied in a spray booth, combustible residue shall be removed from the spraying area and put in receptacles conforming to Article 2.4.1.3.

5.4.8.3. Heating Equipment

������������ 1)�� Space-heating appliances, steam pipes and other hot surfaces shall not be located in an area subject to accumulation of deposits of combustible residue from spray coating operations.

5.4.8.4. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Smoking, open flames or spark-producing devices shall not be permitted in a spraying area, and signs shall be posted in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

5.4.9. �� Fire Protection

5.4.9.1. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be installed near all spraying areas in conformance with Part 6.

5.4.9.2. Protection of Sprinklers

������������ 1)�� Sprinklers in spray booths shall be protected against overspray residue with lightweight paper or thin polyethylene bags which shall be replaced before they have accumulated excessive deposits.

5.4.10. �� Drying Operations

5.4.10.1. Drying Operations

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Article 5.4.10.3., spray booths or other enclosures used for spraying operations shall not be used for drying by any arrangement which could cause an increase in the surface temperatures of such spray booths or enclosures.

5.4.10.2. Location and Installation

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2) and Article 5.4.10.3., drying or curing equipment that utilizes open flames or that produces sparks shall not be installed in or near a spraying area.

������������ 2)�� Equipment described in Sentence (1) is permitted to be installed in an area adjacent to the spraying area provided the adjacent area is equipped with a ventilating system arranged to

����������������������� a)�� purge the drying space before the heating system can be started,

����������������������� b)�� maintain a safe atmosphere at any source of ignition, and

����������������������� c)�� automatically shut off the heating system if the ventilating system is shut down.

5.4.10.3. Spray Booths Used for Drying

������������ 1)�� Spray booths are permitted to be used for drying operations provided

����������������������� a)�� the spray booth conforms to Subsection 5.6.1.,

����������������������� b)�� the interior of the enclosure is kept free of overspray deposits,

����������������������� c)�� if portable drying apparatus is used, it is of the electric infrared type, and such apparatus, wiring and connections are removed from the enclosure during spraying operations, and

����������������������� d)�� interlocks are installed to

������������������������������������ i)��� prevent the use of spraying apparatus while the drying operation is taking place,

����������������������������������� ii)��� provide for the purging of the enclosure of spray vapours for not less than 3 min before the drying apparatus can be energized,

���������������������������������� iii)��� ensure that the ventilating system maintains a safe atmosphere within the enclosure during the drying process, and

���������������������������������� iv)��� ensure that the drying apparatus will automatically shut off if the ventilating system is shut down.

5.4.10.4. Flammable Gases

������������ 1)�� No vehicle or apparatus equipped with a vessel containing a Class 2.1 flammable gas shall be permitted in a drying oven, or exposed to any heat source or ambient temperature conditions that could cause overpressurization of the vessel.

5.4.11. �� Electrostatic Spray Coating and Detearing

5.4.11.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to electrostatic spray coating involving the use of flammable liquids or combustible liquids or to the electrostatic removal of excess coating material.

5.4.11.2. Location of Equipment

������������ 1)�� Except for high voltage grids and their connections, all electrical components including transformers, power packs and control equipment for electrostatic spray coating or for the electrostatic removal of excess coating material shall be located in an area where the vapour concentration of flammable liquids or combustible liquids cannot exceed 25% of the lower explosive limit.

5.4.11.3. Automatic Controls

������������ 1)�� Electrostatic spraying and detearing equipment shall be provided with automatic controls that will operate without a time delay to disconnect power to high voltage transformers and to signal the operator when

����������������������� a)�� stoppage of the air supply, ventilating fan or the conveyor system occurs,

����������������������� b)�� there is a ground at any point on the high voltage system, or

����������������������� c)�� clearances are reduced below those specified in Article 5.4.11.5.

5.4.11.4. Insulators

������������ 1)�� All insulators shall be kept clean and dry.

5.4.11.5. Clearances

������������ 1)�� A space equivalent to twice the sparking distance shall be maintained between articles being painted or deteared and electrodes or conductors.

������������ 2)�� A sign shall be posted near an electrical assembly stating the maximum sparking distance.

5.4.11.6. Drip Plates and Screens

������������ 1)�� Drip plates and screens subject to paint deposits shall be removable for cleaning.

5.4.11.7. High Voltage Components

������������ 1)�� All high voltage components including atomizing heads shall be insulated and protected against mechanical damage and accidental contact or grounding.

������������ 2)�� High voltage circuits shall be designed so that any discharge occurring will not ignite vapour-air mixtures or create a shock hazard.

5.4.11.8. Grounding

������������ 1)�� An automatic means shall be provided for grounding the electrode system when it isde-energized.

������������ 2)�� All electrically conductive objects in the spraying area shall be grounded, and a sign shall be posted indicating the need for such grounding.

5.4.11.9. Operating Distances

������������ 1)�� Articles being electrostatically spray coated shall not be held by hand nor shall they be suspended in such a manner as to reduce the proper operating distance from the atomizing heads.

������������ 2)�� Electrostatic spraying equipment shall be located not less than 1.5 m from processing equipment and shall be isolated from other areas by grounded guards and fences of electrically conducting material.

5.4.11.10. Surface Temperatures

������������ 1)�� The surface temperature of equipment in a spraying area shall not exceed 66�C.

5.4.11.11. Spray Guns

������������ 1)�� The energy supply to the hand spray gun shall be controlled by a switch that also controls the coating material supply.

������������ 2)�� The spray gun handle shall be grounded and shall have a metallic connection which is in direct contact with the operator's hand during spraying.

5.4.11.12. Spray Residue

������������ 1)�� Hooks and other supports for sprayed articles shall be kept clean and free of paint.

5.4.11.13. Signs

������������ 1)�� Signs designating the spraying area as dangerous shall be posted.

5.4.12. �� Automobile Undercoating

5.4.12.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to automobile undercoating spray operations involving the use of Class II or IIIA liquids.

������������ 2)�� Automobile undercoating spray operations described in Sentence (1) conforming to this Subsection are permitted not to comply with other applicable requirements contained in this Section.

������������ 3)�� Automobile undercoating spray operations using Class I liquids are not covered in this Subsection and shall conform to other applicable requirements contained in this Section.

5.4.12.2. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), natural or mechanical ventilation shall be provided in work areas to prevent the accumulation of vapours from Class II or IIIA liquids.

������������ 2)�� Where the undercoating operation uses Class II liquids, they shall be applied in a work area where

����������������������� a)�� there are no work pits,

����������������������� b)�� mechanical ventilation provides not less than 1.2 m3/s of air movement during the application, cleaning and drying cycles,

����������������������� c)�� air movement from the air intake and exhaust system is along the length of the vehicle being undercoated, and

����������������������� d)�� air is exhausted at a level approximately 1 m above the floor.

5.4.12.3. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Work areas described in Article 5.4.12.2. shall have no spark-producing equipment or appliances and no open flames within 6 m of the work area.

������������ 2)�� Smoking shall not be permitted in a work area referred to in Sentence (1) and signs shall be posted at the outer limits of the work area in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

5.4.12.4. Flammable and Combustible Liquids

������������ 1)�� Automobile undercoating material and solvents shall be stored and handled in conformance with Part 4.

5.4.12.5. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

5.4.12.6. Housekeeping

������������ 1)�� All areas where automobile undercoating is used shall be kept clean of undercoating deposits and refuse, which shall be placed in covered metal receptacles.

5.4.13. �� Dry Powder Coating

5.4.13.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to coating operations involving the use of combustible dry powders applied by powder spray guns, electrostatic powder spray guns, fluidized beds or electrostatic fluidized beds.

5.4.13.2. Location and Installation

������������ 1)�� Coating operations referred to in Article 5.4.13.1. shall be performed in

����������������������� a)�� ventilated, enclosed, powder coating rooms of noncombustible construction, or

����������������������� b)�� spray booths conforming to this Section.

������������ 2)�� Electrostatic fluidized beds and associated equipment shall be installed in conformance with good engineering practice.

������������ 3)�� With the exception of charging electrodes and their connections, transformers, power packs, control apparatus and all other electrical components shall be located outside the powder coating area.

5.4.13.3. Temperatures

������������ 1)�� Where an article to be coated is preheated prior to the application of the powder, the temperature of the article shall not exceed the ignition temperature of the powder being used.

������������ 2)�� The surface temperature of electrostatic fluidized bed coating areas shall not exceed 66�C.

5.4.13.4. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� Powder transport, application and recovery equipment shall be bonded and grounded.

������������ 2)�� All electrically conductive objects within the charging influence of the electrodes of electrostatic fluidized beds shall be grounded, and a sign shall be posted indicating the necessity of such grounding.

5.4.13.5. High Voltage Circuits

������������ 1)�� High voltage circuits in electrostatic fluidized beds shall be so designed that any discharge produced when the charging electrodes of the bed are approached or contacted by a grounded object shall not be of sufficient intensity to

����������������������� a)�� ignite any powder-air mixture likely to be encountered, or

����������������������� b)�� result in any appreciable shock hazard.

5.4.13.6. Separators

������������ 1)�� Separators shall be used to prevent tramp iron or other spark-producing materials from being introduced into the powders being applied.

5.4.13.7. Powder Recovery Systems

������������ 1)�� All waste air-suspended powders shall be removed by exhaust ducts to a powder recovery system and shall not be released to the outside atmosphere.

5.4.13.8. Waste Dust Removal

������������ 1)�� Any accumulations of waste dust from dry powder coatings shall be removed by vacuum cleaning equipment.

5.4.13.9. Contact Points

������������ 1)�� Articles being coated shall be maintained in contact with the conveyor or other support.

������������ 2)�� Hangers for articles being coated shall be kept clean and areas of contact with such articles shall have sharp points or edges.

5.4.13.10. Smoking

������������ 1)�� Smoking shall not be permitted and signs shall be conspicuously posted at all powder coating areas and powder storage rooms in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

5.4.14. �� Organic Peroxides and Dual Component Coatings

5.4.14.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to spray coating operations involving the use of Class 5.2 organic peroxides and other dual component coatings.

5.4.14.2. Location

������������ 1)�� Spray coating operations referred to in Article 5.4.14.1. shall be conducted in spray booths conforming to this Section.

5.4.14.3. Initiator Storage

������������ 1)�� Organic peroxide initiators shall be stored so that they will be kept away from contact with all other stored materials.

5.4.14.4. Handling Equipment

������������ 1)�� Handling equipment, including spray guns, which is specifically designed for use with organic peroxides shall be used to apply such coatings.

5.4.14.5. Containers

������������ 1)�� Separate containers shall be used exclusively for the storage of resin and organic peroxide.

5.4.14.6. Pressure Tank Inserts

������������ 1)�� Organic peroxide pressure tank inserts shall be constructed of stainless steel, polyethylene or material that is equally inert to organic peroxide.

5.4.14.7. Foreign Materials

������������ 1)�� Precautions shall be taken to prevent any mixing of foreign materials with dusts or overspray residues resulting from the sanding or spraying of coating materials containing organic peroxides.

5.4.14.8. Absorbents

������������ 1)�� Non-reactive absorbents shall be used to remove peroxide spills and shall be disposed of in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

5.4.14.9. Handling

������������ 1)�� Organic peroxides shall be stored and handled in conformance with Parts 3 and 4.

������������ 2)�� Quantities of organic peroxides shall be withdrawn only as required on a daily basis, and unused material shall be disposed of on the completion of the day's work.

������������ 3)�� Organic peroxides shall not be subjected to shock or friction during handling.

5.4.14.10. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Organic peroxides shall not be permitted to come in contact with ignition sources, such as heating surfaces, open flames and sparks, or be subjected to solar radiation.

������������ 2)�� Where organic peroxides are stored, mixed or applied,

����������������������� a)�� only non-sparking tools shall be used,

����������������������� b)�� smoking shall not be permitted, and

����������������������� c)�� signs shall be posted in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

5.4.14.11. Catalysts

������������ 1)�� Organic peroxides shall not be mixed directly with any catalyst.

5.4.14.12. Trained Personnel

������������ 1)�� Only trained personnel shall work with organic peroxides.

Section 5.5. �� Dipping and Coating Processes

5.5.1. �� Scope

5.5.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to

����������������������� a)�� processes in which products or materials are immersed in a dip tank containing flammable liquids or combustible liquids, and

����������������������� b)�� the unatomized application of flammable liquids or combustible liquids, such as by flow coating or roll coating processes.

5.5.2. �� Location

5.5.2.1. Fire Separation

������������ 1)�� Dipping or coating processes involving Class I liquids shall be separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

5.5.2.2. Basements

������������ 1)�� Dipping or coating processes shall not be located in basements.

5.5.2.3. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� The floor of any room where dipping or coating processes are located shall be

����������������������� a)�� made liquid tight with material that is impervious to the liquids used in the process,

����������������������� b)�� provided with permanent curbs, and

����������������������� c)�� drained to a location conforming to Article 4.1.6.2.

5.5.3. �� Control of Fire Hazards

5.5.3.1. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Ventilation shall be provided to confine all flammable vapour concentrations exceeding 25% of the lower explosive limit to within 600 mm of the dip tank, drain board and freshly coated work.

������������ 2)�� Ventilation systems required in Sentence (1) shall be interlocked so that the shutdown of any ventilation fan will automatically

����������������������� a)�� stop all dipping conveyor systems, and

����������������������� b)�� sound an alarm.

5.5.3.2. Heating System Interlocks

������������ 1)�� The heating system used in drying operations shall be interlocked so that it cannot be started until the ventilation system is in operation.

������������ 2)�� Where there is a possible source of ignition in a drying operation, interlocks shall be installed to

����������������������� a)�� provide for purging before the heating system can be started, and

����������������������� b)�� stop the drying operation if the ventilation system is shut down.

5.5.3.3. Conveyor Systems

������������ 1)�� Conveyor systems utilized in conjunction with dip tanks shall be designed to stop automatically with the actuation of an automatic fixed fire suppression system or a manual fire alarm.

5.5.3.4. Electrical Installation

������������ 1)�� Where a dip tank contains Class I liquids, or where Class II or III liquids are heated to a temperature at or above their flash point, the electrical installation shall conform to CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Eletrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations."

5.5.3.5. Flammable and Combustible Liquids

������������ 1)�� Storage and handling of flammable liquids and combustible liquids shall be in conformance with Part 4.

������������ 2)�� The total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in a processing area shall not exceed that required for one day's operation.

5.5.3.6. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Open flames, spark-producing devices and heated surfaces having a temperature sufficient to ignite vapours shall not be permitted in an area where the concentration of flammable vapours is more than 25% of the lower explosive limit.

5.5.3.7. Smoking

������������ 1)�� Smoking shall not be permitted and signs shall be posted conspicuously in the vicinity of processing areas in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

5.5.4. �� Fire Protection

5.5.4.1. Dip Tanks

������������ 1)�� Dip tanks with over 550 L capacity or with over 1 m2 liquid surface area shall be protected by

����������������������� a)�� an automatic closing cover actuated by a device that also permits manual operation, or

����������������������� b)�� a fixed fire suppression system conforming to Part 6.

������������ 2)�� Dip tanks containing Class I liquids, or Class II or III liquids heated to a temperature at or above their flash point, shall conform to Sentence (1) when

����������������������� a)�� the capacity exceeds 45 L, or

����������������������� b)�� the liquid surface area exceeds 0.4 m2.

5.5.4.2. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Processing areas shall be provided with portable extinguishers in conformance with Part 6.

5.5.5. �� Dip Tanks

5.5.5.1. Height above Floor

������������ 1)�� The top of a dip tank shall be not less than 150 mm above the floor of the room in which it is located.

5.5.5.2. Construction

������������ 1)�� All dip tanks and drain boards shall be constructed of noncombustible material with steel, reinforced concrete or masonry supports.

5.5.5.3. Dip Tank Covers

������������ 1)�� Dip tank covers required in Article 5.5.4.1. shall

����������������������� a)�� be of noncombustible material or be clad with metal having leakproof joints,

����������������������� b)�� overlap the sides of the tank by not less than 25 mm, with a recess or flange extending down around the tank,

����������������������� c)�� be maintained in operating condition, and

����������������������� d)�� be supported by chains or wire rope in areas where a fire may interfere with the action of the closing device.

������������ 2)�� All associated equipment for dip tank covers referred to in Sentence (1) shall be of metal with noncombustible mountings.

5.5.5.4. Liquid Level

������������ 1)�� The liquid level in a dip tank shall be kept not less than 150 mm below the top of the tank.

5.5.5.5. Overflow Pipes

������������ 1)�� Dip tanks having a capacity in excess of 550 L or having a liquid surface area in excess of 1 m2 shall be equipped with a properly trapped overflow pipe that leads to an outside location conforming to Subsection 4.1.6. or to a closed, vented salvage tank conforming to Article 5.5.5.9.

������������ 2)�� The centre line of the overflow connection to a dip tank shall be not less than 150 mm below the top of the tank.

������������ 3)�� Overflow pipe sizes for dip tanks shall conform to Table 5.5.5.5.

������������ 4)�� Overflow pipes shall be connected to dip tanks by a flared outlet.

Table 5.5.5.5.

Overflow Pipe Sizes

Forming Part of Sentence 5.5.5.5.(3)

Capacity of Dip Tank, L

Overflow Pipe Size, mm

Up to 46

50

Over 46 to 160

65

Over 160 to 350

75

Over 350 to 700

100

Over 700 to 1025

125

Over 1 025 to 1 500

150

Over 1 500

200

5.5.5.6. Piping Connections

������������ 1)�� Piping connections for drains and overflow lines shall be designed so as to allow for easy access to their interiors for cleaning purposes.

5.5.5.7. Bottom Drains

������������ 1)�� Dip tanks of over 2 000 L liquid capacity shall be equipped with bottom drains capable of being operated both automatically and manually to drain the tank quickly in the event of fire.

������������ 2)�� Bottom drains from dip tanks shall be trapped and shall discharge to an outside location conforming to Subsection 4.1.6. or to a closed, vented salvage tank conforming to Article 5.5.5.9.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4), bottom drain sizes for dip tanks shall conform to Table 5.5.5.7.

������������ 4)�� Drain pipe diameters other than those specified in Sentence (3) shall be permitted, provided they are adequate to empty the tank in 5 min or less.

������������ 5)�� Manual operation of drains shall be from an accessible location not affected by a fire in or around the dip tank.

Table 5.5.5.7.

Bottom Drain Pipe Sizes

Forming Part of Sentence 5.5.5.7.(3)

Capacity of Dip Tank, L

Diameter of Bottom Drain Pipe, mm

Over 2 000 to 3 000

75

Over 3 000 to 4 000

100

Over 4 000 to 10 000

125

Over 10 000 to 18 000

150

Over 18 000

200

5.5.5.8. Automatic Pumps

������������ 1)�� Where gravity flow is not practicable, automatic pumps shall be installed on drain lines from dip tanks.

5.5.5.9. Salvage Tanks

������������ 1)�� Salvage tanks shall be used only for temporary storage purposes.

������������ 2)�� The capacity of a salvage tank shall be greater than the capacity of the dip tank or tanks to which it is connected.

������������ 3)�� Salvage tanks shall be located underground outside the building, or inside a building in an enclosure separated from the remainder of the building by a fire separation having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 h.

������������ 4)�� Where salvage tanks are used, pumping arrangements shall be provided for the transfer of their contents for disposal.

5.5.6. �� Hardening and Tempering Quench Tanks

5.5.6.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to heat treatment processes where hot materials or metal products are immersed in a quench tank containing Class II or III cooling liquids.

5.5.6.2. Location

������������ 1)�� Quench tanks shall be located as far as practicable from annealing, hardening and tempering furnaces and shall not be located on or near combustible floors.

5.5.6.3. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Quench tanks shall be provided with a noncombustible hood and vent exhausting to the outside to prevent the accumulation and condensation of vapours from the process.

������������ 2)�� Vents for quench tanks shall conform to the requirements for flue pipes in Section 2.6.

5.5.6.4. Temperature Limit Switches

������������ 1)�� Quench tanks shall be provided with a high temperature limit switch installed in such a way that when the cooling liquid reaches 10�C below its flash point, the switch will

����������������������� a)�� stop the conveyors utilized in conjunction with the quench tank, and

����������������������� b)�� sound an alarm.

������������ 2)�� The temperature-sensing element for the high temperature limit switch required in Sentence (1) shall be located close to the surface of the liquid and shall be protected from damage.

5.5.6.5. Air Pressure

������������ 1)�� Air under pressure shall not be used to fill or agitate liquid in quench tanks.

5.5.6.6. Working Temperature

������������ 1)�� A quench tank shall be designed so that the maximum workload is incapable of raising the working temperature of the cooling liquid to within 28�C of its flash point.

5.5.7. �� Flow Coating Operations

5.5.7.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to coating operations where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are discharged in an unatomized state onto products or materials to be coated.

������������ 2)�� The sump area and any area on which coating liquid flows shall be considered as the dip tank area for purposes of these provisions.

5.5.7.2. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� The ventilation system required in Article 5.5.3.1. shall be interlocked to shut off the coating liquid supply whenever ventilation fans are shut down.

5.5.7.3. Coating Liquid Supply

������������ 1)�� Coating liquid shall be supplied by

����������������������� a)�� direct low pressure pumping arranged to stop automatically in the event of fire, or

����������������������� b)�� a gravity tank of not more than 45 L capacity.

5.5.8. �� Roll Coating Operations

5.5.8.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection shall apply to coating operations where flammable liquids or combustible liquids are applied to products or materials by bringing them into contact with a roller that is coated with the coating liquid.

5.5.8.2. Bonding and Grounding

������������ 1)�� All rotating parts shall be bonded and grounded and static collectors shall be installed where the material being coated leaves each rotating part.

Section 5.6. �� Special Processes Involving Flammable and Combustible Liquids

5.6.1. �� Industrial Ovens

5.6.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection applies to industrial baking and drying ovens which during operation contain flammable vapours given off by the products being baked or dried.

5.6.1.2. Location

������������ 1)�� Industrial ovens shall not be located in a basement or any other area below grade.

5.6.1.3. Materials

������������ 1)�� Industrial ovens shall be fabricated of noncombustible materials with smooth interior surfaces to permit cleaning.

5.6.1.4. Limiting Temperature

������������ 1)�� Ovens, heaters and associated ductwork shall have sufficient clearance or be insulated where necessary to prevent the temperature from exceeding 90�C at any combustible part of the building assembly.

5.6.1.5. Explosion Venting

������������ 1)�� Industrial ovens shall be provided with explosion venting conforming to good engineering practice such as described in NFPA 68, "Venting of Deflagrations."

5.6.1.6. Ducts and Stacks

������������ 1)�� Ducts, stacks and associated insulation in systems for the removal of flammable vapours shall

����������������������� a)�� be of noncombustible materials,

����������������������� b)�� not pass through firewalls, and

����������������������� c)�� discharge outdoors not less than

������������������������������������ i)��� 1.5 m from unprotected building openings, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� 6 m from air intake openings.

5.6.1.7. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Ovens in which flammable vapours may be present or through which products of combustion are circulated shall be ventilated in accordance with NFPA 86, "Ovens and Furnaces."

5.6.1.8. Fan Interlocks

������������ 1)�� In ovens where flammable vapours may be present, interlocks shall be provided to ensure that energy sources and ignition devices are de-activated when

����������������������� a)�� the ventilating fans stop, or

����������������������� b)�� the excess temperature controls are activated.

������������ 2)�� In continuous process ovens where flammable vapours may be present, interlocks shall be provided to ensure

����������������������� a)�� that all ventilating fans are operating before conveyors can be started, and

����������������������� b)�� that the conveyors are stopped when

������������������������������������ i)��� the ventilating fans stop, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� the excess temperature controls are activated.

5.6.1.9. Inspection, Cleaning and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Ovens and associated ductwork shall be inspected, cleaned and maintained internally and externally at sufficient intervals to prevent the accumulation of combustible deposits.

������������ 2)�� Access doors or panels shall be provided to permit inspection, cleaning and maintenance of ovens and associated ductwork.

������������ 3)�� Fixed noncombustible ladders, steps or grab rails shall be provided to permit access to the doors or panels required in Sentence (2).

5.6.1.10. Portable Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

5.6.1.11. Standpipe and Hose Systems

������������ 1)�� A standpipe and hose system shall be installed in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code and equipped with spray nozzles so that all parts of an oven structure can be reached by a hose stream.

5.6.1.12. Fire Access Doors

������������ 1)�� Doors or other means of access shall be provided in ovens and associated ductwork so that portable extinguishers or hose streams can be used in all parts of the equipment.

5.6.1.13. Fire Suppression Systems

������������ 1)�� Ovens containing or processing sufficient combustible materials to sustain a fire shall be protected by an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Part 6.

5.6.2. �� Dry Cleaning Plants

5.6.2.1. Dry Cleaning Plants

������������ 1)�� Dry cleaning plants shall conform to NFPA 32, "Drycleaning Plants."

5.6.3. �� Fumigation and Thermal Insecticidal Fogging

5.6.3.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Subsection applies to the fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging of buildings, including the fumigation of equipment or commodities within structures, tanks or bins or under tarpaulins.

5.6.3.2. Notification

������������ 1)�� The fire department shall be notified before any operation described in Article 5.6.3.1. is conducted.

������������ 2)�� The occupants of any premises adjacent to that in which fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging is to take place shall be given prior notice.

5.6.3.3. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� All flames and other sources of ignition shall be eliminated in any part of a building undergoing fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging.

5.6.3.4. Electric Power

������������ 1)�� Electric power supply shall be shut off to the premises undergoing fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging.

5.6.3.5. Air Temperature

������������ 1)�� The air temperature in the part of a building undergoing fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging shall be kept sufficiently low to prevent the actuation of any sprinkler or fire alarm system.

5.6.3.6. Access to Premises

������������ 1)�� No person shall be permitted to enter a premise undergoing fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging until the premise has been ventilated and is safe.

������������ 2)�� Warning signs shall be posted in a conspicuous location near every entrance to the premises being fumigated.

������������ 3)�� One person shall be on duty at each entrance to premises undergoing fumigation or thermal insecticidal fogging to prevent any person from entering until such premises have been ventilated.

5.6.4. �� Floor Finishing

5.6.4.1. Application

������������ 1)�� Floor finishing operations involving the use of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall conform to Part 4 and this Subsection.

5.6.4.2. Public Access

������������ 1)�� Any part of a building where floor finishing operations are done shall not be open to the public.

5.6.4.3. Ventilation

������������ 1)�� Ventilation shall be provided in areas where floor finishing operations are done to prevent the accumulation of flammable vapours.

������������ 2)�� Ventilation required in Sentence (1) is permitted to be provided by mechanical systems if their use does not constitute a source of ignition.

5.6.4.4. Sources of Ignition

������������ 1)�� All mechanical systems, electric motors and other equipment which might be a source of ignition shall be shut down, and smoking and the use of open flames shall be prohibited during the application of Class I liquids and for at least 1 h after such application.

5.6.4.5. Waste Receptacles

������������ 1)�� A receptacle conforming to Article 2.4.1.3. shall be provided for all waste rags and materials used in operations involving flammable liquids or combustible liquids, and the contents shall be removed daily and disposed of in a manner that will not create a fire hazard.

Section 5.7. �� Laboratories

5.7.1. �� Scope

5.7.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Section shall apply to laboratories where dangerous goods, including flammable liquids and combustible liquids, are used.

������������ 2)�� Except as otherwise specified in this Section, the use, handling and storage of dangerous goods, including flammable liquids and combustible liquids, shall conform to Parts 3, 4 and 5.

5.7.2. �� Construction

5.7.2.1. Interior Finish Materials

������������ 1)�� Interior finish materials, floors, fixed furniture and equipment shall be chemically resistant to dangerous goods being used in a laboratory to minimize their deterioration, in conformance with Articles 3.2.7.7. and 3.2.7.8.

5.7.2.2. Separation

������������ 1)�� A laboratory shall be separated from other parts of the building by fire separations conforming to this Code and the British Columbia Building Code, but having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 h.

5.7.3. �� Fire Prevention and Protection

5.7.3.1. Emergency Planning

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) to (6), a laboratory shall conform to the requirements for emergency planning in Section 2.8. and for a fire safety plan in Subsection 5.1.5.

������������ 2)�� Fire drills required in Subsection 2.8.3. shall be held at intervals not greater than 3 months in a laboratory.

������������ 3)�� Personnel working in a laboratory shall be trained in the safe handling and use of dangerous goods, in conformance with Article 3.2.7.15.

������������ 4)�� Dangerous goods shall be identified in conformance with Article 3.2.7.13.

������������ 5)�� The laboratory shall be clearly designated as an area containing dangerous goods in conformance with Article 3.2.7.14.

������������ 6)�� Measures shall be taken to prevent access to the laboratory by unauthorized persons.

5.7.3.2. Combustible Materials

������������ 1)�� Where combustible materials, such as packaging materials, are used in a laboratory, their quantity shall not be greater than the supply for one day of normal operation.

������������ 2)�� Combustible materials in excess of those permitted in Sentence (1) shall be stored outside of the laboratory in conformance with Section 3.2.

5.7.3.3. Spill Control

������������ 1)�� Absorbent and neutralizing materials shall be provided in the laboratory and in the dangerous goods storage areas in conformance with Sentence 3.2.7.11.(2).

5.7.3.4. Electrical Equipment

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence 5.7.3.5.(3), electrical equipment in areas where the concentration of flammable vapours can be greater than 25% of its lower explosive limit shall be in conformance with CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations," for Class I, Division 1 hazardous locations.

������������ 2)�� Electrical equipment located inside a power-ventilated enclosure required in Article 5.7.4.2. and its exhaust duct system shall

����������������������� a)�� conform to Sentence (1), and

����������������������� b)�� be designed and maintained to prevent the accumulation of combustible or reactive deposits.

5.7.3.5. Ignition Sources

������������ 1)�� Smoking shall not be permitted in a laboratory and signs shall be posted in conformance with Article 2.4.2.2.

������������ 2)�� Where overheating of unattended equipment using heat can cause a fire or an explosion, such equipment shall be equipped with a high temperature limit switch fitted to

����������������������� a)�� sound an alarm, and

����������������������� b)�� shut off the heat.

������������ 3)�� An ignition source that is an integral part of an operation involving flammable vapours shall be permitted provided

����������������������� a)�� the supply of flammable liquids or combustible liquids for this operation is controlled and kept to a strict minimum,

����������������������� b)�� flammable vapours and combustion fumes are exhausted in conformance with Article 5.7.4.2.,

����������������������� c)�� there is no other source of ignition capable of igniting the flammable vapours in an uncontrolled manner, and

����������������������� d)�� there is no combustible material in the immediate vicinity of this operation.

5.7.3.6. Inspection and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Electrical equipment, mechanical systems, piping, valves, and automatic and manual control and safety devices shall be inspected, tested and maintained in good operating condition at all times.

������������ 2)�� The ventilation systems serving a laboratory shall be inspected and cleaned to prevent the accumulation of combustible or reactive deposits, and the intervals between inspections shall be not greater than

����������������������� a)�� 12 months for the ventilation systems of the laboratory and dangerous goods storage areas, and

����������������������� b)�� 6 months for the ventilation system of a power-ventilated enclosure required in Article 5.7.4.2.

5.7.3.7. Fire Protection

������������ 1)�� Portable fire extinguishers shall be provided in the laboratory in conformance with Part 6.

5.7.4. �� Ventilation

5.7.4.1. General Ventilation

������������ 1)�� A laboratory shall be provided with continuous mechanical ventilation designed and maintained to ensure that dangerous goods vapours and particles

����������������������� a)�� do not accumulate in the laboratory,

����������������������� b)�� are prevented from migrating to other parts of the building,

����������������������� c)�� do not accumulate in the ventilation system,

����������������������� d)�� are exhausted to the outdoors, and

����������������������� e)�� are not returned to the building.

������������ 2)�� A ventilation system required in this Section shall be provided with monitoring devices to

����������������������� a)�� indicate that the ventilation system is in operation, and

����������������������� b)�� sound an alarm if the ventilation system is malfunctioning.

5.7.4.2. Power-Ventilated Enclosure

������������ 1)�� The use of dangerous goods in a laboratory shall be confined inside a power-ventilated enclosure conforming to Articles 5.7.4.3. and 5.7.4.4. when

����������������������� a)�� their use releases flammable vapours, or causes run-away or potentially explosive reactions,

����������������������� b)�� liquids are heated to a temperature equal to or greater than their flash point, or

����������������������� c)�� Class I liquids or unstable liquids are used.

������������ 2)�� A power-ventilated enclosure required in Sentence (1) shall not be used for the storage of dangerous goods, and any quantity in excess of the supply necessary for normal operations shall conform to Subsection 5.7.5.

5.7.4.3. Enclosure Exhaust Ventilation

������������ 1)�� The ventilation system for a power-ventilated enclosure required in Article 5.7.4.2. shall

����������������������� a)�� conform to NFPA 91, "Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials,"

����������������������� b)�� provide continuous exhaust ventilation at an air velocity sufficient to prevent the accumulation of combustible or reactive deposits in the power-ventilated enclosure and its exhaust duct system,

����������������������� c)�� confine dangerous goods vapours and particles to the area where they are generated and exhaust them to the outdoors,

����������������������� d)�� not return the exhausted air to the building, and

����������������������� e)�� be provided with well identified control switches that are

������������������������������������ i)��� located outside of the power-ventilated enclosure, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� readily accessible in case of an emergency.

������������ 2)�� Where deposits referred to in Clause (1)(b) can accumulate in the power-ventilated enclosure and its exhaust duct system and create a fire or explosion hazard,

����������������������� a)�� provisions shall be made to remove such deposits so they do not create a fire or explosion hazard, or

����������������������� b)�� an automatic fire suppression system shall be provided in conformance with Part 6.

5.7.4.4. Enclosure Construction

������������ 1)�� The power-ventilated enclosure required in Article 5.7.4.2. and its exhaust duct system shall

����������������������� a)�� except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), be constructed of noncombustible materials compatible with and chemically resistant to the dangerous goods vapours and particles being exhausted,

����������������������� b)�� be provided with access doors to permit inspection and maintenance of the fan assembly and exhaust ducts,

����������������������� c)�� be provided with instructions for its use and the operation of the ventilation system, and

����������������������� d)�� be provided with means to control accidental spillage in conformance with Subsection 4.1.6.

������������ 2)�� Combustible materials are permitted in systems described in Clause (1)(a) if

����������������������� a)�� such materials are required by the corrosive or reactive properties of the dangerous goods being used, and

����������������������� b)�� their flame spread rating is not more than 25.

������������ 3)�� The flame spread rating required in Sentence (2) is permitted to be greater than 25 if an automatic fire suppression system conforming to Part 6 is provided inside the power-ventilated enclosure and its exhaust duct system.

5.7.5. �� Dangerous Goods

5.7.5.1. Maximum Quantities

������������ 1)�� The quantity of dangerous goods kept in a laboratory shall be minimized and shall not exceed the lesser of

����������������������� a)�� the supply necessary for normal operation, or

����������������������� b)�� when located in

������������������������������������ i)��� a Group A, Division 2 educational or Group D major occupancy, 300 L of flammable liquids and combustible liquids, of which not more than 50 L shall be Class I liquids, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� a Group B major occupancy, the quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids permitted in Sentence 4.2.6.3.(1).

������������ 2)�� Quantities of flammable liquids and combustible liquids in excess of those permitted in Sentence (1) shall be stored in

����������������������� a)�� cabinets conforming to Subsection 4.2.10. except that, in laboratories described in Clause (1)(b), the total quantity of flammable liquids and combustible liquids stored in such cabinets shall not exceed the quantity permitted for one cabinet, or

����������������������� b)�� a room conforming to Subsection 4.2.9.

������������ 3)�� Quantities of dangerous goods other than flammable liquids and combustible liquids in excess of those permitted in Sentence (1) shall be stored outside of the laboratory in conformance with Part 3.

5.7.5.2. Containers for Flammable and Combustible Liquids

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentences (2) and (3), flammable liquids or combustible liquids in a laboratory shall be kept in containers conforming to Subsection 4.2.3.

������������ 2)�� Where Class I liquids are required to be kept in individual containers having a capacity greater than 5 L in a laboratory, such containers shall

����������������������� a)�� be safety containers conforming toULC/ORD-C30, "Safety Containers," and

����������������������� b)�� have a capacity of not more than 25 L.

������������ 3)�� Containers of flammable liquids or combustible liquids shall be kept closed when not in use.

5.7.5.3. Compressed Gases

������������ 1)�� Storage cylinders and piping systems for Class 2 gases used in a laboratory shall be firmly secured and protected against mechanical damage.

������������ 2)�� Each point of supply and each point of use of cylinders or piping systems for Class 2 gases shall be provided with

����������������������� a)�� labels identifying the gas being supplied, and

����������������������� b)�� a manual shut-off valve.

������������ 3)�� A Class 2 gas cylinder valve shall be closed when not in use.

5.7.5.4. Refrigerated Storage

������������ 1)�� Where refrigerators are required to keep Class I liquids at a temperature below normal ambient conditions in a laboratory, such refrigerators shall be designed so that

����������������������� a)�� electrical equipment located within the storage compartment, within the outer shell, on the door and on the door frame of the refrigerator is in conformance with CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations," for Class I, Division 1 hazardous locations, and

����������������������� b)�� electrical equipment mounted on the outside surface of the refrigerator is

������������������������������������ i)��� in conformance with CSA C22.1, "British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations," for Class I, Division 2 hazardous locations, or

����������������������������������� ii)��� located above the top of the storage compartment.

������������ 2)�� Refrigerators described in Sentence (1) shall be identified in conformance with Article 3.2.7.14.

������������ 3)�� Class I liquids in refrigerators shall be kept in closed containers.

5.7.5.5. Perchloric Acid

������������ 1)�� Where perchloric acid is heated above normal ambient temperature, it shall be done in a separate power-ventilated enclosure

����������������������� a)�� conforming to Articles 5.7.4.3. and 5.7.4.4., and

����������������������� b)�� provided with conspicuously posted instructions specifying that it shall be used only for this application.

������������ 2)�� The power-ventilated enclosure required in Sentence (1) and its exhaust duct system shall be washed with water after each use to prevent the accumulation of highly reactive deposits.

������������ 3)�� Heating of perchloric acid shall not be by open flame or hot oil bath.

5.7.5.6. Chemical Wastes

������������ 1)�� Wastes from dangerous goods shall be

����������������������� a)�� identified to prevent accidental mixing of incompatible chemicals, and

����������������������� b)�� included in the quantities specified in Article 5.7.5.1.

Part 6 ����� Fire Protection Equipment

Section 6.1. �� General

6.1.1. �� General

6.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Part provides for

����������������������� a)�� the installation, inspection, testing, maintenance and operation of automatic sprinkler systems, special extinguishing systems, and portable extinguishers, and

����������������������� b)�� the inspection, testing, maintenance and operation of water supplies for fire protection, fire alarm systems, standpipe and hose systems, and emergency power installations.

����������������������� c)�� the requirements for 2-1/2-inch fire hose couplings with associated allied fittings.

6.1.1.2. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Fire protection installations shall be maintained in operating condition.(See Appendix A.)

6.1.1.3. Notification

������������ 1)�� Where tests, repairs or alterations are made to fire protection installations, including sprinkler and standpipe systems, a procedure of notification shall be established.(See Appendix A.)

6.1.1.4. Protection during Shutdown

������������ 1)�� When any portion of a fire protection system is temporarily shut down, alternative measures shall be taken to ensure that protection is maintained. (See Appendix A.)

Section 6.2. �� Portable Extinguishers

6.2.1. �� General

6.2.1.1. Selection and Installation

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be selected and installed in conformance with NFPA 10, "Portable Fire Extinguishers" and with this Code.

6.2.1.2. Standards

������������ 1)�� A portable extinguisher shall not be sold or installed unless it conforms to

����������������������� a)�� CAN/ULC-S503-M, "Carbon Dioxide Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers",

����������������������� b)�� CAN/ULC-S504, "Dry Chemical and Dry Powder Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers",

����������������������� c)�� CAN4-S507, "9 Litre Stored Pressure Water Type Fire Extinguishers", or

����������������������� d)�� CAN/ULC-S512, "Halogenated Agent Hand and Wheeled Fire Extinguishers".

6.2.1.3. Location

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be located in or adjacent to corridors or aisles that provide access to exits.

������������ 2)�� Portable extinguishers in proximity to a fire hazard shall be located so as to be accessible without exposing the operator to undue risk. (See Appendix A.)

6.2.1.4. Instructions

������������ 1)�� All instructions for operating, maintaining and recharging portable extinguishers shall be permanently fixed to each unit.

6.2.1.5. Corrosive Atmospheres

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers subject to damage in a corrosive atmosphere shall not be installed where such an atmosphere exists without providing appropriate corrosion protection for the extinguisher.

6.2.1.6. Mounting Brackets

������������ 1)�� When portable extinguishers are located on vehicles or in areas where they are subject to jarring or vibration, brackets designed to accommodate these effects shall be used.

6.2.1.7. Health and Safety Hazard

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be of a type that does not constitute a hazard to health and safety in its maintenance and use.

6.2.2. �� Classification and Identification

6.2.2.1. Classification of Fires

������������ 1)�� For the purposes of this Section, fires are identified as Class A, Class B, Class C and Class D fires. (See Appendix A.)

6.2.2.2. Rating of Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be rated and identified in conformance with CAN/ULC-S508-M, "Rating and Fire Testing of Fire Extinguishers and Class D Extinguishing Media."

6.2.3. �� Installation Requirements

6.2.3.1. Hazard Protection

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be provided for the protection of the building structure and occupancy hazards in conformance with this Subsection and as specified elsewhere in this Code. (See Appendix A.)

6.2.3.2. Dwelling Units

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers shall be installed in all buildings except dwelling units.

6.2.3.3. Extinguishers for Class A Fires

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers for Class A fires shall be provided as required in Table 6.2.3.3., but in no case shall there be fewer than one extinguisher per storey having a minimum rating of 2-A.

Table 6.2.3.3.

Portable Extinguishers for Class A Fires

Forming Part of Sentence 6.2.3.3.(1)

Light Hazard
Occupancy (1)

Ordinary Hazard
Occupancy (1)

Extra Hazard
Occupancy (1)

Minimum extinguisher rating

2-A

2-A

4-A (2)

Maximum floor area , m2, per unit of rating (3)

300

150

100

Maximum floor area per
extinguisher, m2

1 100

1 100

1 100

Maximum travel distance to extinguisher, m

25

25

25

Notes to Table 6.2.3.3.:

��� (1)�� Classified in accordance with NFPA 10, "Portable Fire Extinguishers."

��� (2)�� Two 2-A rated extinguishers are permitted to be used to fulfill the requirement for one 4-A rated extinguisher.

��� (3)�� Per unit of the numerical component of the extinguisher rating.

6.2.3.4. Hose Stations in Lieu of Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Up to half of the number of portable extinguishers required per floor area in Table 6.2.3.3. are permitted to be replaced by hose stations that are

����������������������� a)�� equipped with not less than 23 m of hose conforming to CGSB 20-GP-12Ma, "Braided Water Hose, Knitted or Spiral Wound Reinforcement,"

����������������������� b)�� connected to a permanent water supply, and

����������������������� c)�� spaced so that the travel distance to the nearest hose does not exceed 25 m.

������������ 2)�� The water supply piping and hose referred to in Sentence (1) shall be not less than 19 mm diameter, and the hose shall be equipped with a combination water-spray nozzle.

6.2.3.5. Extinguishers for Class B Fires

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers for Class B fires shall be provided as required in Table 6.2.3.5.

Table 6.2.3.5.

Portable Extinguishers for Class B Fires

Forming Part of Sentence 6.2.3.5.(1)

Grade of Hazard (1)

Basic Minimum Extinguisher Rating

Maximum Travel Distance to Extinguishers, m

Light

5-B

9

10-B

15

Ordinary

10-B

9

20-B

15

Extra

40-B

9

80-B

15

Notes to Table 6.2.3.5.:

��� (1)�� Graded in conformance with NFPA 10, "Portable Fire Extinguishers."

6.2.3.6. Extinguishers for Commercial Cooking Equipment

������������ 1)�� Alkali base dry chemical portable extinguishers shall be provided to protect commercial cooking equipment.

6.2.3.7. Extinguishers for Class C Fires

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers for Class C fires shall be provided for fires in or near electrical equipment.

������������ 2)�� Distribution of portable extinguishers for Class C fires shall conform to the applicable provisions for the distribution of extinguishers for Class A or Class B fires in the vicinity of the electrical equipment.

6.2.4. �� Inspection, Testing and Maintenance

6.2.4.1. Inspection, Testing and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Except as otherwise required in this Section, inspection, testing and maintenance of portable extinguishers shall be in conformance with NFPA 10, "Portable Fire Extinguishers."

6.2.4.2. Defective Extinguishers

������������ 1)�� Portable extinguishers having defects shall be repaired or recharged where necessary to ensure the extinguisher will operate effectively and safely.

������������ 2)�� Extinguisher shells, cartridges or cylinders which show leakage or permanent distortion in excess of specified limits or which rupture shall be removed from service.

6.2.4.3. Retests

������������ 1)�� Retests shall be conducted at the original hydrostatic test pressure as stated on the nameplate.

6.2.4.4. Labels

������������ 1)�� A label shall be fixed to the extinguisher after testing indicating the month and year the hydrostatic pressure test was performed and including the test pressure used and the name of the person or agency performing the test.

6.2.4.5. Tags

������������ 1)�� Each portable extinguisher shall have a tag securely attached to it showing the maintenance or recharge date, the servicing agency and the signature of the person who performed the service.

Section 6.3. �� Fire Alarm and Voice Communication Systems

6.3.1. �� General

6.3.1.1. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Fire alarm and voice communication systems shall be maintained in operable condition at all times.

6.3.1.2. Inspection and Testing

������������ 1)�� Fire alarm systems shall be inspected and tested in conformance with CAN/ULC-S536-M, "Inspection and Testing of Fire Alarm Systems."

������������ 2)�� Fire alarm and detection system components shall be accessible for purposes of inspection or maintenance.

6.3.1.3. Records

������������ 1)�� A record shall be kept of all tests required by Sentence 6.3.1.2.(1), and such records shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.3.1.4. Proprietary Signalling Systems

������������ 1)�� Proprietary signalling systems shall be maintained in conformance with NFPA 72, "Installation, Maintenance and Use of Protective Signalling Systems."

6.3.1.5. Voice Communication Systems

������������ 1)�� Voice communication systems that are integrated with a required fire alarm system shall be tested in conformance with Article 6.3.1.2.

������������ 2)�� Voice communication or public address systems that are part of the building evacuation plan and are not electrically supervised shall be tested at intervals not greater than one month in conformance with Sentences (3) and (4). (See Appendix A.)

������������ 3)�� Loudspeakers operated from the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure they can be heard in all parts of the building.

������������ 4)�� The 2-way communication system from each floor area to the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure proper operation.

Section 6.4. �� Standpipe and Hose Systems

6.4.1. �� General

6.4.1.1. Inspection, Testing and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� The inspection, testing and maintenance of standpipe and hose systems shall conform to NFPA 14, "Installation of Standpipe and Hose Systems."

6.4.1.2. Protection During Alteration or Demolition

������������ 1)�� During alteration or demolition of a building required to have a standpipe and hose system, the system shall be installed or dismantled progressively so as to provide protection to all floor areas.

6.4.1.3. Hose Stations and Cabinets

������������ 1)�� Hose stations and cabinets shall be

����������������������� a)�� conspicuously identified,

����������������������� b)�� maintained free of obstructions, and

����������������������� c)�� inspected at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� the hose is in proper position, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� all the equipment is in place and in operable condition.

������������ 2)�� Hose cabinets shall be used for fire protection equipment only.

6.4.1.4. Defects

������������ 1)�� Standpipe and hose systems having defects shall be repaired or replaced where necessary to ensure they will operate effectively and safely.

6.4.1.5. Tests after Alteration or Period of Disuse

������������ 1)�� Standpipe systems that have been modified or extended in conformance with Article 2.1.3.1. or are being restored to service after a period of disuse exceeding 12 months shall be flow and pressure tested at the highest and most remote hose connection to ensure the availability of the water supply for which the system was designed.

6.4.1.6. Flow Testing

������������ 1)�� Standpipe systems shall be flow tested at intervals not greater than 5 years to ensure that the design flow can be delivered.(See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� If during the flow test required in Sentence (1) there is any indication of the presence of debris in the piping, the entire system shall be flushed of foreign material.

6.4.1.7. Fire Department Connections

������������ 1)�� Signs provided to identify which fire department connection serves a particular sprinkler or standpipe system shall be maintained in conformance with Subsection 2.1.4.

������������ 2)�� Protective caps shall be kept in place at all times on fire department connections.

������������ 3)�� Where protective caps are missing, the fire department connections shall be examined for accumulated refuse, back flushed when conditions warrant, and the caps replaced.

������������ 4)�� Fire department connections shall have their location clearly identified, and be keptreadily accessible and clear of obstructions.

6.4.1.8. Records

������������ 1)�� A record shall be kept of all tests required by this Section, and such records shall be retained for inspection by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

Section 6.5. �� Automatic Sprinkler Systems

6.5.1. �� General

6.5.1.1. Design and Installation

������������ 1)�� Except as otherwise provided in this Code, an automatic sprinkler system required by this Code shall be designed and installed in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.1.2. Sprinkler Control Valves

������������ 1)�� Sprinkler control valves shall not be closed in the event of a fire until the fire is extinguished or is considered to be under control by other means, as determined by the fire department.

6.5.1.3. Changes in Ambient Conditions

������������ 1)�� Changes in equipment or occupancy which might result in temperatures at sprinklers being above 38�C or below 4�C shall not be made without previously making provisions to alter the sprinkler system to prevent premature operation or freezing.

6.5.1.4. Precautions against Freezing

������������ 1)�� Sections of sprinkler systems subject to freezing shall be converted to dry pipe or antifreeze systems with a separate control valve for that part of the system.

6.5.1.5. Obstructions

������������ 1)�� No obstructions shall be placed so as to interfere with the effectiveness of water discharge from sprinklers. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.1.6. Sprinkler Guards

������������ 1)�� Sprinklers shall be protected by sprinkler guards where there is the possibility of mechanical damage.

6.5.1.7. Protection of Combustible Sprinkler Piping

������������ 1)�� Protection required by the British Columbia Building Code for combustible sprinkler piping shall be maintained. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.2. �� Sprinkler System Shutdown

6.5.2.1. Repairs

������������ 1)�� When a sprinkler system is temporarily shut down, it shall be returned to service in the shortest possible time.

6.5.2.2. Restoration of Sprinkler Protection

������������ 1)�� Full sprinkler protection shall be restored or the provisions of Article 6.1.1.4. maintained when work on the system is discontinued.

6.5.2.3. Identification of Closed Valves

������������ 1)�� Closed sprinkler control valves shall be clearly identified. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.3. �� Testing

6.5.3.1. Notification

������������ 1)�� Prior notification of waterflow or other tests to be made to a sprinkler system shall be given to parties who could be affected by an alarm.

6.5.3.2. Waterflow Alarm Tests

������������ 1)�� Waterflow alarm tests using the inspector's test connection shall be performed on wet pipe sprinkler systems at intervals not greater than 12 months.

������������ 2)�� Except as provided in Sentence 6.5.3.4.(1), or when the alarm line discharge is subject to freezing, waterflow alarm tests using the alarm test connection located at the sprinkler valve shall be performed on sprinkler systems at intervals not greater than one month.

6.5.3.3. Records

������������ 1)�� A record shall be kept of tests and operations of each system, and this record shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.5.3.4. Electrical Supervisory Signal Testing

������������ 1)�� Where an electrical supervisory signal service is provided for a sprinkler system, initiating and transmitting devices shall be tested in conformance with Sentences (2) and (3).

������������ 2)�� Transmitters and water flow actuated devices shall be tested at intervals not greater than 2 months.

������������ 3)�� Gate-valve supervisory switches, tank water level devices, building and tank water temperature supervisory devices and other sprinkler system supervisory devices shall be tested at intervals not greater than 6 months.

6.5.3.5. Alterations to Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� After repairs or alterations are made to any sprinkler system

����������������������� a)�� new system piping shall be pressure tested in conformance with Articles 6.5.3.8. to 6.5.3.10.,

����������������������� b)�� a main drain test conforming to Article 6.5.3.11. shall be performed to ensure that all valves controlling water supply are fully opened, and

����������������������� c)�� alarm and supervisory devices shall be checked to ensure that they will function properly.

6.5.3.6. Flushing of Mains

������������ 1)�� Before connection is made between underground water mains and overhead sprinkler system piping, or after any work on underground piping or valves has taken place, underground mains and lead-in connections to sprinkler system risers shall be flushed for sufficient time to remove foreign material, and until the discharge water is clear, using a minimum water flow velocity of 3 m/s. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.3.7. Pressure Testing of Underground Mains

������������ 1)�� Underground mains and connections shall be subjected to a 2 h hydrostatic pressure test of 350 kPa (gauge) in excess of the maximum static pressure, but not less than 1 400 kPa (gauge).

������������ 2)�� Leakage during the test required in Sentence (1) shall not exceed

����������������������� a)�� 2 L/h per 100 joints for pipe laid with rubber gasketted joints, and

����������������������� b)�� 30 mL/h per inch of pipe diameter per joint for pipe laid with caulked lead or lead substitute joints.

6.5.3.8. Pressure Testing of Sprinkler Systems

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Article 6.5.3.10., the sprinkler system shall be subjected to a hydrostatic pressure test of 1 400 kPa (gauge), or 350 kPa (gauge) in excess of the maximum static pressure to which the system may be subjected if in excess of 1 050 kPa (gauge), for a period of 2 h without loss of pressure.

6.5.3.9. Dry-Pipe System Testing

������������ 1)�� For dry-pipe systems, the clapper of the differential dry-pipe valve shall be held off its seat and the ball drip in the intermediate chamber shall be replaced by a plug during the test.

6.5.3.10. Danger of Freezing

������������ 1)�� When danger of freezing does not permit hydrostatic pressure testing, the sprinkler system shall be pressure tested with air at 350 kPa (gauge) for 2 h without loss of pressure.

������������ 2)�� When a sprinkler system has been tested in conformance with Sentence (1), it shall be tested again in conformance with Articles 6.5.3.7. and 6.5.3.8. as soon as hydrostatic pressure testing can be performed without danger of freezing.

6.5.3.11. Main Drain Test

������������ 1)�� A main drain test shall be conducted at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that the water supply available to the sprinkler system has not deteriorated. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� Drainage facilities shall be tested to ensure that the drains are capable of taking the full flow from the main drain pipe without causing damage.

6.5.3.12. Trip Testing of Dry-Pipe Valves

������������ 1)�� Dry-pipe valves shall be trip tested at intervals not greater than 12 months with the control valve partially open.

������������ 2)�� Dry-pipe valves shall be trip tested at intervals not greater than 3 years with the control valve fully open using the inspector's test valve.

6.5.3.13. Alarm Testing

������������ 1)�� All mechanical and electrical alarms shall be tested to ensure that they are in operative condition.

6.5.3.14. Defective Devices

������������ 1)�� If any device in a sprinkler system does not operate properly on test, it shall be repaired or replaced.

6.5.4. �� Maintenance

6.5.4.1. Valve Inspections

������������ 1)�� Except as permitted in Sentences (2) and (3), valves controlling sprinkler water supplies or alarms shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days to ensure that they are in the open position.

������������ 2)�� Valves which are locked open shall be inspected at intervals not greater than one month.

������������ 3)�� Valves which are electrically supervised shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 2 months.

6.5.4.2. Accessibility and Operability

������������ 1)�� Sprinkler control valves shall be accessible and maintained in operable condition at all times.

6.5.4.3. Pits

������������ 1)�� Pits containing sprinkler control valves shall be kept free of water and protected against freezing.

6.5.4.4. Reopening of Control Valves

������������ 1)�� After any sprinkler system control valve has been operated, a drain test shall be performed to ensure that the valve has been fully reopened. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.4.5. Piping and Hangers

������������ 1)�� Sprinkler piping and hangers shall be kept in good repair.

6.5.4.6. Dry-Pipe Systems

������������ 1)�� In addition to other requirements in this Part, dry-pipe automatic sprinkler systems shall be maintained in conformance with Articles 6.5.4.7. to 6.5.4.11.

6.5.4.7. Air Pressure

������������ 1)�� Air pressure on dry-pipe automatic sprinkler systems shall be read at intervals not greater than 7 days, and the system shall be maintained at the required pressure.

6.5.4.8. Winter Drainage

������������ 1)�� Auxiliary drains shall be drained before each winter.

6.5.4.9. Protection against Freezing

������������ 1)�� Dry-pipe valve rooms or enclosures in unheated buildings shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 24 h during periods of freezing weather and measures shall be taken to ensure that the temperature of the room or enclosure is maintained above 4�C.

6.5.4.10. Priming Water Level

������������ 1)�� The priming water for dry-pipe valves shall be maintained at the proper level.

6.5.4.11. Test Flushing

������������ 1) Except as provided in Sentence (2), dry-pipe systems shall be test flushed at intervals not greater than 15 years.

������������ 2)�� Whenever any of the regularly scheduled testing procedures required in Subsection 6.5.3. indicate the presence of possible obstructions in dry-pipe system piping, the entire system shall be flushed of foreign material.

6.5.4.12. Sprinkler Inspection and Replacement

������������ 1)�� Sprinklers shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 12 months for damage, corrosion or accumulations of grease, paint or other deposits and shall be replaced where such conditions would impair the operation of the sprinkler. (See Appendix A.)

6.5.4.13. Sprinkler Testing

������������ 1)�� Sample sprinklers from sprinkler systems which have been in service for more than 50 years shall be sent to a recognized testing laboratory for testing, and this procedure shall be repeated at intervals not greater than 10 years thereafter.

������������ 2)�� When sprinklers are required to be tested in conformance with Sentence (1), no fewer than 6 sprinklers of each type shall be tested, except that no fewer than 2 sprinklers per floor per individual system shall be tested.

6.5.4.14. Defective Sprinklers

������������ 1)�� All sprinklers shall be replaced in sprinkler systems from which sample sprinklers have been tested and found defective.

6.5.4.15. Spare Sprinklers

������������ 1)�� Where sprinkler systems are installed, a supply of spare sprinklers and equipment shall be maintained in conformance with Sentences (2) to (5).

������������ 2)�� Spare sprinklers shall be kept in a cabinet located where the temperature will at no time rise above 38�C.

������������ 3)�� The stock of spare sprinklers to be kept on hand shall be as follows:

����������������������� a)�� for installations containing not more than 300 sprinklers, no fewer than 6 spare sprinklers,

����������������������� b)�� for installations containing from 301 to 1 000 sprinklers, no fewer than 12 spare sprinklers, and

����������������������� c)�� for installations containing more than 1 000 sprinklers, no fewer than 24 spare sprinklers.

������������ 4)�� Spare sprinklers shall correspond to the types and temperature ratings of the sprinklers in use.

������������ 5)�� A sprinkler wrench shall be kept in the cabinet where the spare sprinklers are stored.

6.5.4.16. Fire Department Connections

������������ 1)�� Fire department connections for sprinkler systems shall be maintained in conformance with Article 6.4.1.7.

Section 6.6. �� Water Supply Systems for Fire Protection

6.6.1. �� General

6.6.1.1. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Water supplies for fire protection, including hydrants, shall be maintained so as to be capable of providing the flow and pressure of water for which they were designed.

6.6.1.2. Valve Inspections

������������ 1)�� Valves controlling water supplies to fire protection systems shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days to ensure that they are wide open and are sealed or locked in that position.

6.6.1.3. Ice Accumulations

������������ 1)�� Water supply systems for fire protection shall be kept free of ice accumulations.

6.6.1.4. Antifreeze Solutions

������������ 1)�� Where antifreeze solutions are used to maintain pumping systems operable under freezing conditions, the specific gravity shall be such that the solution will remain unfrozen at a temperature not less than 8�C below the expected minimum temperature of the surrounding atmosphere.

6.6.1.5. Internal Scale and Rust

������������ 1)�� Water supply piping systems shall be cleaned and flushed when necessary to remove deposits of scale or rust that reduce the flow of water below that for which the piping is designed.

6.6.2. �� Tanks

6.6.2.1. Tank Inspections

������������ 1)�� Tanks for fire protection, tank supporting structures and water supply systems including piping, control valves, check valves, heating systems, mercury gauges and expansion joints shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that they are in satisfactory operating condition.

6.6.2.2. Tank Heating Equipment

������������ 1)�� Tank heating equipment and accessories shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 24 h during freezing weather to ensure that they are in operating condition and that heater valves are open.

6.6.2.3. Temperature Readings

������������ 1)�� The temperature of water contained in tanks shall be read at intervals not greater than 24 h during freezing weather and measures shall be taken to ensure that it does not fall below 4�C.

������������ 2)�� For tanks in buildings the temperature of the tank enclosure shall be read at intervals not greater than 24 h during freezing weather and measures shall be taken to ensure that the temperature of the water does not fall below 4�C.

6.6.2.4. Sediment Accumulation and Corrosion

������������ 1)�� Tanks shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 2 years for sediment accumulations and for corrosion.

������������ 2)�� Accumulations of sediment found during inspections shall be removed.

������������ 3)�� Corroded iron or steel work shall be scraped and repainted as required.

6.6.2.5. Cathodic Protection Equipment

������������ 1)�� Cathodic protection equipment installed to prevent corrosion of steel tanks shall be inspected and maintained at intervals not greater than 12 months.

6.6.2.6. Inspection of Gravity Tanks

������������ 1)�� Gravity tanks shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that

����������������������� a)�� the tank roof is tight and in good repair,

����������������������� b)�� hatches or doors are kept closed and properly secured, and

����������������������� c)�� the frostproof casing of the tank riser makes a tight joint with the bottom of the tank.

������������ 2)�� Gravity tanks shall be overflowed at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that they are full.

6.6.2.7. Housekeeping

������������ 1)�� Rubbish and waste materials shall not be permitted in

����������������������� a)�� the space between overflow pipes and the tops of gravity tanks,

����������������������� b)�� the valve pits at the bottoms of the risers, and

����������������������� c)�� the entire area around the bases of the columns of tanks.

6.6.2.8. Expansion Joints

������������ 1)�� Gravity tank expansion joints shall be repacked and adjusted if binding or leaks develop.

6.6.2.9. Inspection of Pressure Tanks

������������ 1)�� Pressure tanks shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days during which

����������������������� a)�� the water level shall be observed, and

����������������������� b)�� the pressure shall be read.

������������ 2)�� Water levels and pressure for pressure tanks shall be maintained at the specified levels.

6.6.3. �� Fire Pumps and Reservoirs

6.6.3.1. Reservoirs

������������ 1)�� The water level in the fire pump reservoir shall be observed at intervals not greater than 7 days and maintained at the proper level.

6.6.3.2. Pump Room Temperature

������������ 1)�� Measures shall be taken to ensure that the ambient air temperature in the pump room never falls below the minimum recommended by the engine manufacturer, or 4�C, whichever is higher. (See Appendix A.)

6.6.3.3. Fire Pump Testing

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), fire pumps shall be operated at intervals not greater than 7 days at their rated speeds until the satisfactory performance of the pump, driver and controller is verified. (See Appendix A.)

������������ 2)�� For fire pumps that are driven by an electric motor, the tests described in Sentence (1) shall be performed at intervals not greater than one month.

������������ 3)�� Internal combustion engine fire pumps shall be operated for a sufficient time to bring the engines up to normal operating temperatures, and the storage batteries, lubrication systems, oil and fuel supplies shall be maintained at the correct levels.

������������ 4)�� Fire pumps shall be tested at full rated capacity at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that they are capable of delivering the rated flow.

6.6.3.4. Records

������������ 1)�� Records shall be kept of all fire pump tests, and such records shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.6.4. �� Hydrants

6.6.4.1. Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Hydrants shall be maintained in operating condition.

������������ 2)�� Hydrants shall be kept clear of obstructions and readily accessible for fire fighting use and their locations shall be clearly identified. (See Appendix A.)

6.6.4.2. Inspection Frequency

������������ 1)�� Hydrants shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 6 months and after each use in conformance with Article 6.6.4.4.

6.6.4.3. Records

������������ 1)�� Records of inspections and tests required in Article 6.6.4.2. shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.6.4.4. Inspections and Repairs

������������ 1)�� Hydrants shall be inspected to ensure that hydrant caps are in place and caps with worn, rusted or obstructed threads, which might hamper easy removal, shall be repaired or replaced.

������������ 2)�� Hydrant barrels shall be inspected to determine if water has accumulated as a result of a leaking main valve or a plugged or damaged drain valve.

������������ 3)�� Except as provided in Sentence (4), main valves which are leaking and drain valves which are plugged or damaged shall be repaired.

������������ 4)�� Where it is not practical to repair faulty drain valves or where drain valves are intentionally plugged, measures shall be taken to prevent the freezing of accumulated water.

6.6.4.5. Annual Flushing

������������ 1)�� Hydrants shall be flushed at intervals not greater than 12 months with the main valve and any outlet valves fully opened until the water runs clear.

6.6.5. �� Standard Fire Hose Thread

6.6.5.1. Specifications

������������ 1)�� All 2-1/2-inch fire hose couplings and allied fittings shall conform to the detailed specifications as follows:

����������������������� a)�� all couplings and fitting shall have a 60� truncated vee thread having dimensions in inches for the male and female couplings as set out in the following tables:

Male

Nominal Inside Diameter

Thread Per Inch

Major Diameter

Pitch Diameter

Minor Diameter

Pitch

Depth of Thread

Max

Min

Max

Min

Max

Min

2.500

8

3.000

2.990

2.919

2.909

2.838

0.125

0.081

Female

Nominal Inside Diameter

Thread Per Inch

Major Diameter

Pitch Diameter

Minor Diameter

Pitch

Depth of Thread

Max

Min

Max

Min

Max

Min

2.500

8

3.020

2.949

2.939

2.868

0.125

0.081

������������ 2)�� All 2-1/2-inch couplings shall be made with the higbee cut to aid quick coupling, the design of which requires the female swivel to have a distance from the face of the coupling swivel to the start of the first thread of 1/16 of an inch, and the male thread shall have a distance from the face of the nipple to the start of the first thread of 1/8 of an inch.

������������ 3)�� Thread form shall be calculated as follows:
Thread form, 60� truncated vee,
N = number of threads per inch
P = pitch of thread
D = depth of thread
F = flat or truncation of thread

������������ 4)�� The threaded portion of the 2-1/2-inch female hose coupling shall be shorter than the threaded portion of the male by 1/32 of an inch for end clearance, and the outer edge of the male pilot end and the inside edge of the female end shall be slightly chamfered.

������������ 5)�� The length of the female hose-coupling shall not be less than 3-31/64 inches.

������������ 6)�� The threaded end of the female coupling, including the washer recess, shall be 28/32 of an inch.

������������ 7)�� The length of the male hose-coupling shall not be less than 3-3/32 inches.

������������ 8)�� The threaded end of the male coupling shall be 29/32 of an inch in length.

������������ 9)�� Material from which fire-hose couplings and fittings are fabricated shall be suitable for its intended use.

���������� 10)�� The outside diameter of the female coupling shall not be less than 3-5/8 inches for the fixed portion and 3-11/16 inches for the swivel portion.

���������� 11)�� The outside diameter of the male coupling shall not be less than 3-5/8 inches.

���������� 12)�� Rubber washers which are made to fit the standard female coupling shall be 3-1/4 inches outside diameter, 2-9/16 inches inside diameter, and 1-1/4 inches in thickness.

���������� 13)�� Fire-hydrant operating spindle-nuts and port cap-nuts shall be pentagonal in shape, having dimensions in accordance with the following:

����������������������� a)�� diameter of the circumscribed circle shall be 1-3/4 inches;

����������������������� b)�� the nut shall measure not more than 1-1/4 inches in height.

Section 6.7. �� Emergency Power Systems and Unit Equipment for Emergency Lighting

6.7.1. �� General

6.7.1.1. Inspection, Testing and Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Articles 6.7.1.2. to 6.7.1.5., emergency power systems shall be inspected, tested and maintained in conformance with CAN/CSA C282-M, "Emergency Electrical Power Supply for Buildings."

6.7.1.2. Notification

������������ 1)�� When an emergency power system or any part thereof is shut down, the supervisory staff shall be notified in conformance with Section 2.8.

6.7.1.3. Instructions

������������ 1)�� Where an emergency power system is installed, instructions shall be provided for switching on essential loads and for starting the generator when this is not done automatically.

6.7.1.4. Records

������������ 1)�� Written records shall be maintained as required in CAN/CSA C282-M, "Emergency Electrical Power Supply for Buildings."

6.7.1.5. Supply of Fresh Fuel

������������ 1)�� Liquid fuel storage tanks shall be drained and refilled with fresh fuel at intervals not greater than 12 months. (See Appendix A.)

6.7.1.6. Inspection of Unit Equipment

������������ 1)�� Self-contained emergency lighting unit equipment shall be inspected at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that

����������������������� a)�� pilot lights are functioning and not obviously damaged or obstructed,

����������������������� b)�� the terminal connections are clean, free of corrosion and lubricated when necessary,

����������������������� c)�� the terminal clamps are clean and tight as per manufacturer's specifications, and

����������������������� d)�� the battery surface is kept clean and dry.

������������ 2)�� Self-contained emergency lighting unit equipment shall be tested

����������������������� a)�� at intervals not greater than one month to ensure that the emergency lights will function upon failure of the primary power supply, and

����������������������� b)�� at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that the unit will provide emergency lighting for a duration equal to the design criterion under simulated power failure conditions.

������������ 3)�� After completion of the test required in Clause (2)(b), the charging conditions for voltage and current and the recovery period shall be tested to ensure that the charging system is functioning in accordance with the manufacturer's specifications.

������������ 4)�� Written records shall be kept of the test carried out in conformance with Clause 6.7.1.6.(2)(b) and such records shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.7.1.7. Inspection of Emergency Lights

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Article 6.7.1.6., emergency lights shall be inspected at intervals not greater than 12 months to ensure that they are functional.

Section 6.8. �� Special Fire Suppression Systems

6.8.1. �� General

6.8.1.1. Standards

(See Appendix A.)

������������ 1)�� Except as otherwise provided in this Section, where a special fire suppression system is required to be installed, the design and installation of the system shall conform to the following:

����������������������� a)�� NFPA 11, "Low Expansion Foam and Combined Agent Systems,"

����������������������� b)�� NFPA 11A, "Medium and High Expansion Foam Systems,"

����������������������� c)�� NFPA 12, "Carbon Dioxide Extinguishing Systems,"

����������������������� d)�� NFPA 12A, "Halon 1301 Fire Extinguishing Systems,"

����������������������� e)�� NFPA 12B, "Halon 1211 Fire Extinguishing Systems,"

������������������������ f)�� NFPA 15, "Water Spray Fixed Systems for Fire Protection,"

����������������������� g)�� NFPA 16, "Deluge Foam-Water Sprinkler Systems and Foam-Water Spray Systems,"

����������������������� h)�� NFPA 17, "Dry Chemical Extinguishing Systems,"

������������������������� i)�� NFPA 17A, "Wet Chemical Extinguishing Systems," or

������������������������� j)�� NFPA 18, "Wetting Agents."

������������ 2)�� Except as otherwise provided in this Section, where a special fire suppression system has been installed, inspection, testing and maintenance shall be provided in conformance with the appropriate standard listed in Sentence (1).

������������ 3)�� Where time intervals for maintenance and inspection are not specified in the appropriate standard in Sentence (1), inspection and maintenance routines shall be carried out at intervals not greater than 6 months.

6.8.1.2. Records

������������ 1)�� Written records shall be kept of all periodic tests carried out in conformance with Article 6.8.1.1., and such records shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

6.8.1.3. Instructions

������������ 1)�� Operating and maintenance instructions shall be posted in proximity to the equipment and shall be located near manual controls when such controls are provided.

6.8.1.4. Identification

������������ 1)�� Valves and controls shall be marked to clearly indicate their function and shall be accessible at all times.

6.8.1.5. Container Maintenance

������������ 1)�� Extinguishing agent containers provided for special fire suppression systems shall be fully charged with the proper quantity of extinguishing agent and the necessary operating pressure shall be maintained.

6.8.1.6. Discharge Outlets

������������ 1)�� Discharge outlets for special fire suppression systems shall be kept free of dirt and residue.

6.8.1.7. Piping

������������ 1)�� Piping and equipment shall be mechanically secure and accessible for cleaning and maintenance.

6.8.1.8. Replacement Equipment

������������ 1)�� Replacement equipment and devices provided for special fire suppression systems shall meet the original design criteria for the installation in which they are to be placed.

6.8.1.9. Change in Hazard

������������ 1)�� An increase in a hazard for which a special fire suppression system has been designed is not permitted unless the level of fire protection is increased commensurate with the increased hazard.

Part 7 ����� Fire Emergency Systems in High Buildings

Section 7.1. �� General

7.1.1. �� General

7.1.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� This Part provides for the inspection, testing and maintenance of the fire emergency systems installed in high buildings as defined in Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code.

7.1.1.2. Testing Fire Emergency Systems

������������ 1)�� Except as provided in Sentence (2), fire emergency systems required to be installed in buildings in conformance with Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code shall be tested in conformance with Sections 7.2. and 7.3.

������������ 2)�� Any fire emergency system required by Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code that does not conform to a specific measure outlined in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3) shall be tested to ensure that it operates as intended.

������������ 3)�� Deficiencies noted during the testing described in Sentences (1) and (2) shall be corrected.

7.1.1.3. Records

������������ 1)�� A written record shall be kept of all tests and corrective measures required by Article 7.1.1.2., and such record shall be retained for examination by the authority having jurisdiction, in conformance with Article 1.1.1.6.

7.1.1.4. Maintenance of Fire Emergency Systems

������������ 1)�� In addition to the requirements of Part 6, components of fire emergency systems shall be maintained in conformance with Sentences (2) to (5).

������������ 2)�� The keys required to recall elevators and to permit independent operation of each elevator shall be kept in the locations required by Subsection 3.2.6. of the British Columbia Building Code.

������������ 3)�� Access to windows and panels required to vent floor areas and vents to vestibules permitted to be manually openable shall be kept free of obstruction.

������������ 4)�� Windows and panels provided for venting floor areas shall be maintained so as to be openable without the use of keys.

������������ 5)�� Vents to vestibules permitted to be manually openable shall be maintained in an operable condition.

Section 7.2. �� Inspection, Testing and Maintenance

7.2.1. �� Intervals between Tests

7.2.1.1. Intervals between Tests

������������ 1)�� Except as specifically prescribed in this Part, all tests specified in this Section and Section 7.3. shall be carried out at intervals not greater than 3 months, except that longer intervals between tests are permitted in conformance with Part 1. (See Appendix A.)

7.2.2. �� Elevators

7.2.2.1. Testing Elevators

������������ 1)�� Emergency service features of elevators shall be tested to ensure that they operate in conformance with appropriate provincial, territorial or municipal requirements or, in the absence of such requirements, as provided in Sentence (2).

������������ 2)�� Tests to ensure operation in conformance with CAN/CSA-B44, "Safety Code for Elevators" shall be performed on

����������������������� a)�� in-car emergency service switches,

����������������������� b)�� manual key-operated recall switches located outside an elevator shaft and

����������������������� c)�� automatic emergency recall systems.

������������ 3)�� At intervals not greater than 12 months, the building emergency power systems shall be operated and all elevators supplied with emergency power shall be tested as provided in Sentence (1) with no other source of electrical power.

7.2.3. �� Venting to Aid Fire Fighting

7.2.3.1. Closures

������������ 1)�� The closures in vent openings into smoke shafts from each floor area shall be tested in conformance with Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that they will open as required in Chapter 3, Sentence (5) of Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3).

������������ 2)�� A closure in an opening to the outdoors at the top of a smoke shaft shall be tested to ensure that it will open

����������������������� a)�� manually from outside the building,

����������������������� b)�� on a signal from the smoke detector in the smoke shaft, and

����������������������� c)�� when a closure in an opening between a floor area and the smoke shaft opens.

7.2.3.2. Elevator Recall

������������ 1)�� In addition to the procedures described in Article 7.2.3.1., all elevators in an elevator shaft that is designed for use as a smoke shaft shall be tested to ensure that on activation of the fire alarm system they will return to the street floor level and remain inoperative.

7.2.3.3. Air-Handling System Controls

������������ 1)�� Controls for air-handling systems used for venting in the event of a fire shall be tested to ensure that air is exhausted from each floor area to the outdoors as required in Chapter 3, Sentence (8) of Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3).

7.2.4. �� Central Alarm and Control Facility

7.2.4.1. Fan Controls

������������ 1)�� Air moving fans in a system serving more than 2 storeys shall be tested to ensure that they will stop on activation of a switch at the central alarm and control facility.

7.2.4.2. Hold-Open Devices

������������ 1)�� Doors to vestibules that are normally held open by a hold-open device connected to the building fire alarm system shall be tested to ensure that they will close on a signal from the central alarm and control facility.

Section 7.3. �� Inspections and Test Procedures for Smoke Control Measures

7.3.1. �� General

7.3.1.1. Application

������������ 1)�� The test procedures described in Subsections 7.3.2. to 7.3.15., as appropriate to the fire safety measure being used, shall be carried out in addition to those required by Sections 7.1. and 7.2., unless otherwise specified in the fire safety plan. (See Appendix A.)

7.3.1.2. Doors in Means of Egress

������������ 1)�� Where vestibules or stairshafts are pressurized as a means of smoke control, all doors in the path of exit travel shall be tested to ensure that they can be operated as required in Article 2.7.2.1. when the entire smoke control system is being tested.

7.3.2. �� Measure A

7.3.2.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure A is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� closures to vent openings in verticle service spaces that are required by Sentence (6)*of Measure A open automatically and remain open, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� the mechanical air supply to below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentence (3)* of Measure A,

����������������������� b)�� closures in openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces that are required by Sentence (6)* of Measure A shall be tested to ensure that they will operate as required,

����������������������� c)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and will remain open as provided in Sentence (2)* of Measure A, and

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they will open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when air is being injected into the stairshaft.

7.3.3. �� Measure B

7.3.3.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure B is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� dampers in air-handling systems that serve more than 2 storeys close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (7)* of Measure B, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� closures to vent openings in verticle service spaces that are required by Sentences (5)* and (6)* of Measure B open automatically and remain open,

����������������������� b)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure B,

����������������������� c)�� closures in openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces that are required by Sentence (5) of Measure B shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that they will operate as required, and

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when air is being injected into the stairshaft as required by Sentence (3) of Measure B.

7.3.4. �� Measure C

7.3.4.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure C is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure C, and

����������������������� b)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when air is being injected into the stairshafts.

7.3.5. �� Measure D

7.3.5.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure D is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1.to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in vestibules, verticle service spaces and elevator shafts open automatically and remain open as provided in Sentences (6)*, (10)*, (12)* and (13)* of Measure D, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� dampers in air-handling systems that serve more than 2 storeys close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (16)* of Measure D,

����������������������� b)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to vestibules and below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentence (5) of Measure D,

����������������������� c)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces or at the top of elevator shafts as required by Sentences (10), (12) and (13) of Measure D shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that they will operate as required,

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts and at the street entrance floor of fire fighters' elevator shafts shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and remain open as provided in Sentences (7) and (11) of Measure D, and

����������������������� e)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically, if such means is provided, when air is being injected into the stairshafts as required by Sentence (8) of Measure D.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized vestibules shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or by tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that movement of air is from the vestibules to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.6. �� Measure E

7.3.6.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure E is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that closures in vent openings to the outdoors in vestibules and fire fighters' elevator shafts that are required by Sentences (4) and (9) of Measure E will open automatically and remain open,

����������������������� b)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to vestibules and below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (4) and (7) of Measure E,

����������������������� c)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors at the top of fire fighters' elevator shafts that are required by Sentence (9) of Measure E shall be tested to ensure that they will operate as required,

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts and at the street entrance floor of fire fighters' elevator shafts that are required by Sentences (6) and (10) of Measure E shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and will remain open, and

����������������������� e)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they will open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when air is being injected into the stairshafts as required by Sentence (7) of Measure E.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized vestibules shall be tested in different seasons by pressure sensor or by tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that movement of air is from the vestibules to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.7. �� Measure F

7.3.7.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure F is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� closures to vent openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces, elevator shafts and below grade floor areas that are required by Sentences (6)* and (10)* of Measure F open automatically and remain open, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� dampers in air-handling systems that serve more than 2 storeys close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (12)* of Measure F,

����������������������� b)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to stairshafts and elevator shafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (2), (3) and (4) of Measure F,

����������������������� c)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces or elevator shafts that are required by Sentence (12) of Measure F shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that they will operate as required, and

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when the mechanical air supply to the stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (2) and (3) of Measure F.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized stair and elevator shafts shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the stair or elevator shafts to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.8. �� Measure G

7.3.8.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� When Measure G is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade floor areas that are required by Sentence (6)* of Measure G open automatically and remain open, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� the mechanical air supply to stairshafts and elevator shafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (2),* (3)* and (4)* of Measure G, and

����������������������� b)�� closures in openings to the outdoors in stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically, if such means is provided, and remain open when the air supply to the stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (2) and (3) of Measure G.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized stair and elevator shafts shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the stair or elevator shafts to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.9. �� Measure H

7.3.9.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure H is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3), switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

����������������������� a)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors or into smoke shafts on each floor will open automatically and remain open as provided in Sentence (6) of Measure H,

����������������������� b)�� dampers in return air and exhaust ducts will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (5) of Measure H,

����������������������� c)�� return air and exhaust fans are stopped and supply fans will provide air to all floor areas and stairshafts as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure H, and

����������������������� d)�� closures in all openings in external walls and roofs will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (4) of Measure H.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized vestibules at or near grade level shall be tested by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke in different seasons at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, when the building is pressurized but without venting of the fire floor, to ensure that the direction of air movement is from the building to the outdoors.

7.3.10. �� Measure I

7.3.10.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure I is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3), switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

����������������������� a)�� dampers in air-handling systems that serve more than 2 storeys will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (8) of Measure I,

����������������������� b)�� closures in openings in the walls and roof of the central core and in shafts within the core will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure I,

����������������������� c)�� return air fans are stopped and supply fans will provide air to the central core as provided in Sentence (2) of Measure I,

����������������������� d)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors and into smoke shafts from each floor area will open automatically and remain open as provided in Sentence (4) of Measure I,

����������������������� e)�� air movement is initiated in an exhaust system used for venting as provided in Sentence (4) of Measure I, and

������������������������ f)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in verticle service spaces outside the central core that are required by Sentence (6) of Measure I will open automatically and remain open.

������������ 2)�� The pressurized core shall be tested at or near grade in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that movement of air is from the pressurized core to the outdoors on all storeys.

7.3.11. �� Measure J

7.3.11.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure J is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3), switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

����������������������� a)�� closures in openings in the walls and roofs of the central core and in shafts within the core will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure J, and

����������������������� b)�� return-air fans are stopped and supply fans will provide air to the central core as provided in Sentence (2) of Measure J.

������������ 2)�� The pressurized core shall be tested at or near grade in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the pressurized core to the outdoors on all storeys.

7.3.12. �� Measure K

7.3.12.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure K is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� the mechanical air supply to vestibules is initiated as provided in Sentences (11)* and (15)* of Measure K, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� doors to vestibules, if these are normally held open, will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (1)* of Measure K, and

����������������������� b)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts and in vented vestibules shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and will remain open as provided in Sentences (11) and (13) of Measure K.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized vestibules shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the vestibules to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.13. �� Measure L

7.3.13.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure L is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested at intervals conforming to Article 7.2.1.1. to ensure that

������������������������������������ i)��� doors to vestibules and areas of refuge, if these are normally held open, will close automatically and remain closed as provided in Sentence (8)* of Measure L, and

����������������������������������� ii)��� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in elevator shafts that are required by Sentence (16)* of Measure L will open automatically and remain open,

����������������������� b)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the air supply to the areas of refuge, vestibules and below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentences (9), (10), (11) and (14) of Measure L,

����������������������� c)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in below grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they open automatically and remain open when the air is being injected into the stairshaft, and

����������������������� d)�� vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts and at the street entrance floor of fire fighters' elevator shafts shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and will remain open as provided in Sentence (13) of Measure L.

������������ 2)�� Vestibules and areas of refuge shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the areas of refuge or vestibules to the floor areas on all storeys.

7.3.14. �� Measure M

7.3.14.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure M is used to limit smoke movement as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches at the central alarm and control facility shall be tested to ensure that the mechanical air supply to below grade stairshafts is initiated as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure M, and

����������������������� b)�� vent openings to the outdoors in above grade stairshafts shall be tested to ensure that they can be opened manually and will remain open as provided in Sentence (2) of Measure M.

7.3.15. �� Measure N

7.3.15.1. Test Procedures

������������ 1)�� Where Measure N is used to limit smoke movement from one building to another of connected buildings as provided in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3),

����������������������� a)�� switches to initiate the air supply to the vestibules shall be tested to ensure that the air supply is initiated as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure N, and

����������������������� b)�� closures in vent openings to the outdoors in vestibules shall be tested to ensure that they will open as provided in Sentence (3) of Measure N.

������������ 2)�� Pressurized vestibules shall be tested in different seasons by a pressure sensor or tracer smoke at intervals not greater than 2 years and after any alteration to the building, to ensure that the movement of air is from the vestibules to adjacent floor areas on all storeys.

���

* Sentence numbers refer to those contained in Commentary C of the User's Guide � NBC 1995 Fire Protection, Occupant Safety and Accessibility (Part 3).

Appendix A �Explanatory Material for the British Columbia Fire Code

The Appendix to this document is included for explanatory purposes only and does not form part of the requirements. The reference numbers that introduce each item apply to the requirements in the Code.

A-1.1.2.3.(1)

This requirement is intended as a means for the authority having jurisdiction to accept an arrangement, such as an existing building or fire protection system, that is not exactly identical to that required by the Code, but that is considered to provide an equivalent level of fire and life safety due to its specific qualities. This Code contains references to the British Columbia Building Code for the design, construction and installation of many fire protection features. Some BCBC requirements are most readily applied to new buildings and their retroactive application to existing situations as prescribed by this Code could result in some difficulty in achieving compliance. It is the intent of this Code that an equivalent level of safety be achieved rather than necessarily achieving strict conformance to the BCBC. The application of this Code to the upgrading of existing facilities should be based on the judgement of the enforcement authority, who must deal with each case on its merits. This Code states that the owner or the owner's authorized agent is responsible for carrying out the provisions of the Code. However, the owner is expected to communicate with the authority having jurisdiction, who is in a position to assess the relative significance of variances from the BCBC requirements. Such authority may then determine that upgrading measures are not necessary, on the basis that the existing arrangement represents an equivalent level of fire and life safety. This Code presumes that the adopting legislation provides for the exercise of the necessary discretionary judgement on the part of the enforcing officials, along with appropriate rights to appeal. See also Appendix Note A-2.1.3.1.(1).

Table A-1.1.3.2.

Documents Referenced in Appendix A of the
British Columbia Fire Code

Issuing Agency

Document Number

Title of Document

Code Reference

ACGIH

Industrial Ventilation: A Manual of Recommended Practice, 21st Edition

A-3.2.7.3.(1) (b)

API

2000-1992

Venting Atmospheric and Low-Pressure Storage Tanks

A-4.3.12.8.(1)

ASTM

5-95

Penetration of Bituminous Materials

A-4.1.3.1.

ASTM

D 3278-96

Flash Point of Liquids by Small Scale Closed-Cup Apparatus

A-4.1.3.1.

CCBFC

NRCC 38726

British Columbia Building Code

A-1.1.2.3.(1) A-1.2.1.2.(1) A-2.1.2.1.(1) A-2.1.3.1.(1) A-2.7.1.3.(1) A-2.7.1.4.(2) A-2.7.3.1.(1) A-2.9.3.5.(1) A-3.2.2.3.(6) A-3.2.7.9.(1) A-3.2.7.12.(3)A-4.1.7.1.(1) A-4.2.7.5.(2) A-6.1.1.2.(1)A-6.5.1.1.(1) A-6.5.1.7.(1)

CCBFC

NRCC 38728

National Plumbing Code of Canada 1995

A-4.1.6.2.(2)

CGAI

CGA P-1(1991)

Safe Handling of Compressed Gases in Containers

A-3.1.1.4.(1) (a)

CSA

C22.1-94

Canadian Electrical Code, Part 1

A-4.9.3.3.(1) A-5.1.2.1.(1)

CSA

PLUS 2203 HAZLOC-94

Hazardous Locations: A Guide for the Design, Construction and Installation of Electrical Equipment

A-4.1.4.1.(1)

FMEC

Data Sheet 7-50 (1989)

Compressed Gases in Cylinders

A-3.2.8.2.(2)

FMEC

Data Sheet 8-8 (1990)

Distilled Spirits Storage

A-3.2.3.3.(4)

HC

Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System (WHMIS) of the Hazardous Products Act

A-3.2.7.6.(2) A-3.2.7.13.(1)

HC

Consumer Chemicals and Containers Regulations of the Hazardous Products Act

A-3.2.5.2.(1)

HC

Controlled Products Regulations of the Hazardous Products Act

A-3.2.5.2.(1)

NFPA

Fire Protection Handbook, Seventeenth Edition

A-5.4.3.1.(4)

NFPA

13-1996

Installation of Sprinkler Systems

A-3.2.3.3.(4)A-6.5.1.1.(1) A-6.5.1.5.(1)

NFPA

14-1996

Installation of Standpipe and Hose Systems

A-6.4.1.6.(1)

NFPA

30-1996

Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code

A-4.1.1.1.(2)A-4.1.3.1. A-4.1.4.1.(1) A-4.2.7.7.(1)

NFPA

30B-1994

Manufacture and Storage of Aerosol Products

A-3.2.5.2.(1)

NFPA

33-1995

Spray Application Using Flammable and Combustible Materials

A-5.4.2.1.(3) and (4)

NFPA

36-1997

Solvent Extraction Plants

A-4.1.1.1.(2)

NFPA

49-1994

Hazardous Chemicals Data

A-6.2.2.1.(1)

NFPA

61-1995

Prevention of Fires and Dust Explosions in Agricultural and Food Products

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

65-1993

Processing and Finishing of Aluminum

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

91-1995

Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

120-1994

Coal Preparation Plants

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

231-1995

General Storage

A-3.2.1.1.(1) (a)A-3.2.2.4.(3) A-3.2.3.3.(4)

NFPA

480-1993

Storage, Handling and Processing of Magnesium

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

481-1995

Production, Processing, Handling and Storage of Titanium

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

482-1996

Production, Processing, Handling and Storage of Zirconium

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

497-1997

Classification of Flammable Liquids, Gases, or Vapours and of Hazardous (Classified) Locations for Electrical Installations in Chemical Process Areas

A-4.1.4.1.(1)

NFPA

650-1990

Pneumatic Conveying Systems for Handling Combustible Materials

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

651-1993

Manufacture of Aluminum and Magnesium Powder

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

654-1997

Prevention of Fires and Dust Explosions in the Chemical, Dye, Pharmaceutical and Plastics Industries

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

655-1993

Prevention of Sulfur Fires and Explosions

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

664-1993

Prevention of Fires and Explosions in Wood Processing and Woodworking Facilities

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA

701-1996

Fire Tests for Flame-Resistant Textiles and Films

A-2.3.2.2.(1)

OCIMF

Purchasing, Manufacturing and Testing of Loading and Discharge Hoses for Offshore Moorings, 4th Edition

A-4.7.8.1.(1) (a)

RMA

Hose Handbook, Fifth Edition

A-4.7.8.1.(1) (a)

TC

Transportation of Dangerous Goods Act (Canada) and its Regulations (TDGR)

A-3.2.7.6.(2) A-4.1.2.1.
Table A-4.1.2.1. A-4.2.2.3.(2)

TC

Oil Pollution Prevention Regulations of the Canada Shipping Act

A-4.7.8.1.(1) (a)

A-1.1.3.2.(2)

Documents referenced in this Appendix shall be the editions designated in Table A-1.1.3.2.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Exit.

Exits include doors or doorways leading directly into an exit stair or directly to the outside. In the case of an exit leading to a separate building, exits also include vestibules, walkways, bridges or balconies.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Fire separation.

A fire separation may or may not have a fire resistance rating.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Individual storage area.

The width of subsidiary aisles providing access to stored products within an individual storage area may be determined by material handling methods, or other criteria such as minimum width for access to exits or fire protection equipment.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Public Corridor.

A covered mall is considered to be a public corridor and, as such, is subject to the same requirements as a public corridor.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Service room.

Typical examples of service rooms include boiler rooms, furnace rooms, incinerator rooms, garbage handling rooms and rooms to accommodate air-conditioning or heating appliances, pumps, compressors and electrical equipment. Rooms such as elevator machine rooms and common laundry rooms are not considered to be service rooms.

A-1.2.1.2.(1) Suite.

Tenancy in the context of the term "suite" applies to both rental and ownership tenure. In a condominium arrangement, for example, dwelling units are considered separate suites even though they are individually owned. In order to be of complementary use, a series of rooms that constitute a suite are in reasonably close proximity to each other and have access to each other either directly by means of a common doorway or indirectly by a corridor, vestibule or other similar arrangement.

The term "suite" does not apply to rooms such as service rooms, common laundry rooms and common recreational rooms that are not leased or under a separate tenure in the context of the Code. Similarly, the term "suite" is not normally applied in the context of buildings such as schools and hospitals, since the entire building is under a single tenure. A rented room in a nursing home could be considered as a suite if the room was under a separate tenure. A hospital bedroom on the other hand is not considered to be under a separate tenure, since the patient has little control of that space, even though he pays the hospital a per diem rate for the privilege of using the hospital facilities, which include the sleeping areas.

For certain requirements in the British Columbia Building Code the expression "room or suite" is used (e.g., travel distance). This means that the requirement applies within the rooms of suites as well as to the suite itself and to rooms that may be located outside the suite. In other places the expression "suite, and rooms not located within a suite" is used (e.g., for the installation of smoke and heat detectors). This means that the requirement applies to individual suites as defined, but not to each room within the suite. The rooms "not within a suite" would include common laundry rooms, common recreational rooms and service rooms, that are not considered as tenant occupied space.

A-2.1.2.1.(1)

British Columbia Building Code introduced changes to the method of determining building height. Application of the current method to existing buildings for the purposes of this Code could result in certain buildings being reclassified as higher buildings. For this reason, the British Columbia Fire Code suggests that building height is that which was established by the building code that was applicable at the time of construction in the case of original construction, or at the time of alteration if additional storeys have been added to the building.

A-2.1.2.2.(1)

Arena-type buildings are often used for events such as community dances, rallies and trade shows. These events may increase the occupant and fuel loads beyond that for which the space was designed. To ensure safety during such events, additional egress facilities may be required to compensate for the additional occupant load and, in some cases, additional fire suppression measures may be required to compensate for the increased fuel load.

Large public corridors in mercantile occupancies are also used on a temporary basis for community activities, merchandising and for special displays. In these cases, additional egress facilities and fire suppression may be needed, depending on the increase in hazard.

A-2.1.3.1.(1)

The British Columbia Building Code is most often applied to existing buildings when an owner wishes to rehabilitate a building, change its use, or build an addition; or when an enforcement authority decrees that a building, or a class of buildings, be altered for reasons of public safety. It is not intended that either the BCBC or the British Columbia Fire Code be used to enforce the retrospective application of new requirements in the BCBC to existing buildings. Although the BCFC could be interpreted to require the installation of fire alarm, standpipe and hose and automatic sprinkler systems in an existing building for which there were no requirements before the British Columbia Building Code was issued, it is the intent of the Canadian Commission on Building and Fire Codes that the BCFC not be applied in this manner to these buildings.

It is usually difficult to change structural features of an existing building when undertaking alterations or additions, but installation of "active" fire protection systems, such as alarms, sprinklers and standpipes, in existing buildings may be possible. These systems may be considered as contributing to an adequate degree of life safety in cases where the structural features of a building do not conform to the BCBC.

Sentence 2.1.3.1.(1) is intended to address the installation of fire alarm, sprinkler and standpipe systems in existing buildings presently not so equipped, and in existing buildings that do not provide an acceptable level of safety to meet the current installation standards specified in the BCBC. It is not intended that existing fire protection systems that provide an acceptable level of life safety be upgraded with each new edition of the British Columbia Building Code or in conjunction with the inclusion of new requirements not in force at the time that a building was constructed. The authority having jurisdiction is expected to use discretion in enforcing this requirement. The authority having jurisdiction may accept alternatives to strict compliance with the BCBC as provided for in Sentence 1.1.2.3.(1) and as clarified in Appendix Note A-1.1.2.3.(1).

A-2.2.3.1.(1) Fire Door Signs

Signs should have letters and background in contrasting colours. The individual letters should be a minimum height of 6 mm.

A-2.3.2.2.(1)

The small scale match flame test in NFPA 701 is a relatively simple test that can be used to assess the condition of flame retardant treatments on samples from fabrics that have been in use for a while. It is not intended that NFPA 701 be used as the primary standard for application of fire retardant treatments.

A-2.4.1.1.(1)

Accumulation of a certain amount of combustible waste material in and around buildings may be necessary for the day-to-day operation of many industrial or commercial premises. If basic measures of good housekeeping are observed, the presence of these combustibles may not constitute an "undue fire hazard."

A-2.4.1.1.(2)

The defined term "service rooms" includes boiler rooms, furnace rooms, incinerator rooms, garbage rooms, janitors' closets and rooms to accommodate air-conditioning or heating appliances, pumps, compressors and electrical services. The intent of Sentence 2.4.1.1.(2) is to discourage the use of these rooms for storage of miscellaneous combustible materials. If storage space is needed in a building, a room that does not contain building service equipment should be provided. Even in garbage rooms, combustible materials should not be allowed to accumulate. When the garbage is periodically cleared from the room, the room should be empty, except for the garbage container itself.

A-2.4.5.1.(1)

Measures which can be considered to limit fire spread include sufficient clear space between the fire and adjacent buildings, combustibles and woodlands, the size and height of the pile of combustibles to be burned, prevailing meteorological conditions, fire control measures such as hoses and water tanks and, if a receptacle is to be used, the design of the receptacle. In some cases, a permit or licence may be required for open-air fires.

A-2.4.6.1.(1)

Vacant buildings frequently become the target of vandalism and arson. They should be locked, and accessible windows and doors should be barricaded to prevent unauthorized entry. However, fire department access to the interior of the building in the event of a fire should not be made unduly difficult.

A-2.6.1.4.(1)

External inspection of enclosed chimneys and surrounding construction may require the installation of one or more access openings in the enclosure surrounding the chimney. The presence of scorched or charred adjacent combustible construction will indicate the need for further investigation of the cause of the overheating.

Internal inspection of chimneys can be accomplished by lowering a light from the top, insertion of a light at the bottom or at intermediate locations, together with the use of one or more mirrors.

During inspection of a chimney connected to an operating appliance, the presence of dense smoke at the outlet will indicate improper operation of the appliance, incorrect sizing of the chimney or the use of unsuitable fuels. These factors must be corrected promptly to reduce accumulation of combustible deposits on the chimney and flue pipe walls.

A-2.6.1.4.(2)

The presence in a chimney of deposits of soot or creosote in excess of 3 mm thick will indicate the need for immediate cleaning, possible modification of burning procedures, and more frequent inspections.

A-2.6.1.4.(3)(a)

Structural deficiencies are deviations from required construction, such as the absence of a liner or inadequate design of supports or ties. Instances of decay are cracking, settling, crumbling mortar, distortion, advanced corrosion, separation of sections, or loose or broken supports.

A-2.6.1.9.(3)

Depending on the amount of cooking equipment usage, the entire exhaust system, including grease extractors, should be inspected at intervals not greater than 7 days to determine if grease or other residues have been deposited within. When grease or other residues are in evidence as deposits within the hood, grease removal devices, or ducts, the system should be cleaned. In general, exhaust systems should be cleaned at intervals not greater than 12 months, but in the case of deep fat cooking, char broiling or similar cooking operations, the systems should be cleaned at intervals not greater than 3 months.

A-2.7.1.3.(3)

Table 3.1.16.1. in the British Columbia Building Code is intended to allow a building designer to calculate an occupant load for the purpose of designing certain building features, such as means of egress and fire alarm systems. The designer may choose to design for more or fewer persons than specified in Table 3.1.16.1., in which case the actual design occupant load must be permanently posted in a conspicuous location.

In existing buildings the maximum permissible occupant load is intended to ensure the safe use of rooms or spaces, and may be used as an enforcement measure to control the number of people in a building. The British Columbia Fire Code requires signs to be posted to indicate the maximum permissible occupant load for floor areas, either calculated in accordance with the British Columbia Building Code or the British Columbia Fire Code, where there is no previously determined occupant load available.

There are two criteria used in the British Columbia Fire Code to determine occupant load when there is no previously determined occupant load established by the British Columbia Building Code. The Fire Code determines the maximum permissible occupant load to be the lesser of either the number of persons for which means of egress are provided or the number of persons permitted based on the type of use as determined from Table 2.7.1.3.

Table 2.7.1.3. allows for the various furnishings and fixtures associated with different types of use, which may change according to the nature of functions being held. In certain assembly occupancies it may be appropriate to calculate multiple maximum occupant loads for the different functions anticipated.

It should also be noted that Article 2.1.3.1. of this Code requires fire alarm systems to be installed in conformance with the British Columbia Building Code. This means that if the occupant load determined by Article 2.7.1.3. exceeds that for which a fire alarm system is required by the British Columbia Building Code, a fire alarm system must be provided in the building.

A-2.7.1.4.(2)

Sentence 3.1.16.1.(2) in the British Columbia Building Coderequires that the occupant load used in the design of a floor area be posted if it differs from that determined by Table 3.1.16.1.

A-2.7.3.1.(1)

Subsections 3.2.7. and 3.4.5. in the NBC describe the requirements for placement of exit signs, and emergency and non-emergency lighting requirements.

A-2.8.1.2.(1)

Adequately trained supervisory staff can be of great value in directing people to move in an orderly fashion in the event of a fire and in carrying out appropriate fire control measures until the public fire department arrives. These measures are, as described in the fire safety plan, developed in cooperation with the fire department. The supervisory staff referred to in this Section are assigned their responsibilities by the building owner, unless the public fire department is prepared to take on these responsibilities. Except in hospitals and nursing homes, it is not intended that supervisory staff should be in the building on a continuous basis, but that they should be available to fulfill their obligations as described in the fire safety plan on notification of a fire emergency. In hospitals and nursing homes, however, staff must be in the building at all times to assist occupants who are not capable of caring for themselves in an emergency.

A-2.8.2.1.(1)

The fire safety plan may provide important information to the fire department for use in preparation of pre-fire plans for fire fighting procedures in specific buildings. This is especially true for buildings where flammable or combustible liquids or other dangerous goods are stored.

A-2.8.2.1.(1)(a)(i)

These procedures should also include training of authorized personnel for silencing fire alarm and alert signals under specified conditions. If special keys or devices are required to operate the alarm system, they should be readily available to supervisory staff on duty.

A-2.8.2.1.(1)(a)(iv)

Some occupants of a building may require special assistance during evacuation because cognitive or physical limitations make them unable to proceed independently to a place of safety. Fire safety for these persons will depend to a large extent on preplanning and on their awareness of the fire protection measures incorporated into the building. In some buildings, it may be appropriate to advise such occupants of these provisions by posted notices, handouts or other suitable means. In certain residential occupancies, such as hotels or motels, staff should be aware of rooms occupied by persons requiring special assistance during evacuation and should inform the responding fire department.

A-2.8.3.1.(1)

A fire safety plan is of little value if it is not reviewed periodically so that all supervisory staff remain familiar with their responsibilities. A fire drill, then, is at least a review of the fire safety plan by supervisory staff. The extent to which non-supervisory staff participate in a fire drill should be worked out in cooperation with the fire department. The decision as to whether all occupants should leave the building during a fire drill should be based on the nature of the occupancy.

It may be necessary to hold additional fire drills outside normal working hours for the benefit of employees on afternoon or night shifts, who should be as familiar with fire drill procedures as those who work during the day. If full scale fire drills are not possible during non-regular working hours, arrangements should be made so that night-shift supervisory staff can participate in fire drills conducted during the daytime.

A-2.9.3.5.(1)

The type of fire alarm and emergency communication system anticipated for tents and air-supported structures will vary according to the hazard and the number of occupants. If a tent or air-supported structure is to be permanent, a fire alarm and emergency communication system, as defined in the British Columbia Building Code, may be required. If such structures are to be temporary, however, a somewhat less sophisticated system is anticipated, depending on local conditions.

A-2.14.1.1.(2)

In demolition operations in certain buildings which do not pose an exposure hazard to other buildings, or in which there is little fire hazard to occupants, as in small buildings, the degree of application of this Section may be minimal. The degree of application should be determined in advance in conjunction with the authority having jurisdiction.

Construction projects can range from large multi-storey buildings to small single-storey residences and may include additions or renovations to existing buildings. The degree to which this Section should apply to each project should be determined in advance, as part of the fire safety plan for the construction project, taking into consideration such issues as the size of the project and the site conditions.

A-2.14.1.2.(2)(c)

The control of fire hazards in and around buildings also includes fire protection for combustible construction materials and combustible refuse on the site. The sizes of piles of materials and refuse and the location of such piles in relation to adjacent buildings are factors which should be considered in determining which fire protection measures should be employed. The selection of fire protection measures for demolition operations should also recognize the demolition procedure being used, the specific conditions existing on the site and the fire fighting capabilities of the responding fire department.

A-2.14.1.2.(2)(d)

When demolition operations are in progress in a building of combustible construction, an effort should be made to retain any sprinkler systems in operation as long as possible, to ensure added protection for the structure and the surrounding buildings.

A-3.1.1.4.(1)(a)

For purposes of this exemption, a distributor is deemed to be a commercial enterprise regularly handling or storing more than 1 500 kg of Class 2 gases for purposes of resale. Such distributors are expected to follow the same good engineering practices as their suppliers. The document CGA P-1, "Safe Handling of Compressed Gases in Containers," published by The Compressed Gas Association Incorporated, represents good engineering practice for the handling of Class 2 gases.

A-3.1.2.3.(2)

The International Maritime Organization, the International Civil Aviation Organization, the United Nations and Transport Canada are examples of regulatory authorities that may establish standards for the design and construction of packages and containers for dangerous goods.

A-3.1.2.4.(2)(a)

Methods of preventing valve damage include the use of valve caps, storage in crates (for small cylinders) and the provision of steel rings or protective handles. Certain high pressure cylinders are required by other legislation to be equipped with valve caps.

A-3.1.2.5.(1)

Reactive substances may include various classes of unstable or reactive dangerous goods, such as Class 4 flammable solids, Class 5 oxidizing substances or unstable Class 2 gases.

A-3.2.1.1.(1)

Section 3.2. applies to all parts of buildings, including warehousing or storage areas, manufacturing areas, shipping and receiving areas, and sales areas. It does not apply to the storage of unpackaged grain or coal. Additional requirements in Part 5 of this Code address the dust hazard associated with bulk grain or coal storage.

A-3.2.1.1.(1)(a)

Chapter 2 of NFPA 231, "General Storage," gives an extensive description with numerous examples of commodities for classification purposes and should be consulted. The following is a brief overview of the NFPA 231 classification of commodities:

A Class I commodity is defined as essentially non-combustible products in ordinary corrugated cartons or in ordinary paper wrappings, with or without combustible pallets.

A Class II commodity is defined as Class I products in slatted wooden crates, solid wooden boxes, multiple thickness paperboard cartons or equivalent combustible packaging material, with or without combustible pallets.

A Class III commodity is defined as wood, paper, natural fiber, cloth, or Group C plastics, with or without combustible pallets. Products may contain a limited amount of Group A or B plastics.

A Class IV commodity is defined as Class I, II, or III products in corrugated cartons, containing an appreciable amount of Group A plastics or with Group A plastics packaging, with or without combustible pallets. Group B plastics and free-flowing Group A plastics are also included in this class.

Group A plastics include, but are not limited to, ABS, acrylic, butyl rubber, fiberglass reinforced polyester, natural rubber (if expanded), nitrile rubber, polycarbonate, polyester elastomer, polyethylene, polypropylene, polystyrene, polyurethane, highly plasticized PVC, and SBR.

Group B plastics include, but are not limited to, cellulosics, fluoroplastics, natural rubber (not expanded), nylon, and silicone rubber.

Group C plastics include, but are not limited to, fluoroplastics, melamine, phenolic resins, rigid PVC, and urea formaldehyde.

A-3.2.2.2.

The purpose of this Article is to provide adequate access to the interior of the storage area for fire fighting and overhaul operations. Means of egress must also be provided in accordance with Section 2.7. of the British Columbia Fire Code. The use of dead-end aisles in storage areas should be minimized because of the potential hazard they create with respect to egress. Access aisles required in Sentence (2) include aisles to fire department access panels, or to fire protection equipment such as sprinkler control valves, fire hose stations, portable extinguishers and fire alarm pull stations.

Sentences (4) to (8) prescribe requirements for main access aisles in the storage area. More than one main access aisle may be required depending on the storage configuration and alternate arrangements to a single main access aisle are permitted in Sentence (7). These requirements are in addition to the general requirement for 2.4 m aisles separating individual storage areas. The width of subsidiary aisles within individual storage areas is determined by material handling needs.

Fire department access to a storage area can be by means of doors or access panels on exterior walls, or through doors from another fire compartment in the building, provided that fire compartment in turn has adequate fire department access. The access points should be as remote from each other as possible. Where practicable, the preferred arrangement is for main aisles to terminate at exterior doors on opposite sides of the building.

Where stored products are liable to expand with the absorption of water, there exists a significant danger of collapse of the products into the aisles. It does not matter whether the products are in racks or not, nor whether the water comes from hose streams or sprinklers. Examples of such products include certain paper products and baled rags. Numerous fire fighters have been killed through being crushed by falling products, or through being trapped after their escape routes have become blocked by fallen products. Special consideration should be given in these cases to rack design, aisle widths and layout to prevent such hazards or to minimize their effect.

A-3.2.2.3.(3)

In unsprinklered buildings, a clear space is required above the storage to permit hose streams to be directed onto the top of storage.

A-3.2.2.3.(6)

Clearance between stored products and heating equipment must also be maintained in conformance with Section 2.6. of the British Columbia Fire Code, which references Part 6 of the British Columbia Building Code for installation requirements for heating systems. All stored combustible materials should be kept away from hot elements of heating equipment.

A-3.2.2.4.(3)

Section 4-4 of NFPA 231, "General Storage" gives sprinkler system design criteria for areas where combustible pallets are stored, based on the height, area and type of pallets.

A-3.2.3.2.(2)

For self-contained, multi-tiered structural rack or shelf systems, the storage height should be determined as the height from the lowest floor level to the top of storage on the uppermost tier.

A-3.2.3.3.(4)

NFPA 13 and NFPA 231 do not provide sufficient information on design of sprinkler systems in buildings used for the storage of closed containers of distilled beverage alcohol. Design criteria representing good engineering practice for such sprinkler systems are available in such documents as Data Sheet 8-8, "Distilled Spirits Storage" published by Factory Mutual Engineering Corporation.

A-3.2.4.2.(1)

The volume of tires in a storage area can be determined by measuring to the nearest 0.1 m the length, width and height of the piles or racks intended to contain the tires. In racks, the top shelf is assumed to be loaded to maximum possible height, while observing required clearances between structural elements and sprinklers.

A-3.2.5.1.(1)

Aerosol products that are displayed in mercantile occupancies represent a lower hazard and do not require specific storage limits or additional fire protection provided they have been removed from their combustible cartons or cartons have been display-cut so that only the bottom and the lowest 50 mm of the side panels is retained. The storage of packaged aerosols in mercantile occupancies shall nevertheless conform to this Subsection.

A-3.2.5.2.(1)

This Code has adopted the aerosol classification system developed by the National Fire Protection Association in NFPA 30B, "Manufacture and Storage of Aerosol Products."

Examples of Level 1 aerosol products include shaving cream, spray starch, window cleaners, alkaline oven cleaners, rug shampoos, some air fresheners and some insecticides. These aerosols are less hazardous than Level 2 or Level 3 aerosols, and represent a storage hazard comparable to Class III commodities.

Examples of Level 2 water-miscible flammable base aerosol products include most personal care products such as deodorants (except for oil-based antiperspirants), and hair sprays. They may also include antiseptics and anesthetics, some furniture polishes and windshield de-icers. Level 2 aerosols are less hazardous than Level 3 aerosols.

Examples of Level 3 aerosol products include some automotive products such as engine and carburetor cleaners, undercoats and lubricants; some wood polishes, paints and lacquers; some insecticides; and oil based antiperspirants.

In Canada, some aerosol products are required by the "Controlled Products Regulations," the "Consumer Chemicals and Containers Regulations" and certain other legislation, to bear flammability hazard symbols. The nature of the symbol on the can is determined on the basis of a flame projection test, which measures the susceptibility of the aerosol spray to ignite; this is most important for protecting consumers who, for example, might be smoking while using an aerosol product. A direct comparison between the flammability hazard symbols used in Canadian regulations and the NFPA Level 1, 2 or 3 classification system used in the British Columbia Fire Code is not reliable as the latter measures the overall contribution of flammable base product, combined with flammable gas propellant, to the rate of growth and severity of a fire involving a substantial number of aerosols.

A-3.2.7.3.(1)(b)

Part 4 of the British Columbia Fire Code specifies ventilation rates to prevent the buildup of dangerous concentrations of flammable vapours in rooms used for storing flammable and combustible liquids. The same principles should apply to dangerous goods capable of releasing toxic gases, or where the accidental mixing of incompatible substances could generate flammable vapours or toxic gases. Where no guidance is given, the design of the ventilation system should conform to good engineering practice. Recommendations in the National Fire Protection Association standards, or in the document "Industrial Ventilation: A Manual of Recommended Practice," produced by the American Conference of Governmental Industrial Hygienists, would be considered examples of good engineering practice.

A-3.2.7.6.(2)

It is assumed that Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDS) will in many cases be provided as part of the documentation for the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations," or the "Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System."

The following are examples of basic principles that should apply to any storage situation involving dangerous goods:

��������������� �� Chemicals should not be stored using an alphabetical sequence system but should be grouped according to compatibility.

��������������� �� Organic materials should not be stored with either strong acids or oxidizers.

��������������� �� Alkalis should not be stored with strong acids or chlorinated hydrocarbons.

��������������� �� Strong acids should not be stored with oxidizers.

��������������� �� Sulphites, bisulphites and sulphides should not be stored with acids.

Poisonous chemicals should not be stored together on the basis that they are poisons, but rather on the basis of compatibility. As with the storage of all chemicals, the primary consideration is what might happen in the event of a mishap causing them to be mixed. For instance, the following are all classified as Class 6.1 poisonous substances but will cause serious problems when mixed in the presence of water (such as water used for fire fighting purposes):

��������������� �� Sodium azide + dimethyl sulphate = explosion;

��������������� �� Sodium cyanide + anhydrous chloral = highly toxic vapour cloud.

Poisonous substances should not be stored in the vicinity of chemicals that are designated as B.P., B.P.C., U.S.P., F.C.C. and N.F. grades. Many of these chemicals find their way into cosmetics, pharmaceutical drugs and foodstuffs. A spill of poisonous substance would not only cause contamination of the product itself, but also of the outside of the container and of the clean room in which they are processed.

A-3.2.7.9.(1)

So many types, quantities, and concentrations of dangerous goods could be present in a building that setting maximum quantities allowed in unprotected buildings is very difficult. The hazard presented by the dangerous goods is not necessarily a function of their inherent flammability, but rather a function of their potential for hampering fire fighting. If the area involved in dangerous goods storage is large enough, the owner must provide some degree of built-in automatic fire suppression for the building. Therefore, the point at which installation of an active fire suppression system becomes mandatory is based on the total area involved in dangerous goods storage, regardless of the product stored.

The active fire suppression system intended is a sprinkler system, installed throughout the building, not just in the area of dangerous goods storage. The objective is to control both a fire originating in a spot remote from the dangerous goods, so that it never threatens the dangerous goods, and a fire involving the dangerous goods themselves. Even if a fire originates in a dangerous good on which water should not be applied (stored pesticides for example), sprinklers may provide better control than alternative fire fighting measures. A sprinkler system should control the fire, limit its spread, and minimize the number of containers that fail. The sprinkler alarm will notify responsible persons who can take corrective action while the fire is small. The amount of water applied to the pesticide by the sprinklers will be small in comparison to what will have to be applied by hose streams once the fire is established.

Article 6.5.1.1. in the British Columbia Fire Code refers to the British Columbia Building Code, which sets the basic criteria for sprinkler systems. These criteria may not be appropriate for specific dangerous goods. For example, water may not be the best extinguishing agent to use on a particular product. In such cases, special arrangements may be required, such as isolating that product in an unsprinklered room protected by a fixed fire suppression system conforming to Article 6.8.1.1.

It is assumed that the fire suppression system will be designed by persons experienced in such design, using good engineering practice to establish design criteria, such as type of suppressant to use, and rate of application.

A-3.2.7.10.(1)

Venting of smoke and other products of combustion can be achieved by opening roof vents, breaking skylights, removing panels or opening windows. Smoke and hot gases should be vented directly to the outside.

A-3.2.7.12.(2)

Access to at least 2 sides of a building used for storage of dangerous goods is required so that, if necessary, fire fighting operations can be set up on the upwind side of the building, to minimize the adverse effects of toxic smoke.

A-3.2.7.12.(3)

Protective clothing worn by fire fighters in a fire involving dangerous goods is bulkier than the usual fire fighting turn-out gear. Therefore, Sentence 3.2.7.12.(3) requires access openings into buildings used for the storage of dangerous goods to be wider than otherwise required by the British Columbia Building Code.

A-3.2.7.13.(1)

Fire fighters need to identify the substances they may encounter in a building during a fire. Labelling of products to comply with the "Workplace Hazardous Materials Information System" (WHMIS) or other provincial, territorial or federal legislation is deemed to satisfy this requirement.

A-3.2.7.14.(1)

One or more placards at the door into a room used for storage of dangerous goods are required to inform fire fighters that dangerous goods are contained within. In larger storage areas containing a variety of dangerous goods in different individual storage areas, each individual storage area should have placards.

A-3.2.8.2.(1)(d)

When a flammable mixture of air and vapour/gas/dust is ignited and causes an explosion, the exothermic reaction results in the rapid expansion of heated gases and the corresponding pressure waves travel through the mixture at sonic or supersonic velocities. The pressures developed by an explosion very rapidly reach levels that most buildings and equipment cannot withstand unless specifically designed to do so. Explosion venting consists of devices designed to open at a predetermined pressure to relieve internal pressure buildup inside a room or enclosure, hence limiting the structural and mechanical damage.

The major parameters to be considered in designing an explosion venting system for a building are:

��������������� �� the physical and chemical properties of the flammable air mixture, such as the particle size or the droplet diameter, the moisture content, the minimum ignition temperature and explosive concentration, the burning velocity or explosibility classification, the maximum explosion pressure and the rate of pressure rise,

��������������� �� the concentration and dispersion of the flammable mixture in the room,

��������������� �� the turbulence and physical obstructions in the room,

��������������� �� the size and shape of the room, the type of construction and its ability to withstand internal pressures, and

��������������� �� the type, size and location of relief panels.

A-3.2.8.2.(2)

The following Table gives the specific volume (m3/kg) of some common gases at normal temperature and pressure. This information is available from manufacturer's literature and can be used to convert gas weight (kg) into gas expanded volume (m3), and vice versa. Cylinder data for industrial gases can also be found in Data Sheet 7-50, "Compressed Gases in Cylinders," published by Factory Mutual Engineering Corporation.

A-3.2.9.3.(1)

The purpose of this requirement is to prevent the storage of ammonium nitrate in facilities which contain a space below the floor where molten ammonium nitrate could pool in the event of a fire.

A-3.2.9.3.(2)

Copper or its alloys should not be used where they can come in contact with ammonium nitrate as they can react with it to form potentially explosive mixtures.

A-3.3.1.1.(1)(d)

Hogged material can be described as mill waste consisting mainly of hogged bark but may include a mixture of bark, chips, dust, or other by-products from trees. This also includes material designated as hogged fuel.

Table A-3.2.8.2.

Specific Volume of Common Gases

Gas

Specific Volume (m3/kg)

Acetylene

0.9

Ammonia, anhydrous

1.4

Arsine

0.3

Butane

0.4

Carbon dioxide

0.5

Chlorine

0.3

Ethylene oxide

0.5

Fluorine

0.6

Hydrogen

12.0

Methane

1.5

Methyl acetylene

0.6

Methyl chloride

0.5

Nitrogen

0.9

Oxygen

0.8

Phosphine

0.7

Propane

0.5

Propylene

0.6

A-3.3.1.1.(1)(e)

Factory-assembled combustible structures, such as mobile or modular homes and office trailers, that are transportable in one or more sections, are designated as manufactured buildings in this Section.

A-3.3.1.1.(2)(c)

An intermodal shipping container can be described as a standard sized reusable structure into which commodities are packed and designed to be used in more than one mode of transportation.

A-3.3.1.1.(2)(g)

Treated forest products are those which have been coated or impregnated with flammable or combustible liquids. Ranked piles are typically piles of logs evenly arranged by conveyor, crane or other means.

A-3.3.2.6.(2)

The width and location of gates in a fire department access route should take into account the connection with public thoroughfares, width of the roadway, radius of curves, and the type and size of fire department vehicles available in the municipality or area where the storage site is located. Padlocks that can be forced and replaced are preferred by fire departments for easy access to the storage site.

A-3.3.3.2.(1)

Where the adjoining property is land which may be built upon or used for storage, it is intended that the required clearance be maintained between the stored products and the property line. If the adjoining property does not present a fire exposure hazard, such as a street, right of way, watercourse, or park land, the required clearance could be beyond the property line. In all cases, care should be taken that the storage close to the property line does not defeat the purpose of other safety measures prescribed in this Code.

A-4.1.1.1.(1)

The all-inclusive phrase "buildings, structures and open areas" includes but is not limited to tank farms, bulk plants, fuel dispensing stations, industrial plants, refineries, process plants, distilleries, and piers, wharves and airports that are not subject to over-riding federal control. Part 4 of the British Columbia Fire Code applies wherever flammable or combustible liquids are used or stored, except as specifically exempted in Sentences 4.1.1.1.(2) and (3).

A-4.1.1.1.(2)

Certain areas in refineries, chemical plants and distilleries will not meet all Code requirements because of extraordinary conditions. Design should be based on good engineering practice and on such factors as manual fire suppression equipment, daily inspections, automated transfer systems, location of processing units, and special containment systems, piping, controls and materials used. NFPA 30, "Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code" and NFPA 36, "Solvent Extraction Plants" are examples of good engineering practice and can be referred to by the designer and the authority having jurisdiction.

A-4.1.2.1.

The classification system for flammable liquids used by the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations" (TDGR) differs from the NFPA classification system used in the British Columbia Fire Code. In the British Columbia Fire Code, only liquids with a flash point below 37.8�C are referred to as "flammable" liquids, whereas liquids having flash points at or above 37.8 �C are "combustible" liquids. In contrast, the TDGR, which regulate "flammable liquids" as Class 3 Dangerous Goods, define "flammable liquids" as liquids having a flash point below 61�C. Therefore, the TDGR term "flammable liquids" includes Class II liquids (with a maximum flash point of 60�C), which are referred to as "combustible liquids" in the NFC terminology. The TDGR do not include Class IIIA liquids that have a flash point above 60�C.

The TDGR further classify flammable liquids into Divisions 1, 2, and 3, depending on their flash points. Division 1 flammable liquids have flash points below - 18�C; Division 2 flammable liquids have flash points at or above - 18�C but below 23�C; and Division 3 flammable liquids have flash points at or above 23�C but below 61�C. For the purpose of comparing the TDGR classification system with the British Columbia Fire Code system, the differences between 23�C and 22.8�C, and between 61�C and 60�C may be ignored. The results of closed-cup flash point tests may vary by as much as 1�C, so nothing is gained by unnecessary precision. The following table compares the two classification systems.

Table A-4.1.2.1

Comparison of BCFC and TDGR Classification Systems

Flash Point,
�C

Boiling Point, �C

NFC Classification

TDGR Classification

below - 18

N/A

IA

3.1

at or above - 18 and below 22.8 (1)

below 37.8

IA

3.2

below 22.8

at or above 37.8

IB

3.2

at or above 22.8 and below 37.8

N/A

IC

3.3

at or above 37.8 and below 60 (2)

N/A

II

3.3

at or above 60 and below 93.3

N/A

IIIA

Not Regulated

at or above 93.3

N/A

Not Regulated

Not Regulated

Notes to Table A-4.1.2.1.:

��� (1)�� For purposes of comparison, 22.8�C is deemed to be equivalent to 23�C, as used in the TDGR.

��� (2)�� 60�C is deemed to be equivalent to 61�C, as used in the TDGR.

A-4.1.2.1.(3)(b)

The NFPA classification system for flammable and combustible liquids includes Class IIIB liquids, which have flash points at or above 93.3�C. These liquids are not regulated by Part 4 of the British Columbia Fire Code because they are deemed to represent no greater fire hazard than other combustibles, such as wood or paper products. However, Article 4.1.2.2. clarifies that such liquids are effectively Class I liquids when heated to their flash point temperature.

A-4.1.2.3.

Used automotive lubricating oil may contain both oil and more volatile Class I liquids, such as gasoline. Tests of representative samples have demonstrated that the flash point of such used oil consistently exceeds 60�C, with an average above 93.3�C. When Class I or II liquids are added to such used oil, the flash point of the resulting mixture will vary with the percentage and flammability of the contaminating liquid and shall be determined by tests.

A-4.1.3.1.

The kinematic viscosity of a liquid influences the choice of test most appropriate for measuring its flash point. For measurement of kinematic viscosity, the ASTM standards referenced use units of centistokes, or stokes. In Canada, the unit used for kinematic viscosity is mm2/s (cgs), not stokes or centistokes. One centistoke has units of 1 millimetre squared per second (1 mm2/s).

For purposes of comparison, the kinematic viscosity of water is 1.0038 mm2/s at 20�C; of glycerine, approximately 1 185 mm2/s; and of some common motor oils, near 1 000 mm2/s. Some paints, lacquers and glues have much higher kinematic viscosities, as indicated by the upper limit of 15 000 mm2/s in ASTM D 3278.

The viscosity at which a liquid should no longer be treated as a liquid is addressed in NFPA 30, "Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code." The definition of "liquid" in that document states that "any material that has a fluidity greater than that of 300 penetration asphalt, when tested in accordance with ASTM D 5, "Penetration for Bituminous Materials," is considered to be a liquid.

A-4.1.4.1.(1)

Additional information on determining the extent of Division 1 or 2 zones in Class I locations can be found in CSA PLUS 2203 HAZLOC, "Hazardous Locations: A Guide for the Design, Construction and Installation of Electrical Equipment," in NFPA 30, "Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code," and in NFPA 497A, "Classification of Flammable Liquids, Gases, or Vapours and of Hazardous (Classified) Locations for Electrical Installations in Chemical Process Areas."

A-4.1.5.3.(1)

Sources of ignition include, but are not limited to, open flames, smoking, cutting and welding, hot surfaces, frictional heat, static, electrical and mechanical sparks, spontaneous ignition, heat producing chemical reactions, and radiant heat.

A-4.1.5.9.

Limited quantities of Class I liquids are permitted to be stored or used in basements where it is clear that they do not create a fire hazard. Such factors as the size of basement, ventilation, wiring, and proximity to sources of ignition should be taken into account in determining whether an unsafe condition exists.

A-4.1.6.1.(1)

Measures for control of spills include provision of manhole or catch basin covers for manual closing, and provision of absorbent materials and portable containment dikes. The containment measures should provide sufficient capacity to retain all of the product likely to be spilled, plus the water used for fire fighting purposes. The fire safety plan should include measures for responding to a situation where the containment area could be overtopped.

A-4.1.6.2.(2)

The1998 British Columbia Plumbing Code defines a trap as a fitting or device that is designed to hold a liquid seal that will prevent the passage of gas but will not materially affect the flow of a liquid.

A-4.1.7.1.(1)

Article 3.3.1.19. in the British Columbia Building Code specifies that ventilation must be provided in conformance with Part 6 of that Code if flammable vapour, gas, or dust could create a fire or explosion hazard. However, Part 6 of the British Columbia Building Code does not provide specific information on the design of ventilation systems to prevent an accumulation of dangerous concentrations of flammable vapours. It refers instead to "good engineering practice" and directs the user to a number of NFPA standards for examples of good practice, depending on the nature of the vapours or dusts. Subsection 4.1.7. of the British Columbia Fire Code represents a minimum level of "good practice" for preventing an accumulation of explosive concentrations of vapours from flammable or combustible liquids.

A-4.1.7.2.(3)

Natural ventilation is normally adequate for the storage of flammable liquids and combustible liquids, or the dispensing of Class II and IIIA liquids. Such ventilation should consist of permanent openings at ceiling and floor levels leading to the outside. At least 0.1 m2 each of free inlet and outlet openings per 50 m2 of floor area should be provided. A mechanical ventilation rate of at least 18 m3/h per square metre of floor area, but not less than 250 m3/h, is normally adequate for rooms with low floor to ceiling height or small enclosed spaces where Class I liquids are dispensed. Ventilation for process areas must be designed to suit the nature of the hazard in accordance with good engineering practice.

A-4.1.8.2.(1)(b)

Build-up of static electric charges near the surface of liquids being poured into non-conducting containers can be controlled or eliminated by: limiting the filling rate to velocities less than 1 m/s, using a grounded lance or nozzle extension to the bottom of the container, limiting free fall, or using antistatic additives.

A-4.1.8.2.(3)(b)

It is generally considered that liquids with a conductivity greater than 50 pS/m (pico Siemens per metre) will dissipate static charges so that they will not accumulate to a hazardous potential. Experience indicates that most water miscible liquids, crude oils, residual oils and asphalts do not accumulate static charges.

A-4.1.8.3.(1)

Products tested and listed by recognized agencies are considered to be designed in conformance with good engineering practice. Underwriters Laboratories Inc. and Factory Mutual Engineering Corporation are currently listing these products.

A-4.2.2.3.(2)

Flammable and combustible liquids are classified as Class 3 dangerous goods in accordance with the "Transportation of Dangerous Goods Regulations." However, Class 3 dangerous goods include liquids with flash points up to 61�C, which means that Class IIIA liquids with flash points above 61�C are not treated as dangerous goods. For the purposes of this Article, Class IIIA liquids should be treated as Class 3 dangerous goods as described in Table 3.2.7.6.

A-4.2.5.3.(1)

Article 4.2.5.3. addresses the potential hazard where flammable vapours are released during transfer operations in an improperly ventilated area, and where sources of ignition may not be adequately controlled. It is not intended to prohibit the opening of small containers in retail areas of paint stores for the purpose of tinting paints.

A-4.2.7.5.(2)

Sentence 4.2.7.5.(2) sets no limit to the total quantity of flammable and combustible liquids in a separate or detached storage building. Although total quantity limits of Tables 4.2.7.5.A and 4.2.7.5.B do not apply, the quantity and height limitations specified for the individual storage areas must be complied with in order to take advantage of the exemption for total quantity limits. Requirements pertaining to spatial separation of buildings are found in Subsection 3.2.3. of the British Columbia Building Code. The requirements in this Code for the storage of flammable and combustible liquids must be read in conjunction with applicable provisions in the British Columbia Building Code that impose restrictions on the design of a storage building. For example, the size and height of a building, type of construction, automatic fire suppression and street access are governed in part by Subsection 3.2.2. of the British Columbia Building Code. Environmental protection regulations may contain additional requirements that should be considered in the design of a storage building for flammable and combustible liquids.

A-4.2.7.7.(1)

Options for fixed fire suppression systems for protection of flammable or combustible liquid storage areas include: automatic sprinkler, foam sprinkler, water spray, carbon dioxide, dry chemical or halon systems. Appendix D of NFPA 30, "Flammable and Combustible Liquids Code," represents good engineering practice for design of sprinkler or foam water systems for flammable and combustible liquid storage areas.

A-4.2.7.8.(2)

Containers of flammable or combustible liquids could be punctured or deformed by being pushed up against a protrusion from a wall. The required wall clearance is intended to prevent such damage, and to permit visual inspection of the sides of the individual storage area. The clearance need not be provided for narrow shelves along a wall, where the backs of the shelves can be inspected from the aisle.

A-4.2.8.1.(1)

Subsection 4.2.8. applies to those portions of an industrial occupancy where the use, storage and handling of flammable and combustible liquids is only incidental, or secondary to the principal activity. The word "incidental" does not imply "small quantity," or "insignificant amount." Manufacturers of electronic equipment, furniture and reinforced plastic boats, and automobile assembly plants are typical examples of locations where the use of flammable and combustible liquids is secondary to the principal activity of manufacturing consumer products. In storage areas otherwise governed by Part 3 of this Code, Subsection 4.2.8. applies to the "incidental" storage of flammable and combustible liquids that is deemed to be secondary to the principal activity of storing commodities covered in Part 3. This includes the storage of used lubricating oil in the warehouse portion (industrial occupancy) of a retail outlet. Subsection 4.2.8. also applies to the storage of used lubricating oil at motor vehicle repair and service garages because such storage is secondary to the principal activity of repairing and servicing motor vehicles.

A-4.2.8.3.(1)(a)

The fire separation required by this Clause should also prevent the passage of vapours.

A-4.3.1.8.(1)(b)

Examples of devices to prevent overfill include automatic sensing devices for interconnection with shut-off equipment at the supply vehicle, automatic overfill shut-off devices of a float valve or other mechanical type, vent restriction devices, and overfill alarm devices of the audible or visual type.

A-4.3.2.1.(4)

Boil-over is an event in the burning of certain oils in an open top tank when, after a long period of quiescent burning, there is a sudden increase in fire intensity associated with expulsion of burning oil from the tank. Boil-over occurs when the residues from surface burning become more dense than the unburned oil and sink below the surface to form a hot layer, which progresses downward much faster than the regression of the liquid surface. When this hot layer, called a "heat wave," reaches water or water-in-oil emulsion in the bottom of the tank, the water is first superheated and subsequently boils almost explosively, overflowing the tank. Oils subject to boil-over consist of both light ends and viscous residues. These characteristics are present in most crude oils and can be produced in synthetic mixtures.

���

Note: A boil-over is an entirely different phenomenon from a slop-over or a froth-over. Slop-over involves a minor frothing that occurs when water is sprayed onto the hot surface of a burning oil. Froth-over is not associated with a fire but results when water is present or enters a tank containing hot viscous oil. Upon mixing, the sudden conversion of water to steam causes a portion of the tank contents to overflow.

A-4.3.2.5.

Guidelines for the protection of storage stanks can also be found in standards published by National Fire Protection Association, Insurers' Advisory Organization (1989) Inc., Industrial Risk Insurers and Factory Mutual Engineering Corporation. Such guidelines are considered as good engineering practice in assessing the protection necessary for tanks.

A-4.3.7.5.(1)

When the height of a secondary containment wall exceeds 1.8 m, there is an increased potential for heavier-than-air vapour to accumulate at ground level within the contained area. Depending on the nature of such a vapour accumulation, it may be explosive or sufficiently toxic to seriously endanger personnel. Entry into such a contained area should always be preceded by testing for such a vapour accumulation.

A-4.3.7.5.(2)

Vapours from Class I liquids may reach unsafe concentrations when confined in the small space between the tank and the secondary containment wall. Remotely operated valves or elevated walkways eliminate the need for personnel to enter the bottom of the contained area to operate a valve.

A-4.3.8.9.(1)

The purpose of anchoring or providing overburden on top of underground storage tanks is to prevent them from lifting out of the ground in the event of a rise in the water table or a flood. Any proposed means of anchorage or overburden must be sufficient to resist the uplift forces on tanks when they are empty and completely submerged.

Means which have been employed successfully to protect tanks against uplift are

��������� (a)��� anchor straps to concrete supports beneath them,

��������� (b)��� ground anchors, and

��������� (c)��� reinforced concrete slabs or planks on top of them.

A-4.3.12.8.(1)

For design of normal and emergency venting of indoor storage tanks, Sentence 4.3.12.8.(1) refers to Subsection 4.3.4., which in turn refers to API 2000, "Venting Atmospheric and Low Pressure Storage Tanks." However, API 2000 is intended for outdoor tanks rather than indoor tanks. The venting rate reduction factors for water spray on the tank surface, or drainage rates for spilled liquids, should not be used to calculate the emergency venting rate of a storage tank installed inside a building. The effects of water spray cooling, and room drainage on the calculated emergency venting rate must be worked out according to good engineering practice. Increased emergency venting capacity may be required.

A-4.3.12.9.(2)

Good engineering practice for design of supports for suspended storage tanks should meet the intent of Subsection 4.3.3. as far as possible. Such factors as the provision of adequate fire resistance for supports, the need to prevent over-stressing the tank shell or its supports, and resistance to earthquake forces in areas subject to such forces, should be taken into consideration.

A-4.3.13.4.(1)

The small diameter hose stations permitted in Article 6.2.3.4. are not intended for fighting a flammable or combustible liquid fire. Such fires should be fought using fog nozzles rather than solid water streams, because solid streams may spread the liquid fuel and worsen the situation. The small diameter hoses permitted in lieu of extinguishers are intended to be used for prompt suppression of a small fire in ordinary combustibles, and for prompt wash-down of spilled flammable or combustible liquids, before any fire occurs.

A-4.3.15.1.(3)(b)

Non-volumetric testing to determine the location of leaks includes acoustical, tracer and external product detection methods. The location of leaks in the bottom of a tank shell can also be determined by vacuum testing. It is anticipated that all such testing will be conducted by individuals or companies experienced in these test procedures.

A-4.3.16.3.(1)(a)

If the loss or gain computations specified in Subsection 4.3.16. exceed any of the following criteria:

������������ 1)�� 18 loss computations in the previous 30 consecutive loss/gain computations;

������������ 2)�� 5 consecutive loss/gain computations showing a loss;

������������ 3)�� a cumulative monthly loss/gain of greater than 0.5% of total monthly tank throughput or 2.5% of tank capacity,

then there is substantive evidence that a leak may have occurred or may be occurring from the tank system.

A-4.4.7.11.(1)

It is good practice to space hangers for pipe having a nominal diameter of 50 mm or less not more than 3.5 m apart.

A-4.5.1.1.

Section 4.5. applies only to the portion of a property where fuel dispensing operations are conducted. When a facility combines fuel dispensing operations with other types of business (motor vehicle repair garage, convenience store, restaurant, etc.), Section 4.5. is intended to apply only to the fuel dispensing operations and the adjacent business shall conform to other Sections of this Code based on its occupancy classification (assembly occupancy for a restaurant, mercantile occupancy for a convenience store, industrial occupancy for a repair garage, etc.).

A-4.5.2.2.(2)

This requirement is intended to prevent the accumulation of flammable vapours in low areas of buildings. If low areas are equipped with suitable continuously operating mechanical ventilation, flammable vapours would not be expected to accumulate.

A-4.5.8.4.(1)

The authorized holder of a card or key, having received adequate training in the safe and responsible operation of the equipment, is not considered a member of the "general public." Such is not the case for coin operated or preset dispensers, which could be operated by anyone.

A-4.5.8.6.(2)

When gasoline vapour is allowed to enter into a diesel fuelled engine through the air intake, there is a potential for the diesel engine to run away. In a runaway condition, a diesel engine would accelerate in an uncontrolled manner even if the ignition is switched off, resulting in damage to the engine and potentially causing fire.

A-4.5.8.8.(2)

Examples of signs to indicate that smoking is not permitted and that the engine ignition must be turned off while the vehicle is being refuelled:

Figure A-4.5.8.8.

Fuel dispensing station signs

A-4.6.4.

When used in this Subsection, the terms "loading" and "unloading" shall mean the loading and unloading of tank vehicles or tank cars.

A-4.7.8.1.(1)(a)

Section 38 of the "Oil Pollution Prevention Regulations of the Canada Shipping Act" may apply to flexible cargo hoses described in this Code. The following documents are considered good engineering practice for this application:

"Purchasing, Manufacturing and Testing of Loading and Discharge Hoses for Offshore Moorings" prepared by the Oil Companies International Marine Forum. It can be obtained from: New York Nautical Instrument and Service Corporation, 140 Westbroadway, New York, New York 10013 U.S.A.

"Hose Handbook" prepared by The Rubber Manufacturers Association, Inc. It can be obtained from: The Mail Room, P.O. Box 3147, Medina, Ohio 44258 U.S.A.

A-4.8.3.4.(2)

Examples of such equipment are dispensing stations, open centrifuges, plate and frame filters, open vacuum filters and surfaces of open equipment.

A-4.9.1.1.(1)

Beer, wine, and spirits which contain less than 20% by volume alcohol, are not considered to be flammable liquids and are not regulated by this Section. Section 4.9. does not apply to wineries where distilled beverage alcohol is used to fortify wine.

A-4.9.3.2.

Exposed steel supports do not have a 2 h fire-resistance rating, and need protection as much as timber supports for tanks. Due to the water miscibility of beverage alcohols, automatic sprinklers provide an effective means of achieving the necessary protection, provided there is sufficient space under the tank to permit their installation.

A-4.9.3.3.(1)

The use of "good engineering practice" in the design of normal and emergency venting is intended to prevent an accumulation of flammable vapours inside the building that may present an explosion hazard. For new tank installations, this can be achieved by directing breather vents and emergency vents, equipped with flame arrestors or pressure/vacuum valves, to the outside of the building. However, on existing tank installations, installation of such vents may be impractical. Venting into the interior space may not constitute an undue hazard where certain measures are taken to ensure an adequate degree of fire safety. Such measures include, but are not limited to: installation of automatic sprinklers throughout the tank room and under any raised tanks greater than 1.2 m in diameter; classification of electrical equipment and wiring according to the zone classifications of the " British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations"; provision of adequate natural or mechanical ventilation meeting the objectives of Article 4.9.6.1.; and training of personnel in safe operating procedures.

A-4.9.5.1.(1)

Piping and pumping systems should be designed to recognized engineering standards and accepted industry practice.

A-5.1.2.1.(1)

In addition to the general requirements of CSA C22.1, " British Columbia Electrical Safety Act and Pursuant Regulations," special attention must be given to Sections 18, 20 and 22. Section 18 specifies wiring requirements for Class I, II and III hazardous locations. Section 20 provides specific requirements for areas where flammable or combustible liquids are stored or dispensed. Section 22 specifies wiring requirements for areas where corrosive liquids or vapours or excessive moisture are present.

A-5.3.1.3.(2)

NFPA standards on dust explosions include:

NFPA 61, "Prevention of Fires and Dust Explosions in Agricultural and Food Products,"

NFPA 65, "Processing and Finishing of Aluminum,"

NFPA 91, "Exhaust Systems for Air-Conveying of Materials,"

NFPA 120, "Coal Preparation Plants,"

NFPA 480, "Storage, Handling and Processing of Magnesium,"

NFPA 481, "Production, Processing, Handling and Storage of Titanium,"

NFPA 482, "Production, Processing, Handling and Storage of Zirconium,"

NFPA 650, "Pneumatic Conveying Systems for Handling Combustible Materials,"

NFPA 651, "Manufacture of Aluminum and Magnesium Powder,"

NFPA 654, "Prevention of Fires and Dust Explosions in the Chemical, Dye, Pharmaceutical and Plastics Industries,"

NFPA 655, "Prevention of Sulfur Fires and Explosions,"

NFPA 664, "Prevention of Fires and Explosions in Wood Processing and Woodworking Facilities."

A-5.3.3.2.(2)

A conveyor belt having a surface resistivity of less than 300 megaohms is considered to provide protection against electrostatic charge accumulation in a grain handling facility.

A-5.4.2.1.

The following diagrams illustrate the intent of Article 5.4.2.1. with respect to the degree of separation required between spray coating operations and the remainder of the building.

Figure A-5.4.2.1.A.

Building not sprinklered

Figure A-5.4.2.1.B.

Building fully sprinklered

Figure A-5.4.2.1.C.

Partial automatic fire suppression system with separation

Figure A-5.4.2.1.D.

Partial automatic fire suppression system with no separation

A-5.4.2.1.(3) and (4)

Although partial sprinkler systems and other automatic fire suppression systems installed in the spray booth and spray area only can be overtaxed by a fire developing outside of the protected area, they do have a limited value in protecting the rest of the building against a fire starting within the protected area. Partial sprinkler systems in otherwise unsprinklered buildings should conform as closely as possible to the design and installation standards referenced in Article 6.5.1.1. Additional design guidance is available in NFPA 33, "Spray Application Using Flammable and Combustible Materials."

A-5.4.3.1.(4)

The NFPA "Fire Protection Handbook" identifies 4 basic types of overspray collector: baffle maze, dry filter, water wash, and venturi scrubber.

A-6.1.1.2.(1)

Both the British Columbia Building Code and the British Columbia Fire Code assume that all fire protection features of a building, whether required by Code or voluntarily installed, will be designed in conformance with good fire protection engineering practice and will meet the appropriate installation requirements in relevant standards. Such good design is necessary to ensure that the level of public safety established by the Code requirements is not reduced by a voluntary installation. Thus, a voluntarily installed system should be maintained in operating condition, at least to the extent that it was originally intended to function, in conformance with the applicable installation standards.

A-6.1.1.3.(1)

Notification of planned or emergency interruption or curtailment of service of fire protection installations is preferably given in advance when possible. The parties to be notified who could be affected may include, but are not necessarily limited to, the fire department, supervisory staff in the building and the occupants of the building.

A-6.1.1.4.(1)

Interruption of normal operation of a fire protection system for any purpose constitutes a "temporary shutdown." Types of interruptions include, but are not limited to, periodic inspection or testing, maintenance, and repairs. During a shutdown, alternative measures are necessary to ensure that the level of safety intended by the Code is maintained.

In the shutdown of a fire alarm system, alternative measures should be worked out in cooperation with the fire department to ensure that all persons in the building can be informed promptly, and the fire department notified, if a fire should occur while the alarm system is out of service.

When a sprinkler system is shut down, measures that can be taken include the provision of: emergency hose lines and portable extinguishers, extra fire watch service and, where practicable, temporary water connections to the sprinkler system.

A-6.2.1.3.(2)

Prominent cautionary labels on portable extinguishers, warning signs at entry points to confined spaces, provisions for remote applications, special nozzles, special ventilation, provision of breathing apparatus and other personal protective equipment and adequate training of personnel are among measures to be considered to minimize hazards.

A-6.2.2.1.(1)

Certain combustible metals and reactive chemicals require special extinguishing agents or techniques.NFPA 49, "Hazardous Chemicals Data" can be used as a guide regarding such agents or techniques. Chemical reactions between burning metals and many extinguishing agents may cause explosions or increase the intensity of the fire, depending on the type, form and quantity of metal involved and the extinguishing agent used.

Extinguishers equipped with metal extensions are not considered safe for use on fires in energized electrical equipment and, therefore, should not be used for fighting Class C fires.

A-6.2.3.1.(1)

The anticipated rate of fire spread, the intensity and rate of heat development, the smoke contributed by the burning materials and the approachability of a fire with portable extinguishers are factors that are taken into consideration. Wheeled extinguishers contain additional agent, have greater range and provide additional protection where this is needed.

A-6.3.1.5.(2)

Sentence 6.3.1.5.(2) is intended to ensure that a voice communication system which would not be tested as part of an associated fire alarm system, but which will be relied upon during a fire emergency, will be tested periodically.

A-6.4.1.6.(1)

NFPA 14 "Installation of Standpipe and Hose Systems" requires an initial flow test to be conducted at the hydraulically most remote outlet on any new standpipe system. A similar test should be conducted every five years to ensure that the design flow can be delivered at the required residual pressure at the topmost outlet. This may require installation of a valved test connection near the top of the standpipe riser, as well as special arrangements to stop traffic to permit hose streams to be discharged to the street. On existing standpipe systems, where a flow test from the hydraulically most remote outlet may not be practical, an appropriate location for the test should be selected in consultation with the authority having jurisdiction.

A-6.5.1.1.(1)

This reference to the British Columbia Building Code is intended to lead primarily to Subsection 3.2.5. of the British Columbia Building Code "Provisions for Fire Fighting". Articles in that Subsection specify the appropriate standard for design and installation of automatic sprinkler systems (NFPA 13), and provide for several exceptions or supplementary requirements. On occasion, other pertinent provisions in the British Columbia Building Code may apply. However, where a specific hazard is not addressed by the British Columbia Building Code, such as high piled storage, storage of flammable and combustible liquids or rubber tires, the Fire Code directly references the applicable NFPA standards for design criteria for the sprinkler system. The applicable NFPA standard may also indicate specific or suggested inspection, testing and maintenance information.

A-6.5.1.5.(1)

Partitions, racks, or products stored on shelves or in piles should be kept far enough away from sprinklers so that they will not interfere with the discharge pattern. NFPA 13, "Installation of Sprinkler Systems" sets the standard for minimum clearances from obstructions.

A-6.5.1.7.(1)

The British Columbia Building Code permits the use of plastic sprinkler piping for wet pipe sprinkler systems in residential and other light hazard occupancies. Subsection 3.2.5. of the British Columbia Building Code specifies criteria for protecting plastic sprinkler pipe so that no length of pipe could be exposed to open flame or heat without the protection of a nearby sprinkler, or fire resistive covering. Article 6.5.1.7. of the British Columbia Fire Code ensures that the conditions specified in the British Columbia Building Code are maintained, including the limitation to light hazard occupancies, the location of openings in the protective membrane with respect to sprinklers, the use of steel suspension grids and proper weight individual ceiling tiles in suspended ceilings, and the integrity of fire protective covering construction.

A-6.5.2.3.(1)

The manner in which closed sprinkler control valves are identified should also be apparent to the responding fire department.

A-6.5.3.6.(1)

Velocities of approximately 3 m/s can be achieved by attaining flow rates as indicated in Table A-6.5.3.6.

Table A-6.5.3.6.

Recommended Minimum Flow Rates for Flushing
Underground Water Supply Mains

Size of Pipe, mm

Minimum Flow, L/min

100

1 500

150

3 250

200

5 800

250

9 000

300

13 000

A-6.5.3.11.(1)

The normal water supply is determined by conducting a main drain test at the time of the original sprinkler installation. The static pressure is recorded, the main drain valve is opened wide under available pressure and the residual pressure is recorded. The difference between static and residual pressures at that time is the normal pressure drop. If pressure drops significantly greater than normal occur during subsequent main drain tests, the supply system should be investigated for the possibility of closed valves or other obstructions in the piping.

A-6.5.4.4.(1)

Where a sprinkler system control valve has associated with it a drain valve of adequate size (50 mm), and the necessary pressure gauges, the drain test referred to is as described for a "main drain test" in Appendix Note A-6.5.3.11.(1). However, for sectional control valves, such as occur on sprinkler piping for individual floors or zones in a multi-storey building, the drain valve for the piping in that zone may not be equivalent to a 50 mm "main drain," and the pressure gauges needed to conduct a proper main drain test may be absent. In the case of sectional control valves, the drain test intended involves opening the local drain valve and flowing water to ensure the sectional control valve has been fully reopened.

A-6.5.4.12.(1)

Sprinklers in service frequently accumulate a deposit of dust, grease or other foreign material. Where these deposits are light, they often do not impair the proper operation of the sprinkler. Heavier deposits can often be removed by light cleaning methods. Where the deposits cannot readily be removed, and doubt exists with respect to the effects of the contamination, a sampling of the sprinklers should be removed and forwarded to a recognized testing laboratory for an assessment of their operational characteristics to determine the necessity of replacing other sprinklers in the system.

A-6.6.3.2.(1)

The pump room temperature must be maintained in the range intended by the engine manufacturer, because the start-up performance of the engine may be greatly reduced at lower temperatures. The engine manufacturer may recommend the installation of water heaters and oil heaters when ambient temperatures could be less than 20�C. The temperature in the pump room can be lower for electric motor driven pumps, and 4�C is widely used as the minimum permissible temperature in valve rooms, during the most severe weather.

A-6.6.3.3.(1)

An indication of the satisfactory performance of the controller can be obtained by starting the pump by reducing the water pressure in the controller sensing line. The operating conditions of the relief valve, and the discharge and suction pressures, lubricating oil levels, and priming water levels, are further indications of the performance of the fire pump and related equipment.

Centrifugal fire pumps should not be operated for prolonged periods under shut-off conditions, that is, with no water flowing from the system, or at very low rates of flow, because of the excessive wear on impellers due to cavitation, and on seals and thrust bearings due to the higher operating pressure and increased vibrations. Water should be discharged from the system if possible.

A-6.6.4.1.(2)

The following diagrams illustrate the intent of Sentence 6.6.4.1.(2) with respect to minimum clearances required to be maintained for fire hydrant visibility and accessibility:

Figure 6.6.4.1.A. and Figure 6.6.4.1.B.

A-6.7.1.5.(1)

This can be achieved by replenishment as the result of the routine test program required by Article 6.7.1.1.

A-6.8.1.1.

Concern over the impact of halons on the environment is resulting in changes to the regulations of various agencies that affect their use and release to the atmosphere and the reduction, recycling and eventual phaseout of halon fire extinguishment agents. Standards referenced in the British Columbia Fire Code may not reflect the status at any given time of requirements by other agencies regarding the installation, use and testing of fire suppression systems that employ halons.

A-7.2.1.1.(1)

It is not intended that all equipment be tested on each test occasion. A representative number of devices may be tested on each occasion provided all equipment is tested within the time period agreed to in the fire safety plan.

A-7.3.1.1.(1)

The testing required in Section 7.3. is not intended to be a complete assessment of the design of the smoke control system, but only a test of the individual pieces of equipment specified.

END OF BRITISH COLUMBIA
BUILDING, PLUMBING AND FIRE CODE FOLIO INFOBASE

A Fire Rated Evacuation Stair Can Not Have a Skylight

Source: http://www.qp.gov.bc.ca/testing/wlap/firecode.htm